mirror of
https://git.yoctoproject.org/poky
synced 2026-02-20 08:29:42 +01:00
(From yocto-docs rev: 590ddc11263f00d912d874377199574c123c75b1) Signed-off-by: Nicolas Dechesne <nicolas.dechesne@linaro.org> Signed-off-by: Richard Purdie <richard.purdie@linuxfoundation.org>
10243 lines
443 KiB
ReStructuredText
10243 lines
443 KiB
ReStructuredText
.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
|
||
|
||
************
|
||
Common Tasks
|
||
************
|
||
|
||
This chapter describes fundamental procedures such as creating layers,
|
||
adding new software packages, extending or customizing images, porting
|
||
work to new hardware (adding a new machine), and so forth. You will find
|
||
that the procedures documented here occur often in the development cycle
|
||
using the Yocto Project.
|
||
|
||
Understanding and Creating Layers
|
||
=================================
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system supports organizing
|
||
:term:`Metadata` into multiple layers.
|
||
Layers allow you to isolate different types of customizations from each
|
||
other. For introductory information on the Yocto Project Layer Model,
|
||
see the "`The Yocto Project Layer
|
||
Model <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#the-yocto-project-layer-model>`__" section in
|
||
the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
Creating Your Own Layer
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
It is very easy to create your own layers to use with the OpenEmbedded
|
||
build system. The Yocto Project ships with tools that speed up creating
|
||
layers. This section describes the steps you perform by hand to create
|
||
layers so that you can better understand them. For information about the
|
||
layer-creation tools, see the "`Creating a New BSP Layer Using the
|
||
``bitbake-layers``
|
||
Script <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#creating-a-new-bsp-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP) Developer's
|
||
Guide and the "`Creating a General Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers``
|
||
Script <#creating-a-general-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__"
|
||
section further down in this manual.
|
||
|
||
Follow these general steps to create your layer without using tools:
|
||
|
||
1. *Check Existing Layers:* Before creating a new layer, you should be
|
||
sure someone has not already created a layer containing the Metadata
|
||
you need. You can see the `OpenEmbedded Metadata
|
||
Index <http://layers.openembedded.org/layerindex/layers/>`__ for a
|
||
list of layers from the OpenEmbedded community that can be used in
|
||
the Yocto Project. You could find a layer that is identical or close
|
||
to what you need.
|
||
|
||
2. *Create a Directory:* Create the directory for your layer. When you
|
||
create the layer, be sure to create the directory in an area not
|
||
associated with the Yocto Project :term:`Source Directory`
|
||
(e.g. the cloned
|
||
``poky`` repository).
|
||
|
||
While not strictly required, prepend the name of the directory with
|
||
the string "meta-". For example: meta-mylayer meta-GUI_xyz
|
||
meta-mymachine With rare exceptions, a layer's name follows this
|
||
form: meta-root_name Following this layer naming convention can save
|
||
you trouble later when tools, components, or variables "assume" your
|
||
layer name begins with "meta-". A notable example is in configuration
|
||
files as shown in the following step where layer names without the
|
||
"meta-" string are appended to several variables used in the
|
||
configuration.
|
||
|
||
3. *Create a Layer Configuration File:* Inside your new layer folder,
|
||
you need to create a ``conf/layer.conf`` file. It is easiest to take
|
||
an existing layer configuration file and copy that to your layer's
|
||
``conf`` directory and then modify the file as needed.
|
||
|
||
The ``meta-yocto-bsp/conf/layer.conf`` file in the Yocto Project
|
||
`Source
|
||
Repositories <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta-yocto-bsp/conf>`__
|
||
demonstrates the required syntax. For your layer, you need to replace
|
||
"yoctobsp" with a unique identifier for your layer (e.g. "machinexyz"
|
||
for a layer named "meta-machinexyz"): # We have a conf and classes
|
||
directory, add to BBPATH BBPATH .= ":${LAYERDIR}" # We have
|
||
recipes-\* directories, add to BBFILES BBFILES +=
|
||
"${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bb \\ ${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bbappend"
|
||
BBFILE_COLLECTIONS += "yoctobsp" BBFILE_PATTERN_yoctobsp =
|
||
"^${LAYERDIR}/" BBFILE_PRIORITY_yoctobsp = "5" LAYERVERSION_yoctobsp
|
||
= "4" LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_yoctobsp = "DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP" Following is
|
||
an explanation of the layer configuration file:
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BBPATH`: Adds the layer's
|
||
root directory to BitBake's search path. Through the use of the
|
||
``BBPATH`` variable, BitBake locates class files (``.bbclass``),
|
||
configuration files, and files that are included with ``include``
|
||
and ``require`` statements. For these cases, BitBake uses the
|
||
first file that matches the name found in ``BBPATH``. This is
|
||
similar to the way the ``PATH`` variable is used for binaries. It
|
||
is recommended, therefore, that you use unique class and
|
||
configuration filenames in your custom layer.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BBFILES`: Defines the
|
||
location for all recipes in the layer.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BBFILE_COLLECTIONS`:
|
||
Establishes the current layer through a unique identifier that is
|
||
used throughout the OpenEmbedded build system to refer to the
|
||
layer. In this example, the identifier "yoctobsp" is the
|
||
representation for the container layer named "meta-yocto-bsp".
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BBFILE_PATTERN`:
|
||
Expands immediately during parsing to provide the directory of the
|
||
layer.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY`:
|
||
Establishes a priority to use for recipes in the layer when the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build finds recipes of the same name in different
|
||
layers.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`LAYERVERSION`:
|
||
Establishes a version number for the layer. You can use this
|
||
version number to specify this exact version of the layer as a
|
||
dependency when using the
|
||
:term:`LAYERDEPENDS`
|
||
variable.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`LAYERDEPENDS`:
|
||
Lists all layers on which this layer depends (if any).
|
||
|
||
- :term:`LAYERSERIES_COMPAT`:
|
||
Lists the `Yocto Project <&YOCTO_WIKI_URL;/wiki/Releases>`__
|
||
releases for which the current version is compatible. This
|
||
variable is a good way to indicate if your particular layer is
|
||
current.
|
||
|
||
4. *Add Content:* Depending on the type of layer, add the content. If
|
||
the layer adds support for a machine, add the machine configuration
|
||
in a ``conf/machine/`` file within the layer. If the layer adds
|
||
distro policy, add the distro configuration in a ``conf/distro/``
|
||
file within the layer. If the layer introduces new recipes, put the
|
||
recipes you need in ``recipes-*`` subdirectories within the layer.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For an explanation of layer hierarchy that is compliant with the
|
||
Yocto Project, see the "
|
||
Example Filesystem Layout
|
||
" section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP)
|
||
Developer's Guide.
|
||
|
||
5. *Optionally Test for Compatibility:* If you want permission to use
|
||
the Yocto Project Compatibility logo with your layer or application
|
||
that uses your layer, perform the steps to apply for compatibility.
|
||
See the "`Making Sure Your Layer is Compatible With Yocto
|
||
Project <#making-sure-your-layer-is-compatible-with-yocto-project>`__"
|
||
section for more information.
|
||
|
||
.. _best-practices-to-follow-when-creating-layers:
|
||
|
||
Following Best Practices When Creating Layers
|
||
---------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
To create layers that are easier to maintain and that will not impact
|
||
builds for other machines, you should consider the information in the
|
||
following list:
|
||
|
||
- *Avoid "Overlaying" Entire Recipes from Other Layers in Your
|
||
Configuration:* In other words, do not copy an entire recipe into
|
||
your layer and then modify it. Rather, use an append file
|
||
(``.bbappend``) to override only those parts of the original recipe
|
||
you need to modify.
|
||
|
||
- *Avoid Duplicating Include Files:* Use append files (``.bbappend``)
|
||
for each recipe that uses an include file. Or, if you are introducing
|
||
a new recipe that requires the included file, use the path relative
|
||
to the original layer directory to refer to the file. For example,
|
||
use ``require recipes-core/``\ package\ ``/``\ file\ ``.inc`` instead
|
||
of ``require``\ file\ ``.inc``. If you're finding you have to overlay
|
||
the include file, it could indicate a deficiency in the include file
|
||
in the layer to which it originally belongs. If this is the case, you
|
||
should try to address that deficiency instead of overlaying the
|
||
include file. For example, you could address this by getting the
|
||
maintainer of the include file to add a variable or variables to make
|
||
it easy to override the parts needing to be overridden.
|
||
|
||
- *Structure Your Layers:* Proper use of overrides within append files
|
||
and placement of machine-specific files within your layer can ensure
|
||
that a build is not using the wrong Metadata and negatively impacting
|
||
a build for a different machine. Following are some examples:
|
||
|
||
- *Modify Variables to Support a Different Machine:* Suppose you
|
||
have a layer named ``meta-one`` that adds support for building
|
||
machine "one". To do so, you use an append file named
|
||
``base-files.bbappend`` and create a dependency on "foo" by
|
||
altering the :term:`DEPENDS`
|
||
variable: DEPENDS = "foo" The dependency is created during any
|
||
build that includes the layer ``meta-one``. However, you might not
|
||
want this dependency for all machines. For example, suppose you
|
||
are building for machine "two" but your ``bblayers.conf`` file has
|
||
the ``meta-one`` layer included. During the build, the
|
||
``base-files`` for machine "two" will also have the dependency on
|
||
``foo``.
|
||
|
||
To make sure your changes apply only when building machine "one",
|
||
use a machine override with the ``DEPENDS`` statement: DEPENDS_one
|
||
= "foo" You should follow the same strategy when using ``_append``
|
||
and ``_prepend`` operations: DEPENDS_append_one = " foo"
|
||
DEPENDS_prepend_one = "foo " As an actual example, here's a
|
||
snippet from the generic kernel include file ``linux-yocto.inc``,
|
||
wherein the kernel compile and link options are adjusted in the
|
||
case of a subset of the supported architectures:
|
||
DEPENDS_append_aarch64 = " libgcc" KERNEL_CC_append_aarch64 = "
|
||
${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}" KERNEL_LD_append_aarch64 = "
|
||
${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}" DEPENDS_append_nios2 = " libgcc"
|
||
KERNEL_CC_append_nios2 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
|
||
KERNEL_LD_append_nios2 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
|
||
DEPENDS_append_arc = " libgcc" KERNEL_CC_append_arc = "
|
||
${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}" KERNEL_LD_append_arc = "
|
||
${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}" KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemuall="
|
||
features/debug/printk.scc"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Avoiding "+=" and "=+" and using machine-specific
|
||
\_append
|
||
and
|
||
\_prepend
|
||
operations is recommended as well.
|
||
|
||
- *Place Machine-Specific Files in Machine-Specific Locations:* When
|
||
you have a base recipe, such as ``base-files.bb``, that contains a
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` statement to a
|
||
file, you can use an append file to cause the build to use your
|
||
own version of the file. For example, an append file in your layer
|
||
at ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files.bbappend`` could
|
||
extend :term:`FILESPATH`
|
||
using
|
||
:term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS`
|
||
as follows: FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/${BPN}:" The
|
||
build for machine "one" will pick up your machine-specific file as
|
||
long as you have the file in
|
||
``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/``. However, if you
|
||
are building for a different machine and the ``bblayers.conf``
|
||
file includes the ``meta-one`` layer and the location of your
|
||
machine-specific file is the first location where that file is
|
||
found according to ``FILESPATH``, builds for all machines will
|
||
also use that machine-specific file.
|
||
|
||
You can make sure that a machine-specific file is used for a
|
||
particular machine by putting the file in a subdirectory specific
|
||
to the machine. For example, rather than placing the file in
|
||
``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/`` as shown above,
|
||
put it in ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/one/``.
|
||
Not only does this make sure the file is used only when building
|
||
for machine "one", but the build process locates the file more
|
||
quickly.
|
||
|
||
In summary, you need to place all files referenced from
|
||
``SRC_URI`` in a machine-specific subdirectory within the layer in
|
||
order to restrict those files to machine-specific builds.
|
||
|
||
- *Perform Steps to Apply for Yocto Project Compatibility:* If you want
|
||
permission to use the Yocto Project Compatibility logo with your
|
||
layer or application that uses your layer, perform the steps to apply
|
||
for compatibility. See the "`Making Sure Your Layer is Compatible
|
||
With Yocto
|
||
Project <#making-sure-your-layer-is-compatible-with-yocto-project>`__"
|
||
section for more information.
|
||
|
||
- *Follow the Layer Naming Convention:* Store custom layers in a Git
|
||
repository that use the ``meta-layer_name`` format.
|
||
|
||
- *Group Your Layers Locally:* Clone your repository alongside other
|
||
cloned ``meta`` directories from the :term:`Source Directory`.
|
||
|
||
Making Sure Your Layer is Compatible With Yocto Project
|
||
-------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
When you create a layer used with the Yocto Project, it is advantageous
|
||
to make sure that the layer interacts well with existing Yocto Project
|
||
layers (i.e. the layer is compatible with the Yocto Project). Ensuring
|
||
compatibility makes the layer easy to be consumed by others in the Yocto
|
||
Project community and could allow you permission to use the Yocto
|
||
Project Compatible Logo.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Only Yocto Project member organizations are permitted to use the
|
||
Yocto Project Compatible Logo. The logo is not available for general
|
||
use. For information on how to become a Yocto Project member
|
||
organization, see the
|
||
Yocto Project Website
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project Compatibility Program consists of a layer application
|
||
process that requests permission to use the Yocto Project Compatibility
|
||
Logo for your layer and application. The process consists of two parts:
|
||
|
||
1. Successfully passing a script (``yocto-check-layer``) that when run
|
||
against your layer, tests it against constraints based on experiences
|
||
of how layers have worked in the real world and where pitfalls have
|
||
been found. Getting a "PASS" result from the script is required for
|
||
successful compatibility registration.
|
||
|
||
2. Completion of an application acceptance form, which you can find at
|
||
` <https://www.yoctoproject.org/webform/yocto-project-compatible-registration>`__.
|
||
|
||
To be granted permission to use the logo, you need to satisfy the
|
||
following:
|
||
|
||
- Be able to check the box indicating that you got a "PASS" when
|
||
running the script against your layer.
|
||
|
||
- Answer "Yes" to the questions on the form or have an acceptable
|
||
explanation for any questions answered "No".
|
||
|
||
- Be a Yocto Project Member Organization.
|
||
|
||
The remainder of this section presents information on the registration
|
||
form and on the ``yocto-check-layer`` script.
|
||
|
||
Yocto Project Compatible Program Application
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Use the form to apply for your layer's approval. Upon successful
|
||
application, you can use the Yocto Project Compatibility Logo with your
|
||
layer and the application that uses your layer.
|
||
|
||
To access the form, use this link:
|
||
` <https://www.yoctoproject.org/webform/yocto-project-compatible-registration>`__.
|
||
Follow the instructions on the form to complete your application.
|
||
|
||
The application consists of the following sections:
|
||
|
||
- *Contact Information:* Provide your contact information as the fields
|
||
require. Along with your information, provide the released versions
|
||
of the Yocto Project for which your layer is compatible.
|
||
|
||
- *Acceptance Criteria:* Provide "Yes" or "No" answers for each of the
|
||
items in the checklist. Space exists at the bottom of the form for
|
||
any explanations for items for which you answered "No".
|
||
|
||
- *Recommendations:* Provide answers for the questions regarding Linux
|
||
kernel use and build success.
|
||
|
||
``yocto-check-layer`` Script
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The ``yocto-check-layer`` script provides you a way to assess how
|
||
compatible your layer is with the Yocto Project. You should run this
|
||
script prior to using the form to apply for compatibility as described
|
||
in the previous section. You need to achieve a "PASS" result in order to
|
||
have your application form successfully processed.
|
||
|
||
The script divides tests into three areas: COMMON, BSP, and DISTRO. For
|
||
example, given a distribution layer (DISTRO), the layer must pass both
|
||
the COMMON and DISTRO related tests. Furthermore, if your layer is a BSP
|
||
layer, the layer must pass the COMMON and BSP set of tests.
|
||
|
||
To execute the script, enter the following commands from your build
|
||
directory: $ source oe-init-build-env $ yocto-check-layer
|
||
your_layer_directory Be sure to provide the actual directory for your
|
||
layer as part of the command.
|
||
|
||
Entering the command causes the script to determine the type of layer
|
||
and then to execute a set of specific tests against the layer. The
|
||
following list overviews the test:
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_readme``: Tests if a ``README`` file exists in the
|
||
layer and the file is not empty.
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_parse``: Tests to make sure that BitBake can parse the
|
||
files without error (i.e. ``bitbake -p``).
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_show_environment``: Tests that the global or per-recipe
|
||
environment is in order without errors (i.e. ``bitbake -e``).
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_world``: Verifies that ``bitbake world`` works.
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_signatures``: Tests to be sure that BSP and DISTRO
|
||
layers do not come with recipes that change signatures.
|
||
|
||
- ``common.test_layerseries_compat``: Verifies layer compatibility is
|
||
set properly.
|
||
|
||
- ``bsp.test_bsp_defines_machines``: Tests if a BSP layer has machine
|
||
configurations.
|
||
|
||
- ``bsp.test_bsp_no_set_machine``: Tests to ensure a BSP layer does not
|
||
set the machine when the layer is added.
|
||
|
||
- ``bsp.test_machine_world``: Verifies that ``bitbake world`` works
|
||
regardless of which machine is selected.
|
||
|
||
- ``bsp.test_machine_signatures``: Verifies that building for a
|
||
particular machine affects only the signature of tasks specific to
|
||
that machine.
|
||
|
||
- ``distro.test_distro_defines_distros``: Tests if a DISTRO layer has
|
||
distro configurations.
|
||
|
||
- ``distro.test_distro_no_set_distros``: Tests to ensure a DISTRO layer
|
||
does not set the distribution when the layer is added.
|
||
|
||
Enabling Your Layer
|
||
-------------------
|
||
|
||
Before the OpenEmbedded build system can use your new layer, you need to
|
||
enable it. To enable your layer, simply add your layer's path to the
|
||
``BBLAYERS`` variable in your ``conf/bblayers.conf`` file, which is
|
||
found in the :term:`Build Directory`.
|
||
The following example shows how to enable a layer named
|
||
``meta-mylayer``: # POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION is increased each time
|
||
build/conf/bblayers.conf # changes incompatibly
|
||
POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION = "2" BBPATH = "${TOPDIR}" BBFILES ?= ""
|
||
BBLAYERS ?= " \\ /home/user/poky/meta \\ /home/user/poky/meta-poky \\
|
||
/home/user/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \\ /home/user/poky/meta-mylayer \\ "
|
||
|
||
BitBake parses each ``conf/layer.conf`` file from the top down as
|
||
specified in the ``BBLAYERS`` variable within the ``conf/bblayers.conf``
|
||
file. During the processing of each ``conf/layer.conf`` file, BitBake
|
||
adds the recipes, classes and configurations contained within the
|
||
particular layer to the source directory.
|
||
|
||
.. _using-bbappend-files:
|
||
|
||
Using .bbappend Files in Your Layer
|
||
-----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
A recipe that appends Metadata to another recipe is called a BitBake
|
||
append file. A BitBake append file uses the ``.bbappend`` file type
|
||
suffix, while the corresponding recipe to which Metadata is being
|
||
appended uses the ``.bb`` file type suffix.
|
||
|
||
You can use a ``.bbappend`` file in your layer to make additions or
|
||
changes to the content of another layer's recipe without having to copy
|
||
the other layer's recipe into your layer. Your ``.bbappend`` file
|
||
resides in your layer, while the main ``.bb`` recipe file to which you
|
||
are appending Metadata resides in a different layer.
|
||
|
||
Being able to append information to an existing recipe not only avoids
|
||
duplication, but also automatically applies recipe changes from a
|
||
different layer into your layer. If you were copying recipes, you would
|
||
have to manually merge changes as they occur.
|
||
|
||
When you create an append file, you must use the same root name as the
|
||
corresponding recipe file. For example, the append file
|
||
``someapp_DISTRO.bbappend`` must apply to ``someapp_DISTRO.bb``. This
|
||
means the original recipe and append file names are version
|
||
number-specific. If the corresponding recipe is renamed to update to a
|
||
newer version, you must also rename and possibly update the
|
||
corresponding ``.bbappend`` as well. During the build process, BitBake
|
||
displays an error on starting if it detects a ``.bbappend`` file that
|
||
does not have a corresponding recipe with a matching name. See the
|
||
:term:`BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY`
|
||
variable for information on how to handle this error.
|
||
|
||
As an example, consider the main formfactor recipe and a corresponding
|
||
formfactor append file both from the :term:`Source Directory`.
|
||
Here is the main
|
||
formfactor recipe, which is named ``formfactor_0.0.bb`` and located in
|
||
the "meta" layer at ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor``: SUMMARY = "Device
|
||
formfactor information" SECTION = "base" LICENSE = "MIT"
|
||
LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://${COREBASE}/meta/COPYING.MIT;md5=3da9cfbcb788c80a0384361b4de20420"
|
||
PR = "r45" SRC_URI = "file://config file://machconfig" S = "${WORKDIR}"
|
||
PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}" INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS = "1" do_install()
|
||
{ # Install file only if it has contents install -d
|
||
${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/ install -m 0644 ${S}/config
|
||
${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/ if [ -s "${S}/machconfig" ]; then install
|
||
-m 0644 ${S}/machconfig ${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/ fi } In the main
|
||
recipe, note the :term:`SRC_URI`
|
||
variable, which tells the OpenEmbedded build system where to find files
|
||
during the build.
|
||
|
||
Following is the append file, which is named ``formfactor_0.0.bbappend``
|
||
and is from the Raspberry Pi BSP Layer named ``meta-raspberrypi``. The
|
||
file is in the layer at ``recipes-bsp/formfactor``:
|
||
FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:"
|
||
|
||
By default, the build system uses the
|
||
:term:`FILESPATH` variable to
|
||
locate files. This append file extends the locations by setting the
|
||
:term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS`
|
||
variable. Setting this variable in the ``.bbappend`` file is the most
|
||
reliable and recommended method for adding directories to the search
|
||
path used by the build system to find files.
|
||
|
||
The statement in this example extends the directories to include
|
||
``${``\ :term:`THISDIR`\ ``}/${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``,
|
||
which resolves to a directory named ``formfactor`` in the same directory
|
||
in which the append file resides (i.e.
|
||
``meta-raspberrypi/recipes-bsp/formfactor``. This implies that you must
|
||
have the supporting directory structure set up that will contain any
|
||
files or patches you will be including from the layer.
|
||
|
||
Using the immediate expansion assignment operator ``:=`` is important
|
||
because of the reference to ``THISDIR``. The trailing colon character is
|
||
important as it ensures that items in the list remain colon-separated.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
BitBake automatically defines the ``THISDIR`` variable. You should
|
||
never set this variable yourself. Using "_prepend" as part of the
|
||
``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` ensures your path will be searched prior to other
|
||
paths in the final list.
|
||
|
||
Also, not all append files add extra files. Many append files simply
|
||
exist to add build options (e.g. ``systemd``). For these cases, your
|
||
append file would not even use the ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` statement.
|
||
|
||
Prioritizing Your Layer
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
Each layer is assigned a priority value. Priority values control which
|
||
layer takes precedence if there are recipe files with the same name in
|
||
multiple layers. For these cases, the recipe file from the layer with a
|
||
higher priority number takes precedence. Priority values also affect the
|
||
order in which multiple ``.bbappend`` files for the same recipe are
|
||
applied. You can either specify the priority manually, or allow the
|
||
build system to calculate it based on the layer's dependencies.
|
||
|
||
To specify the layer's priority manually, use the
|
||
:term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY`
|
||
variable and append the layer's root name: BBFILE_PRIORITY_mylayer = "1"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
It is possible for a recipe with a lower version number
|
||
:term:`PV` in a layer that has a higher
|
||
priority to take precedence.
|
||
|
||
Also, the layer priority does not currently affect the precedence
|
||
order of ``.conf`` or ``.bbclass`` files. Future versions of BitBake
|
||
might address this.
|
||
|
||
Managing Layers
|
||
---------------
|
||
|
||
You can use the BitBake layer management tool ``bitbake-layers`` to
|
||
provide a view into the structure of recipes across a multi-layer
|
||
project. Being able to generate output that reports on configured layers
|
||
with their paths and priorities and on ``.bbappend`` files and their
|
||
applicable recipes can help to reveal potential problems.
|
||
|
||
For help on the BitBake layer management tool, use the following
|
||
command: $ bitbake-layers --help NOTE: Starting bitbake server... usage:
|
||
bitbake-layers [-d] [-q] [-F] [--color COLOR] [-h] <subcommand> ...
|
||
BitBake layers utility optional arguments: -d, --debug Enable debug
|
||
output -q, --quiet Print only errors -F, --force Force add without
|
||
recipe parse verification --color COLOR Colorize output (where COLOR is
|
||
auto, always, never) -h, --help show this help message and exit
|
||
subcommands: <subcommand> show-layers show current configured layers.
|
||
show-overlayed list overlayed recipes (where the same recipe exists in
|
||
another layer) show-recipes list available recipes, showing the layer
|
||
they are provided by show-appends list bbappend files and recipe files
|
||
they apply to show-cross-depends Show dependencies between recipes that
|
||
cross layer boundaries. add-layer Add one or more layers to
|
||
bblayers.conf. remove-layer Remove one or more layers from
|
||
bblayers.conf. flatten flatten layer configuration into a separate
|
||
output directory. layerindex-fetch Fetches a layer from a layer index
|
||
along with its dependent layers, and adds them to conf/bblayers.conf.
|
||
layerindex-show-depends Find layer dependencies from layer index.
|
||
create-layer Create a basic layer Use bitbake-layers <subcommand> --help
|
||
to get help on a specific command
|
||
|
||
The following list describes the available commands:
|
||
|
||
- *``help:``* Displays general help or help on a specified command.
|
||
|
||
- *``show-layers:``* Shows the current configured layers.
|
||
|
||
- *``show-overlayed:``* Lists overlayed recipes. A recipe is overlayed
|
||
when a recipe with the same name exists in another layer that has a
|
||
higher layer priority.
|
||
|
||
- *``show-recipes:``* Lists available recipes and the layers that
|
||
provide them.
|
||
|
||
- *``show-appends:``* Lists ``.bbappend`` files and the recipe files to
|
||
which they apply.
|
||
|
||
- *``show-cross-depends:``* Lists dependency relationships between
|
||
recipes that cross layer boundaries.
|
||
|
||
- *``add-layer:``* Adds a layer to ``bblayers.conf``.
|
||
|
||
- *``remove-layer:``* Removes a layer from ``bblayers.conf``
|
||
|
||
- *``flatten:``* Flattens the layer configuration into a separate
|
||
output directory. Flattening your layer configuration builds a
|
||
"flattened" directory that contains the contents of all layers, with
|
||
any overlayed recipes removed and any ``.bbappend`` files appended to
|
||
the corresponding recipes. You might have to perform some manual
|
||
cleanup of the flattened layer as follows:
|
||
|
||
- Non-recipe files (such as patches) are overwritten. The flatten
|
||
command shows a warning for these files.
|
||
|
||
- Anything beyond the normal layer setup has been added to the
|
||
``layer.conf`` file. Only the lowest priority layer's
|
||
``layer.conf`` is used.
|
||
|
||
- Overridden and appended items from ``.bbappend`` files need to be
|
||
cleaned up. The contents of each ``.bbappend`` end up in the
|
||
flattened recipe. However, if there are appended or changed
|
||
variable values, you need to tidy these up yourself. Consider the
|
||
following example. Here, the ``bitbake-layers`` command adds the
|
||
line ``#### bbappended ...`` so that you know where the following
|
||
lines originate: ... DESCRIPTION = "A useful utility" ...
|
||
EXTRA_OECONF = "--enable-something" ... #### bbappended from
|
||
meta-anotherlayer #### DESCRIPTION = "Customized utility"
|
||
EXTRA_OECONF += "--enable-somethingelse" Ideally, you would tidy
|
||
up these utilities as follows: ... DESCRIPTION = "Customized
|
||
utility" ... EXTRA_OECONF = "--enable-something
|
||
--enable-somethingelse" ...
|
||
|
||
- *``layerindex-fetch``:* Fetches a layer from a layer index, along
|
||
with its dependent layers, and adds the layers to the
|
||
``conf/bblayers.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
- *``layerindex-show-depends``:* Finds layer dependencies from the
|
||
layer index.
|
||
|
||
- *``create-layer``:* Creates a basic layer.
|
||
|
||
Creating a General Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers`` Script
|
||
------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The ``bitbake-layers`` script with the ``create-layer`` subcommand
|
||
simplifies creating a new general layer.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- For information on BSP layers, see the "`BSP
|
||
Layers <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#bsp-layers>`__" section in the Yocto
|
||
Project Board Specific (BSP) Developer's Guide.
|
||
|
||
- In order to use a layer with the OpenEmbedded build system, you
|
||
need to add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` configuration
|
||
file. See the "`Adding a Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers``
|
||
Script <#adding-a-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__"
|
||
section for more information.
|
||
|
||
The default mode of the script's operation with this subcommand is to
|
||
create a layer with the following:
|
||
|
||
- A layer priority of 6.
|
||
|
||
- A ``conf`` subdirectory that contains a ``layer.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
- A ``recipes-example`` subdirectory that contains a further
|
||
subdirectory named ``example``, which contains an ``example.bb``
|
||
recipe file.
|
||
|
||
- A ``COPYING.MIT``, which is the license statement for the layer. The
|
||
script assumes you want to use the MIT license, which is typical for
|
||
most layers, for the contents of the layer itself.
|
||
|
||
- A ``README`` file, which is a file describing the contents of your
|
||
new layer.
|
||
|
||
In its simplest form, you can use the following command form to create a
|
||
layer. The command creates a layer whose name corresponds to
|
||
your_layer_name in the current directory: $ bitbake-layers create-layer
|
||
your_layer_name As an example, the following command creates a layer
|
||
named ``meta-scottrif`` in your home directory: $ cd /usr/home $
|
||
bitbake-layers create-layer meta-scottrif NOTE: Starting bitbake
|
||
server... Add your new layer with 'bitbake-layers add-layer
|
||
meta-scottrif'
|
||
|
||
If you want to set the priority of the layer to other than the default
|
||
value of "6", you can either use the ``DASHDASHpriority`` option or you
|
||
can edit the
|
||
:term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` value
|
||
in the ``conf/layer.conf`` after the script creates it. Furthermore, if
|
||
you want to give the example recipe file some name other than the
|
||
default, you can use the ``DASHDASHexample-recipe-name`` option.
|
||
|
||
The easiest way to see how the ``bitbake-layers create-layer`` command
|
||
works is to experiment with the script. You can also read the usage
|
||
information by entering the following: $ bitbake-layers create-layer
|
||
--help NOTE: Starting bitbake server... usage: bitbake-layers
|
||
create-layer [-h] [--priority PRIORITY] [--example-recipe-name
|
||
EXAMPLERECIPE] layerdir Create a basic layer positional arguments:
|
||
layerdir Layer directory to create optional arguments: -h, --help show
|
||
this help message and exit --priority PRIORITY, -p PRIORITY Layer
|
||
directory to create --example-recipe-name EXAMPLERECIPE, -e
|
||
EXAMPLERECIPE Filename of the example recipe
|
||
|
||
Adding a Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers`` Script
|
||
--------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Once you create your general layer, you must add it to your
|
||
``bblayers.conf`` file. Adding the layer to this configuration file
|
||
makes the OpenEmbedded build system aware of your layer so that it can
|
||
search it for metadata.
|
||
|
||
Add your layer by using the ``bitbake-layers add-layer`` command: $
|
||
bitbake-layers add-layer your_layer_name Here is an example that adds a
|
||
layer named ``meta-scottrif`` to the configuration file. Following the
|
||
command that adds the layer is another ``bitbake-layers`` command that
|
||
shows the layers that are in your ``bblayers.conf`` file: $
|
||
bitbake-layers add-layer meta-scottrif NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
|
||
Parsing recipes: 100%
|
||
\|##########################################################\| Time:
|
||
0:00:49 Parsing of 1441 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1441 parsed). 2055
|
||
targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors. $ bitbake-layers show-layers
|
||
NOTE: Starting bitbake server... layer path priority
|
||
==========================================================================
|
||
meta /home/scottrif/poky/meta 5 meta-poky /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky
|
||
5 meta-yocto-bsp /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp 5 workspace
|
||
/home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace 99 meta-scottrif
|
||
/home/scottrif/poky/build/meta-scottrif 6 Adding the layer to this file
|
||
enables the build system to locate the layer during the build.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system looks in the layers
|
||
from the top of the list down to the bottom in that order.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage:
|
||
|
||
Customizing Images
|
||
==================
|
||
|
||
You can customize images to satisfy particular requirements. This
|
||
section describes several methods and provides guidelines for each.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage-localconf:
|
||
|
||
Customizing Images Using ``local.conf``
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Probably the easiest way to customize an image is to add a package by
|
||
way of the ``local.conf`` configuration file. Because it is limited to
|
||
local use, this method generally only allows you to add packages and is
|
||
not as flexible as creating your own customized image. When you add
|
||
packages using local variables this way, you need to realize that these
|
||
variable changes are in effect for every build and consequently affect
|
||
all images, which might not be what you require.
|
||
|
||
To add a package to your image using the local configuration file, use
|
||
the ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable with the ``_append`` operator:
|
||
IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " strace" Use of the syntax is important -
|
||
specifically, the space between the quote and the package name, which is
|
||
``strace`` in this example. This space is required since the ``_append``
|
||
operator does not add the space.
|
||
|
||
Furthermore, you must use ``_append`` instead of the ``+=`` operator if
|
||
you want to avoid ordering issues. The reason for this is because doing
|
||
so unconditionally appends to the variable and avoids ordering problems
|
||
due to the variable being set in image recipes and ``.bbclass`` files
|
||
with operators like ``?=``. Using ``_append`` ensures the operation
|
||
takes affect.
|
||
|
||
As shown in its simplest use, ``IMAGE_INSTALL_append`` affects all
|
||
images. It is possible to extend the syntax so that the variable applies
|
||
to a specific image only. Here is an example:
|
||
IMAGE_INSTALL_append_pn-core-image-minimal = " strace" This example adds
|
||
``strace`` to the ``core-image-minimal`` image only.
|
||
|
||
You can add packages using a similar approach through the
|
||
``CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL`` variable. If you use this variable, only
|
||
``core-image-*`` images are affected.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures:
|
||
|
||
Customizing Images Using Custom ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES``
|
||
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Another method for customizing your image is to enable or disable
|
||
high-level image features by using the
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
|
||
variables. Although the functions for both variables are nearly
|
||
equivalent, best practices dictate using ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` from within
|
||
a recipe and using ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` from within your
|
||
``local.conf`` file, which is found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`.
|
||
|
||
To understand how these features work, the best reference is
|
||
``meta/classes/core-image.bbclass``. This class lists out the available
|
||
``IMAGE_FEATURES`` of which most map to package groups while some, such
|
||
as ``debug-tweaks`` and ``read-only-rootfs``, resolve as general
|
||
configuration settings.
|
||
|
||
In summary, the file looks at the contents of the ``IMAGE_FEATURES``
|
||
variable and then maps or configures the feature accordingly. Based on
|
||
this information, the build system automatically adds the appropriate
|
||
packages or configurations to the
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable.
|
||
Effectively, you are enabling extra features by extending the class or
|
||
creating a custom class for use with specialized image ``.bb`` files.
|
||
|
||
Use the ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` variable from within your local
|
||
configuration file. Using a separate area from which to enable features
|
||
with this variable helps you avoid overwriting the features in the image
|
||
recipe that are enabled with ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. The value of
|
||
``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` is added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` within
|
||
``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``.
|
||
|
||
To illustrate how you can use these variables to modify your image,
|
||
consider an example that selects the SSH server. The Yocto Project ships
|
||
with two SSH servers you can use with your images: Dropbear and OpenSSH.
|
||
Dropbear is a minimal SSH server appropriate for resource-constrained
|
||
environments, while OpenSSH is a well-known standard SSH server
|
||
implementation. By default, the ``core-image-sato`` image is configured
|
||
to use Dropbear. The ``core-image-full-cmdline`` and ``core-image-lsb``
|
||
images both include OpenSSH. The ``core-image-minimal`` image does not
|
||
contain an SSH server.
|
||
|
||
You can customize your image and change these defaults. Edit the
|
||
``IMAGE_FEATURES`` variable in your recipe or use the
|
||
``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` in your ``local.conf`` file so that it
|
||
configures the image you are working with to include
|
||
``ssh-server-dropbear`` or ``ssh-server-openssh``.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
See the "
|
||
Images
|
||
" section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual for a complete list
|
||
of image features that ship with the Yocto Project.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage-custombb:
|
||
|
||
Customizing Images Using Custom .bb Files
|
||
-----------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can also customize an image by creating a custom recipe that defines
|
||
additional software as part of the image. The following example shows
|
||
the form for the two lines you need: IMAGE_INSTALL =
|
||
"packagegroup-core-x11-base package1 package2" inherit core-image
|
||
|
||
Defining the software using a custom recipe gives you total control over
|
||
the contents of the image. It is important to use the correct names of
|
||
packages in the ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable. You must use the
|
||
OpenEmbedded notation and not the Debian notation for the names (e.g.
|
||
``glibc-dev`` instead of ``libc6-dev``).
|
||
|
||
The other method for creating a custom image is to base it on an
|
||
existing image. For example, if you want to create an image based on
|
||
``core-image-sato`` but add the additional package ``strace`` to the
|
||
image, copy the ``meta/recipes-sato/images/core-image-sato.bb`` to a new
|
||
``.bb`` and add the following line to the end of the copy: IMAGE_INSTALL
|
||
+= "strace"
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage-customtasks:
|
||
|
||
Customizing Images Using Custom Package Groups
|
||
----------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
For complex custom images, the best approach for customizing an image is
|
||
to create a custom package group recipe that is used to build the image
|
||
or images. A good example of a package group recipe is
|
||
``meta/recipes-core/packagegroups/packagegroup-base.bb``.
|
||
|
||
If you examine that recipe, you see that the ``PACKAGES`` variable lists
|
||
the package group packages to produce. The ``inherit packagegroup``
|
||
statement sets appropriate default values and automatically adds
|
||
``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and ``-ptest`` complementary packages for each
|
||
package specified in the ``PACKAGES`` statement.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The
|
||
inherit packagegroup
|
||
line should be located near the top of the recipe, certainly before
|
||
the
|
||
PACKAGES
|
||
statement.
|
||
|
||
For each package you specify in ``PACKAGES``, you can use ``RDEPENDS``
|
||
and ``RRECOMMENDS`` entries to provide a list of packages the parent
|
||
task package should contain. You can see examples of these further down
|
||
in the ``packagegroup-base.bb`` recipe.
|
||
|
||
Here is a short, fabricated example showing the same basic pieces for a
|
||
hypothetical packagegroup defined in ``packagegroup-custom.bb``, where
|
||
the variable ``PN`` is the standard way to abbreviate the reference to
|
||
the full packagegroup name ``packagegroup-custom``: DESCRIPTION = "My
|
||
Custom Package Groups" inherit packagegroup PACKAGES = "\\ ${PN}-apps \\
|
||
${PN}-tools \\ " RDEPENDS_${PN}-apps = "\\ dropbear \\ portmap \\
|
||
psplash" RDEPENDS_${PN}-tools = "\\ oprofile \\ oprofileui-server \\
|
||
lttng-tools" RRECOMMENDS_${PN}-tools = "\\ kernel-module-oprofile"
|
||
|
||
In the previous example, two package group packages are created with
|
||
their dependencies and their recommended package dependencies listed:
|
||
``packagegroup-custom-apps``, and ``packagegroup-custom-tools``. To
|
||
build an image using these package group packages, you need to add
|
||
``packagegroup-custom-apps`` and/or ``packagegroup-custom-tools`` to
|
||
``IMAGE_INSTALL``. For other forms of image dependencies see the other
|
||
areas of this section.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-extend-customimage-image-name:
|
||
|
||
Customizing an Image Hostname
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
By default, the configured hostname (i.e. ``/etc/hostname``) in an image
|
||
is the same as the machine name. For example, if
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` equals "qemux86", the
|
||
configured hostname written to ``/etc/hostname`` is "qemux86".
|
||
|
||
You can customize this name by altering the value of the "hostname"
|
||
variable in the ``base-files`` recipe using either an append file or a
|
||
configuration file. Use the following in an append file:
|
||
hostname="myhostname" Use the following in a configuration file:
|
||
hostname_pn-base-files = "myhostname"
|
||
|
||
Changing the default value of the variable "hostname" can be useful in
|
||
certain situations. For example, suppose you need to do extensive
|
||
testing on an image and you would like to easily identify the image
|
||
under test from existing images with typical default hostnames. In this
|
||
situation, you could change the default hostname to "testme", which
|
||
results in all the images using the name "testme". Once testing is
|
||
complete and you do not need to rebuild the image for test any longer,
|
||
you can easily reset the default hostname.
|
||
|
||
Another point of interest is that if you unset the variable, the image
|
||
will have no default hostname in the filesystem. Here is an example that
|
||
unsets the variable in a configuration file: hostname_pn-base-files = ""
|
||
Having no default hostname in the filesystem is suitable for
|
||
environments that use dynamic hostnames such as virtual machines.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-writing-a-new-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Writing a New Recipe
|
||
====================
|
||
|
||
Recipes (``.bb`` files) are fundamental components in the Yocto Project
|
||
environment. Each software component built by the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system requires a recipe to define the component. This section describes
|
||
how to create, write, and test a new recipe.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For information on variables that are useful for recipes and for
|
||
information about recipe naming issues, see the "
|
||
Required
|
||
" section of the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-overview:
|
||
|
||
Overview
|
||
--------
|
||
|
||
The following figure shows the basic process for creating a new recipe.
|
||
The remainder of the section provides details for the steps.
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/recipe-workflow.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-locate-or-automatically-create-a-base-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Locate or Automatically Create a Base Recipe
|
||
--------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can always write a recipe from scratch. However, three choices exist
|
||
that can help you quickly get a start on a new recipe:
|
||
|
||
- *``devtool add``:* A command that assists in creating a recipe and an
|
||
environment conducive to development.
|
||
|
||
- *``recipetool create``:* A command provided by the Yocto Project that
|
||
automates creation of a base recipe based on the source files.
|
||
|
||
- *Existing Recipes:* Location and modification of an existing recipe
|
||
that is similar in function to the recipe you need.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For information on recipe syntax, see the "
|
||
Recipe Syntax
|
||
" section.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-creating-the-base-recipe-using-devtool:
|
||
|
||
Creating the Base Recipe Using ``devtool add``
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The ``devtool add`` command uses the same logic for auto-creating the
|
||
recipe as ``recipetool create``, which is listed below. Additionally,
|
||
however, ``devtool add`` sets up an environment that makes it easy for
|
||
you to patch the source and to make changes to the recipe as is often
|
||
necessary when adding a recipe to build a new piece of software to be
|
||
included in a build.
|
||
|
||
You can find a complete description of the ``devtool add`` command in
|
||
the "`A Closer Look at ``devtool``
|
||
add <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-a-closer-look-at-devtool-add>`__" section
|
||
in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible Software
|
||
Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-creating-the-base-recipe-using-recipetool:
|
||
|
||
Creating the Base Recipe Using ``recipetool create``
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
``recipetool create`` automates creation of a base recipe given a set of
|
||
source code files. As long as you can extract or point to the source
|
||
files, the tool will construct a recipe and automatically configure all
|
||
pre-build information into the recipe. For example, suppose you have an
|
||
application that builds using Autotools. Creating the base recipe using
|
||
``recipetool`` results in a recipe that has the pre-build dependencies,
|
||
license requirements, and checksums configured.
|
||
|
||
To run the tool, you just need to be in your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` and have sourced the
|
||
build environment setup script (i.e.
|
||
```oe-init-build-env`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__).
|
||
To get help on the tool, use the following command: $ recipetool -h
|
||
NOTE: Starting bitbake server... usage: recipetool [-d] [-q] [--color
|
||
COLOR] [-h] <subcommand> ... OpenEmbedded recipe tool options: -d,
|
||
--debug Enable debug output -q, --quiet Print only errors --color COLOR
|
||
Colorize output (where COLOR is auto, always, never) -h, --help show
|
||
this help message and exit subcommands: create Create a new recipe
|
||
newappend Create a bbappend for the specified target in the specified
|
||
layer setvar Set a variable within a recipe appendfile Create/update a
|
||
bbappend to replace a target file appendsrcfiles Create/update a
|
||
bbappend to add or replace source files appendsrcfile Create/update a
|
||
bbappend to add or replace a source file Use recipetool <subcommand>
|
||
--help to get help on a specific command
|
||
|
||
Running ``recipetool create -o`` OUTFILE creates the base recipe and
|
||
locates it properly in the layer that contains your source files.
|
||
Following are some syntax examples:
|
||
|
||
Use this syntax to generate a recipe based on source. Once generated,
|
||
the recipe resides in the existing source code layer: recipetool create
|
||
-o OUTFILE source Use this syntax to generate a recipe using code that
|
||
you extract from source. The extracted code is placed in its own layer
|
||
defined by EXTERNALSRC. recipetool create -o OUTFILE -x EXTERNALSRC
|
||
source Use this syntax to generate a recipe based on source. The options
|
||
direct ``recipetool`` to generate debugging information. Once generated,
|
||
the recipe resides in the existing source code layer: recipetool create
|
||
-d -o OUTFILE source
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-locating-and-using-a-similar-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Locating and Using a Similar Recipe
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Before writing a recipe from scratch, it is often useful to discover
|
||
whether someone else has already written one that meets (or comes close
|
||
to meeting) your needs. The Yocto Project and OpenEmbedded communities
|
||
maintain many recipes that might be candidates for what you are doing.
|
||
You can find a good central index of these recipes in the `OpenEmbedded
|
||
Layer Index <http://layers.openembedded.org>`__.
|
||
|
||
Working from an existing recipe or a skeleton recipe is the best way to
|
||
get started. Here are some points on both methods:
|
||
|
||
- *Locate and modify a recipe that is close to what you want to do:*
|
||
This method works when you are familiar with the current recipe
|
||
space. The method does not work so well for those new to the Yocto
|
||
Project or writing recipes.
|
||
|
||
Some risks associated with this method are using a recipe that has
|
||
areas totally unrelated to what you are trying to accomplish with
|
||
your recipe, not recognizing areas of the recipe that you might have
|
||
to add from scratch, and so forth. All these risks stem from
|
||
unfamiliarity with the existing recipe space.
|
||
|
||
- *Use and modify the following skeleton recipe:* If for some reason
|
||
you do not want to use ``recipetool`` and you cannot find an existing
|
||
recipe that is close to meeting your needs, you can use the following
|
||
structure to provide the fundamental areas of a new recipe.
|
||
DESCRIPTION = "" HOMEPAGE = "" LICENSE = "" SECTION = "" DEPENDS = ""
|
||
LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "" SRC_URI = ""
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-storing-and-naming-the-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Storing and Naming the Recipe
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
Once you have your base recipe, you should put it in your own layer and
|
||
name it appropriately. Locating it correctly ensures that the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system can find it when you use BitBake to process
|
||
the recipe.
|
||
|
||
- *Storing Your Recipe:* The OpenEmbedded build system locates your
|
||
recipe through the layer's ``conf/layer.conf`` file and the
|
||
:term:`BBFILES` variable. This
|
||
variable sets up a path from which the build system can locate
|
||
recipes. Here is the typical use: BBFILES +=
|
||
"${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bb \\ ${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bbappend"
|
||
Consequently, you need to be sure you locate your new recipe inside
|
||
your layer such that it can be found.
|
||
|
||
You can find more information on how layers are structured in the
|
||
"`Understanding and Creating
|
||
Layers <#understanding-and-creating-layers>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
- *Naming Your Recipe:* When you name your recipe, you need to follow
|
||
this naming convention: basename_version.bb Use lower-cased
|
||
characters and do not include the reserved suffixes ``-native``,
|
||
``-cross``, ``-initial``, or ``-dev`` casually (i.e. do not use them
|
||
as part of your recipe name unless the string applies). Here are some
|
||
examples: cups_1.7.0.bb gawk_4.0.2.bb irssi_0.8.16-rc1.bb
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-running-a-build-on-the-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Running a Build on the Recipe
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
Creating a new recipe is usually an iterative process that requires
|
||
using BitBake to process the recipe multiple times in order to
|
||
progressively discover and add information to the recipe file.
|
||
|
||
Assuming you have sourced the build environment setup script (i.e.
|
||
````` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__) and you are in
|
||
the :term:`Build Directory`, use
|
||
BitBake to process your recipe. All you need to provide is the
|
||
``basename`` of the recipe as described in the previous section: $
|
||
bitbake basename
|
||
|
||
During the build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a temporary work
|
||
directory for each recipe
|
||
(``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}``)
|
||
where it keeps extracted source files, log files, intermediate
|
||
compilation and packaging files, and so forth.
|
||
|
||
The path to the per-recipe temporary work directory depends on the
|
||
context in which it is being built. The quickest way to find this path
|
||
is to have BitBake return it by running the following: $ bitbake -e
|
||
basename \| grep ^WORKDIR= As an example, assume a Source Directory
|
||
top-level folder named ``poky``, a default Build Directory at
|
||
``poky/build``, and a ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system.
|
||
Furthermore, suppose your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0.bb``. In this
|
||
case, the work directory the build system uses to build the package
|
||
would be as follows: poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0
|
||
Inside this directory you can find sub-directories such as ``image``,
|
||
``packages-split``, and ``temp``. After the build, you can examine these
|
||
to determine how well the build went.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can find log files for each task in the recipe's
|
||
temp
|
||
directory (e.g.
|
||
poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0/temp
|
||
). Log files are named
|
||
log.
|
||
taskname
|
||
(e.g.
|
||
log.do_configure
|
||
,
|
||
log.do_fetch
|
||
, and
|
||
log.do_compile
|
||
).
|
||
|
||
You can find more information about the build process in "`The Yocto
|
||
Project Development
|
||
Environment <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#overview-development-environment>`__"
|
||
chapter of the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-fetching-code:
|
||
|
||
Fetching Code
|
||
-------------
|
||
|
||
The first thing your recipe must do is specify how to fetch the source
|
||
files. Fetching is controlled mainly through the
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` variable. Your recipe
|
||
must have a ``SRC_URI`` variable that points to where the source is
|
||
located. For a graphical representation of source locations, see the
|
||
"`Sources <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#sources-dev-environment>`__" section in
|
||
the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
The :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` task uses
|
||
the prefix of each entry in the ``SRC_URI`` variable value to determine
|
||
which `fetcher <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#bb-fetchers>`__ to use to get your
|
||
source files. It is the ``SRC_URI`` variable that triggers the fetcher.
|
||
The :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task uses
|
||
the variable after source is fetched to apply patches. The OpenEmbedded
|
||
build system uses
|
||
:term:`FILESOVERRIDES` for
|
||
scanning directory locations for local files in ``SRC_URI``.
|
||
|
||
The ``SRC_URI`` variable in your recipe must define each unique location
|
||
for your source files. It is good practice to not hard-code version
|
||
numbers in a URL used in ``SRC_URI``. Rather than hard-code these
|
||
values, use ``${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``,
|
||
which causes the fetch process to use the version specified in the
|
||
recipe filename. Specifying the version in this manner means that
|
||
upgrading the recipe to a future version is as simple as renaming the
|
||
recipe to match the new version.
|
||
|
||
Here is a simple example from the
|
||
``meta/recipes-devtools/strace/strace_5.5.bb`` recipe where the source
|
||
comes from a single tarball. Notice the use of the
|
||
:term:`PV` variable: SRC_URI =
|
||
"https://strace.io/files/${PV}/strace-${PV}.tar.xz \\
|
||
|
||
Files mentioned in ``SRC_URI`` whose names end in a typical archive
|
||
extension (e.g. ``.tar``, ``.tar.gz``, ``.tar.bz2``, ``.zip``, and so
|
||
forth), are automatically extracted during the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task. For
|
||
another example that specifies these types of files, see the
|
||
"`Autotooled Package <#new-recipe-autotooled-package>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
Another way of specifying source is from an SCM. For Git repositories,
|
||
you must specify :term:`SRCREV` and
|
||
you should specify :term:`PV` to include
|
||
the revision with :term:`SRCPV`. Here
|
||
is an example from the recipe
|
||
``meta/recipes-kernel/blktrace/blktrace_git.bb``: SRCREV =
|
||
"d6918c8832793b4205ed3bfede78c2f915c23385" PR = "r6" PV =
|
||
"1.0.5+git${SRCPV}" SRC_URI = "git://git.kernel.dk/blktrace.git \\
|
||
file://ldflags.patch"
|
||
|
||
If your ``SRC_URI`` statement includes URLs pointing to individual files
|
||
fetched from a remote server other than a version control system,
|
||
BitBake attempts to verify the files against checksums defined in your
|
||
recipe to ensure they have not been tampered with or otherwise modified
|
||
since the recipe was written. Two checksums are used:
|
||
``SRC_URI[md5sum]`` and ``SRC_URI[sha256sum]``.
|
||
|
||
If your ``SRC_URI`` variable points to more than a single URL (excluding
|
||
SCM URLs), you need to provide the ``md5`` and ``sha256`` checksums for
|
||
each URL. For these cases, you provide a name for each URL as part of
|
||
the ``SRC_URI`` and then reference that name in the subsequent checksum
|
||
statements. Here is an example combining lines from the files
|
||
``git.inc`` and ``git_2.24.1.bb``: SRC_URI =
|
||
"${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/software/scm/git/git-${PV}.tar.gz;name=tarball \\
|
||
${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/software/scm/git/git-manpages-${PV}.tar.gz;name=manpages"
|
||
SRC_URI[tarball.md5sum] = "166bde96adbbc11c8843d4f8f4f9811b"
|
||
SRC_URI[tarball.sha256sum] =
|
||
"ad5334956301c86841eb1e5b1bb20884a6bad89a10a6762c958220c7cf64da02"
|
||
SRC_URI[manpages.md5sum] = "31c2272a8979022497ba3d4202df145d"
|
||
SRC_URI[manpages.sha256sum] =
|
||
"9a7ae3a093bea39770eb96ca3e5b40bff7af0b9f6123f089d7821d0e5b8e1230"
|
||
|
||
Proper values for ``md5`` and ``sha256`` checksums might be available
|
||
with other signatures on the download page for the upstream source (e.g.
|
||
``md5``, ``sha1``, ``sha256``, ``GPG``, and so forth). Because the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system only deals with ``sha256sum`` and ``md5sum``,
|
||
you should verify all the signatures you find by hand.
|
||
|
||
If no ``SRC_URI`` checksums are specified when you attempt to build the
|
||
recipe, or you provide an incorrect checksum, the build will produce an
|
||
error for each missing or incorrect checksum. As part of the error
|
||
message, the build system provides the checksum string corresponding to
|
||
the fetched file. Once you have the correct checksums, you can copy and
|
||
paste them into your recipe and then run the build again to continue.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
As mentioned, if the upstream source provides signatures for
|
||
verifying the downloaded source code, you should verify those
|
||
manually before setting the checksum values in the recipe and
|
||
continuing with the build.
|
||
|
||
This final example is a bit more complicated and is from the
|
||
``meta/recipes-sato/rxvt-unicode/rxvt-unicode_9.20.bb`` recipe. The
|
||
example's ``SRC_URI`` statement identifies multiple files as the source
|
||
files for the recipe: a tarball, a patch file, a desktop file, and an
|
||
icon. SRC_URI =
|
||
"http://dist.schmorp.de/rxvt-unicode/Attic/rxvt-unicode-${PV}.tar.bz2 \\
|
||
file://xwc.patch \\ file://rxvt.desktop \\ file://rxvt.png"
|
||
|
||
When you specify local files using the ``file://`` URI protocol, the
|
||
build system fetches files from the local machine. The path is relative
|
||
to the :term:`FILESPATH` variable
|
||
and searches specific directories in a certain order:
|
||
``${``\ :term:`BP`\ ``}``,
|
||
``${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}``, and
|
||
``files``. The directories are assumed to be subdirectories of the
|
||
directory in which the recipe or append file resides. For another
|
||
example that specifies these types of files, see the "`Single .c File
|
||
Package (Hello
|
||
World!) <#new-recipe-single-c-file-package-hello-world>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
The previous example also specifies a patch file. Patch files are files
|
||
whose names usually end in ``.patch`` or ``.diff`` but can end with
|
||
compressed suffixes such as ``diff.gz`` and ``patch.bz2``, for example.
|
||
The build system automatically applies patches as described in the
|
||
"`Patching Code <#new-recipe-patching-code>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-unpacking-code:
|
||
|
||
Unpacking Code
|
||
--------------
|
||
|
||
During the build, the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task unpacks
|
||
the source with ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``
|
||
pointing to where it is unpacked.
|
||
|
||
If you are fetching your source files from an upstream source archived
|
||
tarball and the tarball's internal structure matches the common
|
||
convention of a top-level subdirectory named
|
||
``${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}-${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``,
|
||
then you do not need to set ``S``. However, if ``SRC_URI`` specifies to
|
||
fetch source from an archive that does not use this convention, or from
|
||
an SCM like Git or Subversion, your recipe needs to define ``S``.
|
||
|
||
If processing your recipe using BitBake successfully unpacks the source
|
||
files, you need to be sure that the directory pointed to by ``${S}``
|
||
matches the structure of the source.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-patching-code:
|
||
|
||
Patching Code
|
||
-------------
|
||
|
||
Sometimes it is necessary to patch code after it has been fetched. Any
|
||
files mentioned in ``SRC_URI`` whose names end in ``.patch`` or
|
||
``.diff`` or compressed versions of these suffixes (e.g. ``diff.gz`` are
|
||
treated as patches. The
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task
|
||
automatically applies these patches.
|
||
|
||
The build system should be able to apply patches with the "-p1" option
|
||
(i.e. one directory level in the path will be stripped off). If your
|
||
patch needs to have more directory levels stripped off, specify the
|
||
number of levels using the "striplevel" option in the ``SRC_URI`` entry
|
||
for the patch. Alternatively, if your patch needs to be applied in a
|
||
specific subdirectory that is not specified in the patch file, use the
|
||
"patchdir" option in the entry.
|
||
|
||
As with all local files referenced in
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` using ``file://``,
|
||
you should place patch files in a directory next to the recipe either
|
||
named the same as the base name of the recipe
|
||
(:term:`BP` and
|
||
:term:`BPN`) or "files".
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-licensing:
|
||
|
||
Licensing
|
||
---------
|
||
|
||
Your recipe needs to have both the
|
||
:term:`LICENSE` and
|
||
:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
|
||
variables:
|
||
|
||
- *``LICENSE``:* This variable specifies the license for the software.
|
||
If you do not know the license under which the software you are
|
||
building is distributed, you should go to the source code and look
|
||
for that information. Typical files containing this information
|
||
include ``COPYING``, ``LICENSE``, and ``README`` files. You could
|
||
also find the information near the top of a source file. For example,
|
||
given a piece of software licensed under the GNU General Public
|
||
License version 2, you would set ``LICENSE`` as follows: LICENSE =
|
||
"GPLv2"
|
||
|
||
The licenses you specify within ``LICENSE`` can have any name as long
|
||
as you do not use spaces, since spaces are used as separators between
|
||
license names. For standard licenses, use the names of the files in
|
||
``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the ``SPDXLICENSEMAP`` flag names
|
||
defined in ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``.
|
||
|
||
- *``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM``:* The OpenEmbedded build system uses this
|
||
variable to make sure the license text has not changed. If it has,
|
||
the build produces an error and it affords you the chance to figure
|
||
it out and correct the problem.
|
||
|
||
You need to specify all applicable licensing files for the software.
|
||
At the end of the configuration step, the build process will compare
|
||
the checksums of the files to be sure the text has not changed. Any
|
||
differences result in an error with the message containing the
|
||
current checksum. For more explanation and examples of how to set the
|
||
``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable, see the "`Tracking License
|
||
Changes <#>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
To determine the correct checksum string, you can list the
|
||
appropriate files in the ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable with incorrect
|
||
md5 strings, attempt to build the software, and then note the
|
||
resulting error messages that will report the correct md5 strings.
|
||
See the "`Fetching Code <#new-recipe-fetching-code>`__" section for
|
||
additional information.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example that assumes the software has a ``COPYING`` file:
|
||
LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=xxx" When you try to build the
|
||
software, the build system will produce an error and give you the
|
||
correct string that you can substitute into the recipe file for a
|
||
subsequent build.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-dependencies:
|
||
|
||
Dependencies
|
||
------------
|
||
|
||
Most software packages have a short list of other packages that they
|
||
require, which are called dependencies. These dependencies fall into two
|
||
main categories: build-time dependencies, which are required when the
|
||
software is built; and runtime dependencies, which are required to be
|
||
installed on the target in order for the software to run.
|
||
|
||
Within a recipe, you specify build-time dependencies using the
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS` variable. Although
|
||
nuances exist, items specified in ``DEPENDS`` should be names of other
|
||
recipes. It is important that you specify all build-time dependencies
|
||
explicitly. If you do not, due to the parallel nature of BitBake's
|
||
execution, you can end up with a race condition where the dependency is
|
||
present for one task of a recipe (e.g.
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure`) and
|
||
then gone when the next task runs (e.g.
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-compile`).
|
||
|
||
Another consideration is that configure scripts might automatically
|
||
check for optional dependencies and enable corresponding functionality
|
||
if those dependencies are found. This behavior means that to ensure
|
||
deterministic results and thus avoid more race conditions, you need to
|
||
either explicitly specify these dependencies as well, or tell the
|
||
configure script explicitly to disable the functionality. If you wish to
|
||
make a recipe that is more generally useful (e.g. publish the recipe in
|
||
a layer for others to use), instead of hard-disabling the functionality,
|
||
you can use the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGECONFIG` variable
|
||
to allow functionality and the corresponding dependencies to be enabled
|
||
and disabled easily by other users of the recipe.
|
||
|
||
Similar to build-time dependencies, you specify runtime dependencies
|
||
through a variable -
|
||
:term:`RDEPENDS`, which is
|
||
package-specific. All variables that are package-specific need to have
|
||
the name of the package added to the end as an override. Since the main
|
||
package for a recipe has the same name as the recipe, and the recipe's
|
||
name can be found through the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` variable, then
|
||
you specify the dependencies for the main package by setting
|
||
``RDEPENDS_${PN}``. If the package were named ``${PN}-tools``, then you
|
||
would set ``RDEPENDS_${PN}-tools``, and so forth.
|
||
|
||
Some runtime dependencies will be set automatically at packaging time.
|
||
These dependencies include any shared library dependencies (i.e. if a
|
||
package "example" contains "libexample" and another package "mypackage"
|
||
contains a binary that links to "libexample" then the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system will automatically add a runtime dependency to "mypackage" on
|
||
"example"). See the "`Automatically Added Runtime
|
||
Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for further
|
||
details.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-configuring-the-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Configuring the Recipe
|
||
----------------------
|
||
|
||
Most software provides some means of setting build-time configuration
|
||
options before compilation. Typically, setting these options is
|
||
accomplished by running a configure script with options, or by modifying
|
||
a build configuration file.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
As of Yocto Project Release 1.7, some of the core recipes that
|
||
package binary configuration scripts now disable the scripts due to
|
||
the scripts previously requiring error-prone path substitution. The
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system uses
|
||
pkg-config
|
||
now, which is much more robust. You can find a list of the
|
||
\*-config
|
||
scripts that are disabled list in the "
|
||
Binary Configuration Scripts Disabled
|
||
" section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
A major part of build-time configuration is about checking for
|
||
build-time dependencies and possibly enabling optional functionality as
|
||
a result. You need to specify any build-time dependencies for the
|
||
software you are building in your recipe's
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS` value, in terms of
|
||
other recipes that satisfy those dependencies. You can often find
|
||
build-time or runtime dependencies described in the software's
|
||
documentation.
|
||
|
||
The following list provides configuration items of note based on how
|
||
your software is built:
|
||
|
||
- *Autotools:* If your source files have a ``configure.ac`` file, then
|
||
your software is built using Autotools. If this is the case, you just
|
||
need to worry about modifying the configuration.
|
||
|
||
When using Autotools, your recipe needs to inherit the
|
||
:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class
|
||
and your recipe does not have to contain a
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
|
||
However, you might still want to make some adjustments. For example,
|
||
you can set
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or
|
||
:term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
|
||
to pass any needed configure options that are specific to the recipe.
|
||
|
||
- *CMake:* If your source files have a ``CMakeLists.txt`` file, then
|
||
your software is built using CMake. If this is the case, you just
|
||
need to worry about modifying the configuration.
|
||
|
||
When you use CMake, your recipe needs to inherit the
|
||
:ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class and your
|
||
recipe does not have to contain a
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
|
||
You can make some adjustments by setting
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE` to
|
||
pass any needed configure options that are specific to the recipe.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you need to install one or more custom CMake toolchain files
|
||
that are supplied by the application you are building, install the
|
||
files to
|
||
${D}${datadir}/cmake/
|
||
Modules during
|
||
do_install
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
- *Other:* If your source files do not have a ``configure.ac`` or
|
||
``CMakeLists.txt`` file, then your software is built using some
|
||
method other than Autotools or CMake. If this is the case, you
|
||
normally need to provide a
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task
|
||
in your recipe unless, of course, there is nothing to configure.
|
||
|
||
Even if your software is not being built by Autotools or CMake, you
|
||
still might not need to deal with any configuration issues. You need
|
||
to determine if configuration is even a required step. You might need
|
||
to modify a Makefile or some configuration file used for the build to
|
||
specify necessary build options. Or, perhaps you might need to run a
|
||
provided, custom configure script with the appropriate options.
|
||
|
||
For the case involving a custom configure script, you would run
|
||
``./configure --help`` and look for the options you need to set.
|
||
|
||
Once configuration succeeds, it is always good practice to look at the
|
||
``log.do_configure`` file to ensure that the appropriate options have
|
||
been enabled and no additional build-time dependencies need to be added
|
||
to ``DEPENDS``. For example, if the configure script reports that it
|
||
found something not mentioned in ``DEPENDS``, or that it did not find
|
||
something that it needed for some desired optional functionality, then
|
||
you would need to add those to ``DEPENDS``. Looking at the log might
|
||
also reveal items being checked for, enabled, or both that you do not
|
||
want, or items not being found that are in ``DEPENDS``, in which case
|
||
you would need to look at passing extra options to the configure script
|
||
as needed. For reference information on configure options specific to
|
||
the software you are building, you can consult the output of the
|
||
``./configure --help`` command within ``${S}`` or consult the software's
|
||
upstream documentation.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-using-headers-to-interface-with-devices:
|
||
|
||
Using Headers to Interface with Devices
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
If your recipe builds an application that needs to communicate with some
|
||
device or needs an API into a custom kernel, you will need to provide
|
||
appropriate header files. Under no circumstances should you ever modify
|
||
the existing
|
||
``meta/recipes-kernel/linux-libc-headers/linux-libc-headers.inc`` file.
|
||
These headers are used to build ``libc`` and must not be compromised
|
||
with custom or machine-specific header information. If you customize
|
||
``libc`` through modified headers all other applications that use
|
||
``libc`` thus become affected.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Never copy and customize the
|
||
libc
|
||
header file (i.e.
|
||
meta/recipes-kernel/linux-libc-headers/linux-libc-headers.inc
|
||
).
|
||
|
||
The correct way to interface to a device or custom kernel is to use a
|
||
separate package that provides the additional headers for the driver or
|
||
other unique interfaces. When doing so, your application also becomes
|
||
responsible for creating a dependency on that specific provider.
|
||
|
||
Consider the following:
|
||
|
||
- Never modify ``linux-libc-headers.inc``. Consider that file to be
|
||
part of the ``libc`` system, and not something you use to access the
|
||
kernel directly. You should access ``libc`` through specific ``libc``
|
||
calls.
|
||
|
||
- Applications that must talk directly to devices should either provide
|
||
necessary headers themselves, or establish a dependency on a special
|
||
headers package that is specific to that driver.
|
||
|
||
For example, suppose you want to modify an existing header that adds I/O
|
||
control or network support. If the modifications are used by a small
|
||
number programs, providing a unique version of a header is easy and has
|
||
little impact. When doing so, bear in mind the guidelines in the
|
||
previous list.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If for some reason your changes need to modify the behavior of the
|
||
libc
|
||
, and subsequently all other applications on the system, use a
|
||
.bbappend
|
||
to modify the
|
||
linux-kernel-headers.inc
|
||
file. However, take care to not make the changes machine specific.
|
||
|
||
Consider a case where your kernel is older and you need an older
|
||
``libc`` ABI. The headers installed by your recipe should still be a
|
||
standard mainline kernel, not your own custom one.
|
||
|
||
When you use custom kernel headers you need to get them from
|
||
:term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR`,
|
||
which is the directory with kernel headers that are required to build
|
||
out-of-tree modules. Your recipe will also need the following:
|
||
do_configure[depends] += "virtual/kernel:do_shared_workdir"
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-compilation:
|
||
|
||
Compilation
|
||
-----------
|
||
|
||
During a build, the ``do_compile`` task happens after source is fetched,
|
||
unpacked, and configured. If the recipe passes through ``do_compile``
|
||
successfully, nothing needs to be done.
|
||
|
||
However, if the compile step fails, you need to diagnose the failure.
|
||
Here are some common issues that cause failures.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For cases where improper paths are detected for configuration files
|
||
or for when libraries/headers cannot be found, be sure you are using
|
||
the more robust
|
||
pkg-config
|
||
. See the note in section "
|
||
Configuring the Recipe
|
||
" for additional information.
|
||
|
||
- *Parallel build failures:* These failures manifest themselves as
|
||
intermittent errors, or errors reporting that a file or directory
|
||
that should be created by some other part of the build process could
|
||
not be found. This type of failure can occur even if, upon
|
||
inspection, the file or directory does exist after the build has
|
||
failed, because that part of the build process happened in the wrong
|
||
order.
|
||
|
||
To fix the problem, you need to either satisfy the missing dependency
|
||
in the Makefile or whatever script produced the Makefile, or (as a
|
||
workaround) set
|
||
:term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` to an
|
||
empty string: PARALLEL_MAKE = ""
|
||
|
||
For information on parallel Makefile issues, see the "`Debugging
|
||
Parallel Make Races <#debugging-parallel-make-races>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
- *Improper host path usage:* This failure applies to recipes building
|
||
for the target or ``nativesdk`` only. The failure occurs when the
|
||
compilation process uses improper headers, libraries, or other files
|
||
from the host system when cross-compiling for the target.
|
||
|
||
To fix the problem, examine the ``log.do_compile`` file to identify
|
||
the host paths being used (e.g. ``/usr/include``, ``/usr/lib``, and
|
||
so forth) and then either add configure options, apply a patch, or do
|
||
both.
|
||
|
||
- *Failure to find required libraries/headers:* If a build-time
|
||
dependency is missing because it has not been declared in
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS`, or because the
|
||
dependency exists but the path used by the build process to find the
|
||
file is incorrect and the configure step did not detect it, the
|
||
compilation process could fail. For either of these failures, the
|
||
compilation process notes that files could not be found. In these
|
||
cases, you need to go back and add additional options to the
|
||
configure script as well as possibly add additional build-time
|
||
dependencies to ``DEPENDS``.
|
||
|
||
Occasionally, it is necessary to apply a patch to the source to
|
||
ensure the correct paths are used. If you need to specify paths to
|
||
find files staged into the sysroot from other recipes, use the
|
||
variables that the OpenEmbedded build system provides (e.g.
|
||
``STAGING_BINDIR``, ``STAGING_INCDIR``, ``STAGING_DATADIR``, and so
|
||
forth).
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-installing:
|
||
|
||
Installing
|
||
----------
|
||
|
||
During ``do_install``, the task copies the built files along with their
|
||
hierarchy to locations that would mirror their locations on the target
|
||
device. The installation process copies files from the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``,
|
||
``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``, and
|
||
``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}``
|
||
directories to the ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``
|
||
directory to create the structure as it should appear on the target
|
||
system.
|
||
|
||
How your software is built affects what you must do to be sure your
|
||
software is installed correctly. The following list describes what you
|
||
must do for installation depending on the type of build system used by
|
||
the software being built:
|
||
|
||
- *Autotools and CMake:* If the software your recipe is building uses
|
||
Autotools or CMake, the OpenEmbedded build system understands how to
|
||
install the software. Consequently, you do not have to have a
|
||
``do_install`` task as part of your recipe. You just need to make
|
||
sure the install portion of the build completes with no issues.
|
||
However, if you wish to install additional files not already being
|
||
installed by ``make install``, you should do this using a
|
||
``do_install_append`` function using the install command as described
|
||
in the "Manual" bulleted item later in this list.
|
||
|
||
- *Other (using ``make install``):* You need to define a ``do_install``
|
||
function in your recipe. The function should call
|
||
``oe_runmake install`` and will likely need to pass in the
|
||
destination directory as well. How you pass that path is dependent on
|
||
how the ``Makefile`` being run is written (e.g. ``DESTDIR=${D}``,
|
||
``PREFIX=${D}``, ``INSTALLROOT=${D}``, and so forth).
|
||
|
||
For an example recipe using ``make install``, see the
|
||
"`Makefile-Based Package <#new-recipe-makefile-based-package>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
- *Manual:* You need to define a ``do_install`` function in your
|
||
recipe. The function must first use ``install -d`` to create the
|
||
directories under
|
||
``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``. Once the
|
||
directories exist, your function can use ``install`` to manually
|
||
install the built software into the directories.
|
||
|
||
You can find more information on ``install`` at
|
||
` <http://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/manual/html_node/install-invocation.html>`__.
|
||
|
||
For the scenarios that do not use Autotools or CMake, you need to track
|
||
the installation and diagnose and fix any issues until everything
|
||
installs correctly. You need to look in the default location of
|
||
``${D}``, which is ``${WORKDIR}/image``, to be sure your files have been
|
||
installed correctly.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- During the installation process, you might need to modify some of
|
||
the installed files to suit the target layout. For example, you
|
||
might need to replace hard-coded paths in an initscript with
|
||
values of variables provided by the build system, such as
|
||
replacing ``/usr/bin/`` with ``${bindir}``. If you do perform such
|
||
modifications during ``do_install``, be sure to modify the
|
||
destination file after copying rather than before copying.
|
||
Modifying after copying ensures that the build system can
|
||
re-execute ``do_install`` if needed.
|
||
|
||
- ``oe_runmake install``, which can be run directly or can be run
|
||
indirectly by the
|
||
:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` and
|
||
:ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` classes,
|
||
runs ``make install`` in parallel. Sometimes, a Makefile can have
|
||
missing dependencies between targets that can result in race
|
||
conditions. If you experience intermittent failures during
|
||
``do_install``, you might be able to work around them by disabling
|
||
parallel Makefile installs by adding the following to the recipe:
|
||
PARALLEL_MAKEINST = "" See
|
||
:term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST`
|
||
for additional information.
|
||
|
||
- If you need to install one or more custom CMake toolchain files
|
||
that are supplied by the application you are building, install the
|
||
files to ``${D}${datadir}/cmake/`` Modules during
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install`.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-enabling-system-services:
|
||
|
||
Enabling System Services
|
||
------------------------
|
||
|
||
If you want to install a service, which is a process that usually starts
|
||
on boot and runs in the background, then you must include some
|
||
additional definitions in your recipe.
|
||
|
||
If you are adding services and the service initialization script or the
|
||
service file itself is not installed, you must provide for that
|
||
installation in your recipe using a ``do_install_append`` function. If
|
||
your recipe already has a ``do_install`` function, update the function
|
||
near its end rather than adding an additional ``do_install_append``
|
||
function.
|
||
|
||
When you create the installation for your services, you need to
|
||
accomplish what is normally done by ``make install``. In other words,
|
||
make sure your installation arranges the output similar to how it is
|
||
arranged on the target system.
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system provides support for starting services two
|
||
different ways:
|
||
|
||
- *SysVinit:* SysVinit is a system and service manager that manages the
|
||
init system used to control the very basic functions of your system.
|
||
The init program is the first program started by the Linux kernel
|
||
when the system boots. Init then controls the startup, running and
|
||
shutdown of all other programs.
|
||
|
||
To enable a service using SysVinit, your recipe needs to inherit the
|
||
:ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>`
|
||
class. The class helps facilitate safely installing the package on
|
||
the target.
|
||
|
||
You will need to set the
|
||
:term:`INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES`,
|
||
:term:`INITSCRIPT_NAME`,
|
||
and
|
||
:term:`INITSCRIPT_PARAMS`
|
||
variables within your recipe.
|
||
|
||
- *systemd:* System Management Daemon (systemd) was designed to replace
|
||
SysVinit and to provide enhanced management of services. For more
|
||
information on systemd, see the systemd homepage at
|
||
` <http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/>`__.
|
||
|
||
To enable a service using systemd, your recipe needs to inherit the
|
||
:ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class. See
|
||
the ``systemd.bbclass`` file located in your :term:`Source Directory`
|
||
section for
|
||
more information.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-packaging:
|
||
|
||
Packaging
|
||
---------
|
||
|
||
Successful packaging is a combination of automated processes performed
|
||
by the OpenEmbedded build system and some specific steps you need to
|
||
take. The following list describes the process:
|
||
|
||
- *Splitting Files*: The ``do_package`` task splits the files produced
|
||
by the recipe into logical components. Even software that produces a
|
||
single binary might still have debug symbols, documentation, and
|
||
other logical components that should be split out. The ``do_package``
|
||
task ensures that files are split up and packaged correctly.
|
||
|
||
- *Running QA Checks*: The
|
||
:ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class adds a
|
||
step to the package generation process so that output quality
|
||
assurance checks are generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. This
|
||
step performs a range of checks to be sure the build's output is free
|
||
of common problems that show up during runtime. For information on
|
||
these checks, see the
|
||
:ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and
|
||
the "`QA Error and Warning
|
||
Messages <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#ref-qa-checks>`__" chapter in the
|
||
Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
- *Hand-Checking Your Packages*: After you build your software, you
|
||
need to be sure your packages are correct. Examine the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/packages-split``
|
||
directory and make sure files are where you expect them to be. If you
|
||
discover problems, you can set
|
||
:term:`PACKAGES`,
|
||
:term:`FILES`,
|
||
``do_install(_append)``, and so forth as needed.
|
||
|
||
- *Splitting an Application into Multiple Packages*: If you need to
|
||
split an application into several packages, see the "`Splitting an
|
||
Application into Multiple
|
||
Packages <#splitting-an-application-into-multiple-packages>`__"
|
||
section for an example.
|
||
|
||
- *Installing a Post-Installation Script*: For an example showing how
|
||
to install a post-installation script, see the "`Post-Installation
|
||
Scripts <#new-recipe-post-installation-scripts>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
- *Marking Package Architecture*: Depending on what your recipe is
|
||
building and how it is configured, it might be important to mark the
|
||
packages produced as being specific to a particular machine, or to
|
||
mark them as not being specific to a particular machine or
|
||
architecture at all.
|
||
|
||
By default, packages apply to any machine with the same architecture
|
||
as the target machine. When a recipe produces packages that are
|
||
machine-specific (e.g. the
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` value is passed
|
||
into the configure script or a patch is applied only for a particular
|
||
machine), you should mark them as such by adding the following to the
|
||
recipe: PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
|
||
|
||
On the other hand, if the recipe produces packages that do not
|
||
contain anything specific to the target machine or architecture at
|
||
all (e.g. recipes that simply package script files or configuration
|
||
files), you should use the
|
||
:ref:`allarch <ref-classes-allarch>` class to
|
||
do this for you by adding this to your recipe: inherit allarch
|
||
Ensuring that the package architecture is correct is not critical
|
||
while you are doing the first few builds of your recipe. However, it
|
||
is important in order to ensure that your recipe rebuilds (or does
|
||
not rebuild) appropriately in response to changes in configuration,
|
||
and to ensure that you get the appropriate packages installed on the
|
||
target machine, particularly if you run separate builds for more than
|
||
one target machine.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-sharing-files-between-recipes:
|
||
|
||
Sharing Files Between Recipes
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
Recipes often need to use files provided by other recipes on the build
|
||
host. For example, an application linking to a common library needs
|
||
access to the library itself and its associated headers. The way this
|
||
access is accomplished is by populating a sysroot with files. Each
|
||
recipe has two sysroots in its work directory, one for target files
|
||
(``recipe-sysroot``) and one for files that are native to the build host
|
||
(``recipe-sysroot-native``).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You could find the term "staging" used within the Yocto project
|
||
regarding files populating sysroots (e.g. the
|
||
STAGING_DIR
|
||
variable).
|
||
|
||
Recipes should never populate the sysroot directly (i.e. write files
|
||
into sysroot). Instead, files should be installed into standard
|
||
locations during the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task within
|
||
the ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` directory. The
|
||
reason for this limitation is that almost all files that populate the
|
||
sysroot are cataloged in manifests in order to ensure the files can be
|
||
removed later when a recipe is either modified or removed. Thus, the
|
||
sysroot is able to remain free from stale files.
|
||
|
||
A subset of the files installed by the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task are
|
||
used by the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
|
||
task as defined by the the
|
||
:term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable to
|
||
automatically populate the sysroot. It is possible to modify the list of
|
||
directories that populate the sysroot. The following example shows how
|
||
you could add the ``/opt`` directory to the list of directories within a
|
||
recipe: SYSROOT_DIRS += "/opt"
|
||
|
||
For a more complete description of the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
|
||
task and its associated functions, see the
|
||
:ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class.
|
||
|
||
.. _metadata-virtual-providers:
|
||
|
||
Using Virtual Providers
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
Prior to a build, if you know that several different recipes provide the
|
||
same functionality, you can use a virtual provider (i.e. ``virtual/*``)
|
||
as a placeholder for the actual provider. The actual provider is
|
||
determined at build-time.
|
||
|
||
A common scenario where a virtual provider is used would be for the
|
||
kernel recipe. Suppose you have three kernel recipes whose
|
||
:term:`PN` values map to ``kernel-big``,
|
||
``kernel-mid``, and ``kernel-small``. Furthermore, each of these recipes
|
||
in some way uses a :term:`PROVIDES`
|
||
statement that essentially identifies itself as being able to provide
|
||
``virtual/kernel``. Here is one way through the
|
||
:ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class: PROVIDES
|
||
+= "${@ "virtual/kernel" if (d.getVar("KERNEL_PACKAGE_NAME") ==
|
||
"kernel") else "" }" Any recipe that inherits the ``kernel`` class is
|
||
going to utilize a ``PROVIDES`` statement that identifies that recipe as
|
||
being able to provide the ``virtual/kernel`` item.
|
||
|
||
Now comes the time to actually build an image and you need a kernel
|
||
recipe, but which one? You can configure your build to call out the
|
||
kernel recipe you want by using the
|
||
:term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER`
|
||
variable. As an example, consider the
|
||
```x86-base.inc`` <https://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta/conf/machine/include/x86-base.inc>`__
|
||
include file, which is a machine (i.e.
|
||
:term:`MACHINE`) configuration file.
|
||
This include file is the reason all x86-based machines use the
|
||
``linux-yocto`` kernel. Here are the relevant lines from the include
|
||
file: PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ??= "linux-yocto"
|
||
PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto ??= "4.15%"
|
||
|
||
When you use a virtual provider, you do not have to "hard code" a recipe
|
||
name as a build dependency. You can use the
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS` variable to state the
|
||
build is dependent on ``virtual/kernel`` for example: DEPENDS =
|
||
"virtual/kernel" During the build, the OpenEmbedded build system picks
|
||
the correct recipe needed for the ``virtual/kernel`` dependency based on
|
||
the ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER`` variable. If you want to use the small kernel
|
||
mentioned at the beginning of this section, configure your build as
|
||
follows: PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ??= "kernel-small"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Any recipe that
|
||
PROVIDES
|
||
a
|
||
virtual/\*
|
||
item that is ultimately not selected through
|
||
PREFERRED_PROVIDER
|
||
does not get built. Preventing these recipes from building is usually
|
||
the desired behavior since this mechanism's purpose is to select
|
||
between mutually exclusive alternative providers.
|
||
|
||
The following lists specific examples of virtual providers:
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/kernel``: Provides the name of the kernel recipe to use
|
||
when building a kernel image.
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/bootloader``: Provides the name of the bootloader to use
|
||
when building an image.
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/libgbm``: Provides ``gbm.pc``.
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/egl``: Provides ``egl.pc`` and possibly ``wayland-egl.pc``.
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/libgl``: Provides ``gl.pc`` (i.e. libGL).
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/libgles1``: Provides ``glesv1_cm.pc`` (i.e. libGLESv1_CM).
|
||
|
||
- ``virtual/libgles2``: Provides ``glesv2.pc`` (i.e. libGLESv2).
|
||
|
||
Properly Versioning Pre-Release Recipes
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Sometimes the name of a recipe can lead to versioning problems when the
|
||
recipe is upgraded to a final release. For example, consider the
|
||
``irssi_0.8.16-rc1.bb`` recipe file in the list of example recipes in
|
||
the "`Storing and Naming the
|
||
Recipe <#new-recipe-storing-and-naming-the-recipe>`__" section. This
|
||
recipe is at a release candidate stage (i.e. "rc1"). When the recipe is
|
||
released, the recipe filename becomes ``irssi_0.8.16.bb``. The version
|
||
change from ``0.8.16-rc1`` to ``0.8.16`` is seen as a decrease by the
|
||
build system and package managers, so the resulting packages will not
|
||
correctly trigger an upgrade.
|
||
|
||
In order to ensure the versions compare properly, the recommended
|
||
convention is to set :term:`PV` within the
|
||
recipe to "previous_version+current_version". You can use an additional
|
||
variable so that you can use the current version elsewhere. Here is an
|
||
example: REALPV = "0.8.16-rc1" PV = "0.8.15+${REALPV}"
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-post-installation-scripts:
|
||
|
||
Post-Installation Scripts
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
Post-installation scripts run immediately after installing a package on
|
||
the target or during image creation when a package is included in an
|
||
image. To add a post-installation script to a package, add a
|
||
``pkg_postinst_``\ PACKAGENAME\ ``()`` function to the recipe file
|
||
(``.bb``) and replace PACKAGENAME with the name of the package you want
|
||
to attach to the ``postinst`` script. To apply the post-installation
|
||
script to the main package for the recipe, which is usually what is
|
||
required, specify
|
||
``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` in place of
|
||
PACKAGENAME.
|
||
|
||
A post-installation function has the following structure:
|
||
pkg_postinst_PACKAGENAME() { # Commands to carry out }
|
||
|
||
The script defined in the post-installation function is called when the
|
||
root filesystem is created. If the script succeeds, the package is
|
||
marked as installed.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Any RPM post-installation script that runs on the target should
|
||
return a 0 exit code. RPM does not allow non-zero exit codes for
|
||
these scripts, and the RPM package manager will cause the package to
|
||
fail installation on the target.
|
||
|
||
Sometimes it is necessary for the execution of a post-installation
|
||
script to be delayed until the first boot. For example, the script might
|
||
need to be executed on the device itself. To delay script execution
|
||
until boot time, you must explicitly mark post installs to defer to the
|
||
target. You can use ``pkg_postinst_ontarget()`` or call
|
||
``postinst_intercept delay_to_first_boot`` from ``pkg_postinst()``. Any
|
||
failure of a ``pkg_postinst()`` script (including exit 1) triggers an
|
||
error during the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
|
||
|
||
If you have recipes that use ``pkg_postinst`` function and they require
|
||
the use of non-standard native tools that have dependencies during
|
||
rootfs construction, you need to use the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS`
|
||
variable in your recipe to list these tools. If you do not use this
|
||
variable, the tools might be missing and execution of the
|
||
post-installation script is deferred until first boot. Deferring the
|
||
script to first boot is undesirable and for read-only rootfs impossible.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Equivalent support for pre-install, pre-uninstall, and post-uninstall
|
||
scripts exist by way of
|
||
pkg_preinst
|
||
,
|
||
pkg_prerm
|
||
, and
|
||
pkg_postrm
|
||
, respectively. These scrips work in exactly the same way as does
|
||
pkg_postinst
|
||
with the exception that they run at different times. Also, because of
|
||
when they run, they are not applicable to being run at image creation
|
||
time like
|
||
pkg_postinst
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-testing:
|
||
|
||
Testing
|
||
-------
|
||
|
||
The final step for completing your recipe is to be sure that the
|
||
software you built runs correctly. To accomplish runtime testing, add
|
||
the build's output packages to your image and test them on the target.
|
||
|
||
For information on how to customize your image by adding specific
|
||
packages, see the "`Customizing
|
||
Images <#usingpoky-extend-customimage>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-testing-examples:
|
||
|
||
Examples
|
||
--------
|
||
|
||
To help summarize how to write a recipe, this section provides some
|
||
examples given various scenarios:
|
||
|
||
- Recipes that use local files
|
||
|
||
- Using an Autotooled package
|
||
|
||
- Using a Makefile-based package
|
||
|
||
- Splitting an application into multiple packages
|
||
|
||
- Adding binaries to an image
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-single-c-file-package-hello-world:
|
||
|
||
Single .c File Package (Hello World!)
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Building an application from a single file that is stored locally (e.g.
|
||
under ``files``) requires a recipe that has the file listed in the
|
||
``SRC_URI`` variable. Additionally, you need to manually write the
|
||
``do_compile`` and ``do_install`` tasks. The ``S`` variable defines the
|
||
directory containing the source code, which is set to
|
||
:term:`WORKDIR` in this case - the
|
||
directory BitBake uses for the build. SUMMARY = "Simple helloworld
|
||
application" SECTION = "examples" LICENSE = "MIT" LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://${COMMON_LICENSE_DIR}/MIT;md5=0835ade698e0bcf8506ecda2f7b4f302"
|
||
SRC_URI = "file://helloworld.c" S = "${WORKDIR}" do_compile() { ${CC}
|
||
helloworld.c -o helloworld } do_install() { install -d ${D}${bindir}
|
||
install -m 0755 helloworld ${D}${bindir} }
|
||
|
||
By default, the ``helloworld``, ``helloworld-dbg``, and
|
||
``helloworld-dev`` packages are built. For information on how to
|
||
customize the packaging process, see the "`Splitting an Application into
|
||
Multiple Packages <#splitting-an-application-into-multiple-packages>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-autotooled-package:
|
||
|
||
Autotooled Package
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Applications that use Autotools such as ``autoconf`` and ``automake``
|
||
require a recipe that has a source archive listed in ``SRC_URI`` and
|
||
also inherit the
|
||
:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class,
|
||
which contains the definitions of all the steps needed to build an
|
||
Autotool-based application. The result of the build is automatically
|
||
packaged. And, if the application uses NLS for localization, packages
|
||
with local information are generated (one package per language).
|
||
Following is one example: (``hello_2.3.bb``) SUMMARY = "GNU Helloworld
|
||
application" SECTION = "examples" LICENSE = "GPLv2+" LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://COPYING;md5=751419260aa954499f7abaabaa882bbe" SRC_URI =
|
||
"${GNU_MIRROR}/hello/hello-${PV}.tar.gz" inherit autotools gettext
|
||
|
||
The variable ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` is used to track source license
|
||
changes as described in the "`Tracking License
|
||
Changes <#usingpoky-configuring-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM>`__" section in the
|
||
Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. You can quickly create
|
||
Autotool-based recipes in a manner similar to the previous example.
|
||
|
||
.. _new-recipe-makefile-based-package:
|
||
|
||
Makefile-Based Package
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Applications that use GNU ``make`` also require a recipe that has the
|
||
source archive listed in ``SRC_URI``. You do not need to add a
|
||
``do_compile`` step since by default BitBake starts the ``make`` command
|
||
to compile the application. If you need additional ``make`` options, you
|
||
should store them in the
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` or
|
||
:term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
|
||
variables. BitBake passes these options into the GNU ``make``
|
||
invocation. Note that a ``do_install`` task is still required.
|
||
Otherwise, BitBake runs an empty ``do_install`` task by default.
|
||
|
||
Some applications might require extra parameters to be passed to the
|
||
compiler. For example, the application might need an additional header
|
||
path. You can accomplish this by adding to the ``CFLAGS`` variable. The
|
||
following example shows this: CFLAGS_prepend = "-I ${S}/include "
|
||
|
||
In the following example, ``mtd-utils`` is a makefile-based package:
|
||
SUMMARY = "Tools for managing memory technology devices" SECTION =
|
||
"base" DEPENDS = "zlib lzo e2fsprogs util-linux" HOMEPAGE =
|
||
"http://www.linux-mtd.infradead.org/" LICENSE = "GPLv2+"
|
||
LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=0636e73ff0215e8d672dc4c32c317bb3
|
||
\\
|
||
file://include/common.h;beginline=1;endline=17;md5=ba05b07912a44ea2bf81ce409380049c"
|
||
# Use the latest version at 26 Oct, 2013 SRCREV =
|
||
"9f107132a6a073cce37434ca9cda6917dd8d866b" SRC_URI =
|
||
"git://git.infradead.org/mtd-utils.git \\
|
||
file://add-exclusion-to-mkfs-jffs2-git-2.patch \\ " PV =
|
||
"1.5.1+git${SRCPV}" S = "${WORKDIR}/git" EXTRA_OEMAKE = "'CC=${CC}'
|
||
'RANLIB=${RANLIB}' 'AR=${AR}' 'CFLAGS=${CFLAGS} -I${S}/include
|
||
-DWITHOUT_XATTR' 'BUILDDIR=${S}'" do_install () { oe_runmake install
|
||
DESTDIR=${D} SBINDIR=${sbindir} MANDIR=${mandir}
|
||
INCLUDEDIR=${includedir} } PACKAGES =+ "mtd-utils-jffs2 mtd-utils-ubifs
|
||
mtd-utils-misc" FILES_mtd-utils-jffs2 = "${sbindir}/mkfs.jffs2
|
||
${sbindir}/jffs2dump ${sbindir}/jffs2reader ${sbindir}/sumtool"
|
||
FILES_mtd-utils-ubifs = "${sbindir}/mkfs.ubifs ${sbindir}/ubi*"
|
||
FILES_mtd-utils-misc = "${sbindir}/nftl\* ${sbindir}/ftl\*
|
||
${sbindir}/rfd\* ${sbindir}/doc\* ${sbindir}/serve_image
|
||
${sbindir}/recv_image" PARALLEL_MAKE = "" BBCLASSEXTEND = "native"
|
||
|
||
Splitting an Application into Multiple Packages
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
You can use the variables ``PACKAGES`` and ``FILES`` to split an
|
||
application into multiple packages.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example that uses the ``libxpm`` recipe. By default,
|
||
this recipe generates a single package that contains the library along
|
||
with a few binaries. You can modify the recipe to split the binaries
|
||
into separate packages: require xorg-lib-common.inc SUMMARY = "Xpm: X
|
||
Pixmap extension library" LICENSE = "BSD" LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://COPYING;md5=51f4270b012ecd4ab1a164f5f4ed6cf7" DEPENDS +=
|
||
"libxext libsm libxt" PE = "1" XORG_PN = "libXpm" PACKAGES =+ "sxpm
|
||
cxpm" FILES_cxpm = "${bindir}/cxpm" FILES_sxpm = "${bindir}/sxpm"
|
||
|
||
In the previous example, we want to ship the ``sxpm`` and ``cxpm``
|
||
binaries in separate packages. Since ``bindir`` would be packaged into
|
||
the main ``PN`` package by default, we prepend the ``PACKAGES`` variable
|
||
so additional package names are added to the start of list. This results
|
||
in the extra ``FILES_*`` variables then containing information that
|
||
define which files and directories go into which packages. Files
|
||
included by earlier packages are skipped by latter packages. Thus, the
|
||
main ``PN`` package does not include the above listed files.
|
||
|
||
Packaging Externally Produced Binaries
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Sometimes, you need to add pre-compiled binaries to an image. For
|
||
example, suppose that binaries for proprietary code exist, which are
|
||
created by a particular division of a company. Your part of the company
|
||
needs to use those binaries as part of an image that you are building
|
||
using the OpenEmbedded build system. Since you only have the binaries
|
||
and not the source code, you cannot use a typical recipe that expects to
|
||
fetch the source specified in
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` and then compile it.
|
||
|
||
One method is to package the binaries and then install them as part of
|
||
the image. Generally, it is not a good idea to package binaries since,
|
||
among other things, it can hinder the ability to reproduce builds and
|
||
could lead to compatibility problems with ABI in the future. However,
|
||
sometimes you have no choice.
|
||
|
||
The easiest solution is to create a recipe that uses the
|
||
:ref:`bin_package <ref-classes-bin-package>` class
|
||
and to be sure that you are using default locations for build artifacts.
|
||
In most cases, the ``bin_package`` class handles "skipping" the
|
||
configure and compile steps as well as sets things up to grab packages
|
||
from the appropriate area. In particular, this class sets ``noexec`` on
|
||
both the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`
|
||
and :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` tasks,
|
||
sets ``FILES_${PN}`` to "/" so that it picks up all files, and sets up a
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task, which
|
||
effectively copies all files from ``${S}`` to ``${D}``. The
|
||
``bin_package`` class works well when the files extracted into ``${S}``
|
||
are already laid out in the way they should be laid out on the target.
|
||
For more information on these variables, see the
|
||
:term:`FILES`,
|
||
:term:`PN`,
|
||
:term:`S`, and
|
||
:term:`D` variables in the Yocto Project
|
||
Reference Manual's variable glossary.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- Using :term:`DEPENDS` is a good
|
||
idea even for components distributed in binary form, and is often
|
||
necessary for shared libraries. For a shared library, listing the
|
||
library dependencies in ``DEPENDS`` makes sure that the libraries
|
||
are available in the staging sysroot when other recipes link
|
||
against the library, which might be necessary for successful
|
||
linking.
|
||
|
||
- Using ``DEPENDS`` also allows runtime dependencies between
|
||
packages to be added automatically. See the "`Automatically Added
|
||
Runtime
|
||
Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
|
||
information.
|
||
|
||
If you cannot use the ``bin_package`` class, you need to be sure you are
|
||
doing the following:
|
||
|
||
- Create a recipe where the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` and
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` tasks do
|
||
nothing: It is usually sufficient to just not define these tasks in
|
||
the recipe, because the default implementations do nothing unless a
|
||
Makefile is found in
|
||
``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``.
|
||
|
||
If ``${S}`` might contain a Makefile, or if you inherit some class
|
||
that replaces ``do_configure`` and ``do_compile`` with custom
|
||
versions, then you can use the
|
||
``[``\ ```noexec`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#variable-flags>`__\ ``]``
|
||
flag to turn the tasks into no-ops, as follows: do_configure[noexec]
|
||
= "1" do_compile[noexec] = "1" Unlike
|
||
```deleting the tasks`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#deleting-a-task>`__,
|
||
using the flag preserves the dependency chain from the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`,
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack`, and
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` tasks to the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task.
|
||
|
||
- Make sure your ``do_install`` task installs the binaries
|
||
appropriately.
|
||
|
||
- Ensure that you set up :term:`FILES`
|
||
(usually
|
||
``FILES_${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``) to
|
||
point to the files you have installed, which of course depends on
|
||
where you have installed them and whether those files are in
|
||
different locations than the defaults.
|
||
|
||
Following Recipe Style Guidelines
|
||
---------------------------------
|
||
|
||
When writing recipes, it is good to conform to existing style
|
||
guidelines. The `OpenEmbedded
|
||
Styleguide <http://www.openembedded.org/wiki/Styleguide>`__ wiki page
|
||
provides rough guidelines for preferred recipe style.
|
||
|
||
It is common for existing recipes to deviate a bit from this style.
|
||
However, aiming for at least a consistent style is a good idea. Some
|
||
practices, such as omitting spaces around ``=`` operators in assignments
|
||
or ordering recipe components in an erratic way, are widely seen as poor
|
||
style.
|
||
|
||
Recipe Syntax
|
||
-------------
|
||
|
||
Understanding recipe file syntax is important for writing recipes. The
|
||
following list overviews the basic items that make up a BitBake recipe
|
||
file. For more complete BitBake syntax descriptions, see the "`Syntax
|
||
and Operators <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#bitbake-user-manual-metadata>`__"
|
||
chapter of the BitBake User Manual.
|
||
|
||
- *Variable Assignments and Manipulations:* Variable assignments allow
|
||
a value to be assigned to a variable. The assignment can be static
|
||
text or might include the contents of other variables. In addition to
|
||
the assignment, appending and prepending operations are also
|
||
supported.
|
||
|
||
The following example shows some of the ways you can use variables in
|
||
recipes: S = "${WORKDIR}/postfix-${PV}" CFLAGS += "-DNO_ASM"
|
||
SRC_URI_append = " file://fixup.patch"
|
||
|
||
- *Functions:* Functions provide a series of actions to be performed.
|
||
You usually use functions to override the default implementation of a
|
||
task function or to complement a default function (i.e. append or
|
||
prepend to an existing function). Standard functions use ``sh`` shell
|
||
syntax, although access to OpenEmbedded variables and internal
|
||
methods are also available.
|
||
|
||
The following is an example function from the ``sed`` recipe:
|
||
do_install () { autotools_do_install install -d ${D}${base_bindir} mv
|
||
${D}${bindir}/sed ${D}${base_bindir}/sed rmdir ${D}${bindir}/ } It is
|
||
also possible to implement new functions that are called between
|
||
existing tasks as long as the new functions are not replacing or
|
||
complementing the default functions. You can implement functions in
|
||
Python instead of shell. Both of these options are not seen in the
|
||
majority of recipes.
|
||
|
||
- *Keywords:* BitBake recipes use only a few keywords. You use keywords
|
||
to include common functions (``inherit``), load parts of a recipe
|
||
from other files (``include`` and ``require``) and export variables
|
||
to the environment (``export``).
|
||
|
||
The following example shows the use of some of these keywords: export
|
||
POSTCONF = "${STAGING_BINDIR}/postconf" inherit autoconf require
|
||
otherfile.inc
|
||
|
||
- *Comments (#):* Any lines that begin with the hash character (``#``)
|
||
are treated as comment lines and are ignored: # This is a comment
|
||
|
||
This next list summarizes the most important and most commonly used
|
||
parts of the recipe syntax. For more information on these parts of the
|
||
syntax, you can reference the `Syntax and
|
||
Operators <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#bitbake-user-manual-metadata>`__ chapter
|
||
in the BitBake User Manual.
|
||
|
||
- *Line Continuation (\):* Use the backward slash (``\``) character to
|
||
split a statement over multiple lines. Place the slash character at
|
||
the end of the line that is to be continued on the next line: VAR =
|
||
"A really long \\ line"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You cannot have any characters including spaces or tabs after the
|
||
slash character.
|
||
|
||
- *Using Variables (${VARNAME}):* Use the ``${VARNAME}`` syntax to
|
||
access the contents of a variable: SRC_URI =
|
||
"${SOURCEFORGE_MIRROR}/libpng/zlib-${PV}.tar.gz"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
It is important to understand that the value of a variable
|
||
expressed in this form does not get substituted automatically. The
|
||
expansion of these expressions happens on-demand later (e.g.
|
||
usually when a function that makes reference to the variable
|
||
executes). This behavior ensures that the values are most
|
||
appropriate for the context in which they are finally used. On the
|
||
rare occasion that you do need the variable expression to be
|
||
expanded immediately, you can use the
|
||
:=
|
||
operator instead of
|
||
=
|
||
when you make the assignment, but this is not generally needed.
|
||
|
||
- *Quote All Assignments ("value"):* Use double quotes around values in
|
||
all variable assignments (e.g. ``"value"``). Following is an example:
|
||
VAR1 = "${OTHERVAR}" VAR2 = "The version is ${PV}"
|
||
|
||
- *Conditional Assignment (?=):* Conditional assignment is used to
|
||
assign a value to a variable, but only when the variable is currently
|
||
unset. Use the question mark followed by the equal sign (``?=``) to
|
||
make a "soft" assignment used for conditional assignment. Typically,
|
||
"soft" assignments are used in the ``local.conf`` file for variables
|
||
that are allowed to come through from the external environment.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example where ``VAR1`` is set to "New value" if it is
|
||
currently empty. However, if ``VAR1`` has already been set, it
|
||
remains unchanged: VAR1 ?= "New value" In this next example, ``VAR1``
|
||
is left with the value "Original value": VAR1 = "Original value" VAR1
|
||
?= "New value"
|
||
|
||
- *Appending (+=):* Use the plus character followed by the equals sign
|
||
(``+=``) to append values to existing variables.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This operator adds a space between the existing content of the
|
||
variable and the new content.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example: SRC_URI += "file://fix-makefile.patch"
|
||
|
||
- *Prepending (=+):* Use the equals sign followed by the plus character
|
||
(``=+``) to prepend values to existing variables.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This operator adds a space between the new content and the
|
||
existing content of the variable.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example: VAR =+ "Starts"
|
||
|
||
- *Appending (_append):* Use the ``_append`` operator to append values
|
||
to existing variables. This operator does not add any additional
|
||
space. Also, the operator is applied after all the ``+=``, and ``=+``
|
||
operators have been applied and after all ``=`` assignments have
|
||
occurred.
|
||
|
||
The following example shows the space being explicitly added to the
|
||
start to ensure the appended value is not merged with the existing
|
||
value: SRC_URI_append = " file://fix-makefile.patch" You can also use
|
||
the ``_append`` operator with overrides, which results in the actions
|
||
only being performed for the specified target or machine:
|
||
SRC_URI_append_sh4 = " file://fix-makefile.patch"
|
||
|
||
- *Prepending (_prepend):* Use the ``_prepend`` operator to prepend
|
||
values to existing variables. This operator does not add any
|
||
additional space. Also, the operator is applied after all the ``+=``,
|
||
and ``=+`` operators have been applied and after all ``=``
|
||
assignments have occurred.
|
||
|
||
The following example shows the space being explicitly added to the
|
||
end to ensure the prepended value is not merged with the existing
|
||
value: CFLAGS_prepend = "-I${S}/myincludes " You can also use the
|
||
``_prepend`` operator with overrides, which results in the actions
|
||
only being performed for the specified target or machine:
|
||
CFLAGS_prepend_sh4 = "-I${S}/myincludes "
|
||
|
||
- *Overrides:* You can use overrides to set a value conditionally,
|
||
typically based on how the recipe is being built. For example, to set
|
||
the :term:`KBRANCH` variable's
|
||
value to "standard/base" for any target
|
||
:term:`MACHINE`, except for
|
||
qemuarm where it should be set to "standard/arm-versatile-926ejs",
|
||
you would do the following: KBRANCH = "standard/base" KBRANCH_qemuarm
|
||
= "standard/arm-versatile-926ejs" Overrides are also used to separate
|
||
alternate values of a variable in other situations. For example, when
|
||
setting variables such as
|
||
:term:`FILES` and
|
||
:term:`RDEPENDS` that are
|
||
specific to individual packages produced by a recipe, you should
|
||
always use an override that specifies the name of the package.
|
||
|
||
- *Indentation:* Use spaces for indentation rather than than tabs. For
|
||
shell functions, both currently work. However, it is a policy
|
||
decision of the Yocto Project to use tabs in shell functions. Realize
|
||
that some layers have a policy to use spaces for all indentation.
|
||
|
||
- *Using Python for Complex Operations:* For more advanced processing,
|
||
it is possible to use Python code during variable assignments (e.g.
|
||
search and replacement on a variable).
|
||
|
||
You indicate Python code using the ``${@python_code}`` syntax for the
|
||
variable assignment: SRC_URI =
|
||
"ftp://ftp.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/src/zip${@d.getVar('PV',1).replace('.',
|
||
'')}.tgz
|
||
|
||
- *Shell Function Syntax:* Write shell functions as if you were writing
|
||
a shell script when you describe a list of actions to take. You
|
||
should ensure that your script works with a generic ``sh`` and that
|
||
it does not require any ``bash`` or other shell-specific
|
||
functionality. The same considerations apply to various system
|
||
utilities (e.g. ``sed``, ``grep``, ``awk``, and so forth) that you
|
||
might wish to use. If in doubt, you should check with multiple
|
||
implementations - including those from BusyBox.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-newmachine:
|
||
|
||
Adding a New Machine
|
||
====================
|
||
|
||
Adding a new machine to the Yocto Project is a straightforward process.
|
||
This section describes how to add machines that are similar to those
|
||
that the Yocto Project already supports.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Although well within the capabilities of the Yocto Project, adding a
|
||
totally new architecture might require changes to
|
||
gcc/glibc
|
||
and to the site information, which is beyond the scope of this
|
||
manual.
|
||
|
||
For a complete example that shows how to add a new machine, see the
|
||
"`Creating a New BSP Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers``
|
||
Script <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#creating-a-new-bsp-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP) Developer's
|
||
Guide.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-newmachine-conffile:
|
||
|
||
Adding the Machine Configuration File
|
||
-------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
To add a new machine, you need to add a new machine configuration file
|
||
to the layer's ``conf/machine`` directory. This configuration file
|
||
provides details about the device you are adding.
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system uses the root name of the machine
|
||
configuration file to reference the new machine. For example, given a
|
||
machine configuration file named ``crownbay.conf``, the build system
|
||
recognizes the machine as "crownbay".
|
||
|
||
The most important variables you must set in your machine configuration
|
||
file or include from a lower-level configuration file are as follows:
|
||
|
||
- ``TARGET_ARCH`` (e.g. "arm")
|
||
|
||
- ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel``
|
||
|
||
- ``MACHINE_FEATURES`` (e.g. "apm screen wifi")
|
||
|
||
You might also need these variables:
|
||
|
||
- ``SERIAL_CONSOLES`` (e.g. "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1")
|
||
|
||
- ``KERNEL_IMAGETYPE`` (e.g. "zImage")
|
||
|
||
- ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` (e.g. "tar.gz jffs2")
|
||
|
||
You can find full details on these variables in the reference section.
|
||
You can leverage existing machine ``.conf`` files from
|
||
``meta-yocto-bsp/conf/machine/``.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-newmachine-kernel:
|
||
|
||
Adding a Kernel for the Machine
|
||
-------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system needs to be able to build a kernel for the
|
||
machine. You need to either create a new kernel recipe for this machine,
|
||
or extend an existing kernel recipe. You can find several kernel recipe
|
||
examples in the Source Directory at ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` that
|
||
you can use as references.
|
||
|
||
If you are creating a new kernel recipe, normal recipe-writing rules
|
||
apply for setting up a ``SRC_URI``. Thus, you need to specify any
|
||
necessary patches and set ``S`` to point at the source code. You need to
|
||
create a ``do_configure`` task that configures the unpacked kernel with
|
||
a ``defconfig`` file. You can do this by using a ``make defconfig``
|
||
command or, more commonly, by copying in a suitable ``defconfig`` file
|
||
and then running ``make oldconfig``. By making use of ``inherit kernel``
|
||
and potentially some of the ``linux-*.inc`` files, most other
|
||
functionality is centralized and the defaults of the class normally work
|
||
well.
|
||
|
||
If you are extending an existing kernel recipe, it is usually a matter
|
||
of adding a suitable ``defconfig`` file. The file needs to be added into
|
||
a location similar to ``defconfig`` files used for other machines in a
|
||
given kernel recipe. A possible way to do this is by listing the file in
|
||
the ``SRC_URI`` and adding the machine to the expression in
|
||
``COMPATIBLE_MACHINE``: COMPATIBLE_MACHINE = '(qemux86|qemumips)' For
|
||
more information on ``defconfig`` files, see the "`Changing the
|
||
Configuration <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#changing-the-configuration>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-newmachine-formfactor:
|
||
|
||
Adding a Formfactor Configuration File
|
||
--------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
A formfactor configuration file provides information about the target
|
||
hardware for which the image is being built and information that the
|
||
build system cannot obtain from other sources such as the kernel. Some
|
||
examples of information contained in a formfactor configuration file
|
||
include framebuffer orientation, whether or not the system has a
|
||
keyboard, the positioning of the keyboard in relation to the screen, and
|
||
the screen resolution.
|
||
|
||
The build system uses reasonable defaults in most cases. However, if
|
||
customization is necessary, you need to create a ``machconfig`` file in
|
||
the ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor/files`` directory. This directory
|
||
contains directories for specific machines such as ``qemuarm`` and
|
||
``qemux86``. For information about the settings available and the
|
||
defaults, see the ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor/files/config`` file
|
||
found in the same area.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example for "qemuarm" machine: HAVE_TOUCHSCREEN=1
|
||
HAVE_KEYBOARD=1 DISPLAY_CAN_ROTATE=0 DISPLAY_ORIENTATION=0
|
||
#DISPLAY_WIDTH_PIXELS=640 #DISPLAY_HEIGHT_PIXELS=480 #DISPLAY_BPP=16
|
||
DISPLAY_DPI=150 DISPLAY_SUBPIXEL_ORDER=vrgb
|
||
|
||
.. _gs-upgrading-recipes:
|
||
|
||
Upgrading Recipes
|
||
=================
|
||
|
||
Over time, upstream developers publish new versions for software built
|
||
by layer recipes. It is recommended to keep recipes up-to-date with
|
||
upstream version releases.
|
||
|
||
While several methods exist that allow you upgrade a recipe, you might
|
||
consider checking on the upgrade status of a recipe first. You can do so
|
||
using the ``devtool check-upgrade-status`` command. See the "`Checking
|
||
on the Upgrade Status of a
|
||
Recipe <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#devtool-checking-on-the-upgrade-status-of-a-recipe>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual for more information.
|
||
|
||
The remainder of this section describes three ways you can upgrade a
|
||
recipe. You can use the Automated Upgrade Helper (AUH) to set up
|
||
automatic version upgrades. Alternatively, you can use
|
||
``devtool upgrade`` to set up semi-automatic version upgrades. Finally,
|
||
you can manually upgrade a recipe by editing the recipe itself.
|
||
|
||
.. _gs-using-the-auto-upgrade-helper:
|
||
|
||
Using the Auto Upgrade Helper (AUH)
|
||
-----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The AUH utility works in conjunction with the OpenEmbedded build system
|
||
in order to automatically generate upgrades for recipes based on new
|
||
versions being published upstream. Use AUH when you want to create a
|
||
service that performs the upgrades automatically and optionally sends
|
||
you an email with the results.
|
||
|
||
AUH allows you to update several recipes with a single use. You can also
|
||
optionally perform build and integration tests using images with the
|
||
results saved to your hard drive and emails of results optionally sent
|
||
to recipe maintainers. Finally, AUH creates Git commits with appropriate
|
||
commit messages in the layer's tree for the changes made to recipes.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Conditions do exist when you should not use AUH to upgrade recipes
|
||
and you should instead use either
|
||
devtool upgrade
|
||
or upgrade your recipes manually:
|
||
|
||
- When AUH cannot complete the upgrade sequence. This situation
|
||
usually results because custom patches carried by the recipe
|
||
cannot be automatically rebased to the new version. In this case,
|
||
``devtool upgrade`` allows you to manually resolve conflicts.
|
||
|
||
- When for any reason you want fuller control over the upgrade
|
||
process. For example, when you want special arrangements for
|
||
testing.
|
||
|
||
The following steps describe how to set up the AUH utility:
|
||
|
||
1. *Be Sure the Development Host is Set Up:* You need to be sure that
|
||
your development host is set up to use the Yocto Project. For
|
||
information on how to set up your host, see the "`Preparing the Build
|
||
Host <#dev-preparing-the-build-host>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
2. *Make Sure Git is Configured:* The AUH utility requires Git to be
|
||
configured because AUH uses Git to save upgrades. Thus, you must have
|
||
Git user and email configured. The following command shows your
|
||
configurations: $ git config --list If you do not have the user and
|
||
email configured, you can use the following commands to do so: $ git
|
||
config --global user.name some_name $ git config --global user.email
|
||
username@domain.com
|
||
|
||
3. *Clone the AUH Repository:* To use AUH, you must clone the repository
|
||
onto your development host. The following command uses Git to create
|
||
a local copy of the repository on your system: $ git clone
|
||
git://git.yoctoproject.org/auto-upgrade-helper Cloning into
|
||
'auto-upgrade-helper'... remote: Counting objects: 768, done. remote:
|
||
Compressing objects: 100% (300/300), done. remote: Total 768 (delta
|
||
499), reused 703 (delta 434) Receiving objects: 100% (768/768),
|
||
191.47 KiB \| 98.00 KiB/s, done. Resolving deltas: 100% (499/499),
|
||
done. Checking connectivity... done. AUH is not part of the
|
||
:term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` or
|
||
`Poky <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#poky>`__ repositories.
|
||
|
||
4. *Create a Dedicated Build Directory:* Run the
|
||
```oe-init-build-env`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__
|
||
script to create a fresh build directory that you use exclusively for
|
||
running the AUH utility: $ cd ~/poky $ source oe-init-build-env
|
||
your_AUH_build_directory Re-using an existing build directory and its
|
||
configurations is not recommended as existing settings could cause
|
||
AUH to fail or behave undesirably.
|
||
|
||
5. *Make Configurations in Your Local Configuration File:* Several
|
||
settings need to exist in the ``local.conf`` file in the build
|
||
directory you just created for AUH. Make these following
|
||
configurations:
|
||
|
||
- If you want to enable `Build
|
||
History <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#maintaining-build-output-quality>`__,
|
||
which is optional, you need the following lines in the
|
||
``conf/local.conf`` file: INHERIT =+ "buildhistory"
|
||
BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1" With this configuration and a successful
|
||
upgrade, a build history "diff" file appears in the
|
||
``upgrade-helper/work/recipe/buildhistory-diff.txt`` file found in
|
||
your build directory.
|
||
|
||
- If you want to enable testing through the
|
||
:ref:`testimage <ref-classes-testimage*>`
|
||
class, which is optional, you need to have the following set in
|
||
your ``conf/local.conf`` file: INHERIT += "testimage"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If your distro does not enable by default ptest, which Poky
|
||
does, you need the following in your
|
||
local.conf
|
||
file:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_append = " ptest"
|
||
|
||
|
||
6. *Optionally Start a vncserver:* If you are running in a server
|
||
without an X11 session, you need to start a vncserver: $ vncserver :1
|
||
$ export DISPLAY=:1
|
||
|
||
7. *Create and Edit an AUH Configuration File:* You need to have the
|
||
``upgrade-helper/upgrade-helper.conf`` configuration file in your
|
||
build directory. You can find a sample configuration file in the `AUH
|
||
source
|
||
repository <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/auto-upgrade-helper/tree/>`__.
|
||
|
||
Read through the sample file and make configurations as needed. For
|
||
example, if you enabled build history in your ``local.conf`` as
|
||
described earlier, you must enable it in ``upgrade-helper.conf``.
|
||
|
||
Also, if you are using the default ``maintainers.inc`` file supplied
|
||
with Poky and located in ``meta-yocto`` and you do not set a
|
||
"maintainers_whitelist" or "global_maintainer_override" in the
|
||
``upgrade-helper.conf`` configuration, and you specify "-e all" on
|
||
the AUH command-line, the utility automatically sends out emails to
|
||
all the default maintainers. Please avoid this.
|
||
|
||
This next set of examples describes how to use the AUH:
|
||
|
||
- *Upgrading a Specific Recipe:* To upgrade a specific recipe, use the
|
||
following form: $ upgrade-helper.py recipe_name For example, this
|
||
command upgrades the ``xmodmap`` recipe: $ upgrade-helper.py xmodmap
|
||
|
||
- *Upgrading a Specific Recipe to a Particular Version:* To upgrade a
|
||
specific recipe to a particular version, use the following form: $
|
||
upgrade-helper.py recipe_name -t version For example, this command
|
||
upgrades the ``xmodmap`` recipe to version 1.2.3: $ upgrade-helper.py
|
||
xmodmap -t 1.2.3
|
||
|
||
- *Upgrading all Recipes to the Latest Versions and Suppressing Email
|
||
Notifications:* To upgrade all recipes to their most recent versions
|
||
and suppress the email notifications, use the following command: $
|
||
upgrade-helper.py all
|
||
|
||
- *Upgrading all Recipes to the Latest Versions and Send Email
|
||
Notifications:* To upgrade all recipes to their most recent versions
|
||
and send email messages to maintainers for each attempted recipe as
|
||
well as a status email, use the following command: $
|
||
upgrade-helper.py -e all
|
||
|
||
Once you have run the AUH utility, you can find the results in the AUH
|
||
build directory: ${BUILDDIR}/upgrade-helper/timestamp The AUH utility
|
||
also creates recipe update commits from successful upgrade attempts in
|
||
the layer tree.
|
||
|
||
You can easily set up to run the AUH utility on a regular basis by using
|
||
a cron job. See the
|
||
```weeklyjob.sh`` <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/auto-upgrade-helper/tree/weeklyjob.sh>`__
|
||
file distributed with the utility for an example.
|
||
|
||
.. _gs-using-devtool-upgrade:
|
||
|
||
Using ``devtool upgrade``
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
As mentioned earlier, an alternative method for upgrading recipes to
|
||
newer versions is to use
|
||
```devtool upgrade`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#ref-devtool-reference>`__.
|
||
You can read about ``devtool upgrade`` in general in the "`Use
|
||
``devtool upgrade`` to Create a Version of the Recipe that Supports a
|
||
Newer Version of the
|
||
Software <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-devtool-use-devtool-upgrade-to-create-a-version-of-the-recipe-that-supports-a-newer-version-of-the-software>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
|
||
Software Development Kit (eSDK) Manual.
|
||
|
||
To see all the command-line options available with ``devtool upgrade``,
|
||
use the following help command: $ devtool upgrade -h
|
||
|
||
If you want to find out what version a recipe is currently at upstream
|
||
without any attempt to upgrade your local version of the recipe, you can
|
||
use the following command: $ devtool latest-version recipe_name
|
||
|
||
As mentioned in the previous section describing AUH, ``devtool upgrade``
|
||
works in a less-automated manner than AUH. Specifically,
|
||
``devtool upgrade`` only works on a single recipe that you name on the
|
||
command line, cannot perform build and integration testing using images,
|
||
and does not automatically generate commits for changes in the source
|
||
tree. Despite all these "limitations", ``devtool upgrade`` updates the
|
||
recipe file to the new upstream version and attempts to rebase custom
|
||
patches contained by the recipe as needed.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
AUH uses much of
|
||
devtool upgrade
|
||
behind the scenes making AUH somewhat of a "wrapper" application for
|
||
devtool upgrade
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
A typical scenario involves having used Git to clone an upstream
|
||
repository that you use during build operations. Because you are (or
|
||
have) built the recipe in the past, the layer is likely added to your
|
||
configuration already. If for some reason, the layer is not added, you
|
||
could add it easily using the
|
||
```bitbake-layers`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#creating-a-new-bsp-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__
|
||
script. For example, suppose you use the ``nano.bb`` recipe from the
|
||
``meta-oe`` layer in the ``meta-openembedded`` repository. For this
|
||
example, assume that the layer has been cloned into following area:
|
||
/home/scottrif/meta-openembedded The following command from your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` adds the layer to
|
||
your build configuration (i.e. ``${BUILDDIR}/conf/bblayers.conf``): $
|
||
bitbake-layers add-layer /home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe NOTE:
|
||
Starting bitbake server... Parsing recipes: 100%
|
||
\|##########################################\| Time: 0:00:55 Parsing of
|
||
1431 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1431 parsed). 2040 targets, 56
|
||
skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors. Removing 12 recipes from the x86_64
|
||
sysroot: 100% \|##############\| Time: 0:00:00 Removing 1 recipes from
|
||
the x86_64_i586 sysroot: 100% \|##########\| Time: 0:00:00 Removing 5
|
||
recipes from the i586 sysroot: 100% \|#################\| Time: 0:00:00
|
||
Removing 5 recipes from the qemux86 sysroot: 100% \|##############\|
|
||
Time: 0:00:00 For this example, assume that the ``nano.bb`` recipe that
|
||
is upstream has a 2.9.3 version number. However, the version in the
|
||
local repository is 2.7.4. The following command from your build
|
||
directory automatically upgrades the recipe for you:
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Using the
|
||
-V
|
||
option is not necessary. Omitting the version number causes
|
||
devtool upgrade
|
||
to upgrade the recipe to the most recent version.
|
||
|
||
$ devtool upgrade nano -V 2.9.3 NOTE: Starting bitbake server... NOTE:
|
||
Creating workspace layer in /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace Parsing
|
||
recipes: 100% \|##########################################\| Time:
|
||
0:00:46 Parsing of 1431 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1431 parsed). 2040
|
||
targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors. NOTE: Extracting current
|
||
version source... NOTE: Resolving any missing task queue dependencies .
|
||
. . NOTE: Executing SetScene Tasks NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks NOTE:
|
||
Tasks Summary: Attempted 74 tasks of which 72 didn't need to be rerun
|
||
and all succeeded. Adding changed files: 100%
|
||
\|#####################################\| Time: 0:00:00 NOTE: Upgraded
|
||
source extracted to /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano
|
||
NOTE: New recipe is
|
||
/home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/recipes/nano/nano_2.9.3.bb
|
||
Continuing with this example, you can use ``devtool build`` to build the
|
||
newly upgraded recipe: $ devtool build nano NOTE: Starting bitbake
|
||
server... Loading cache: 100%
|
||
\|################################################################################################\|
|
||
Time: 0:00:01 Loaded 2040 entries from dependency cache. Parsing
|
||
recipes: 100%
|
||
\|##############################################################################################\|
|
||
Time: 0:00:00 Parsing of 1432 .bb files complete (1431 cached, 1
|
||
parsed). 2041 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors. NOTE: Resolving
|
||
any missing task queue dependencies . . . NOTE: Executing SetScene Tasks
|
||
NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks NOTE: nano: compiling from external
|
||
source tree /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano NOTE: Tasks
|
||
Summary: Attempted 520 tasks of which 304 didn't need to be rerun and
|
||
all succeeded. Within the ``devtool upgrade`` workflow, opportunity
|
||
exists to deploy and test your rebuilt software. For this example,
|
||
however, running ``devtool finish`` cleans up the workspace once the
|
||
source in your workspace is clean. This usually means using Git to stage
|
||
and submit commits for the changes generated by the upgrade process.
|
||
|
||
Once the tree is clean, you can clean things up in this example with the
|
||
following command from the ``${BUILDDIR}/workspace/sources/nano``
|
||
directory: $ devtool finish nano meta-oe NOTE: Starting bitbake
|
||
server... Loading cache: 100%
|
||
\|################################################################################################\|
|
||
Time: 0:00:00 Loaded 2040 entries from dependency cache. Parsing
|
||
recipes: 100%
|
||
\|##############################################################################################\|
|
||
Time: 0:00:01 Parsing of 1432 .bb files complete (1431 cached, 1
|
||
parsed). 2041 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors. NOTE: Adding new
|
||
patch 0001-nano.bb-Stuff-I-changed-when-upgrading-nano.bb.patch NOTE:
|
||
Updating recipe nano_2.9.3.bb NOTE: Removing file
|
||
/home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe/recipes-support/nano/nano_2.7.4.bb
|
||
NOTE: Moving recipe file to
|
||
/home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe/recipes-support/nano NOTE:
|
||
Leaving source tree /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano
|
||
as-is; if you no longer need it then please delete it manually Using the
|
||
``devtool finish`` command cleans up the workspace and creates a patch
|
||
file based on your commits. The tool puts all patch files back into the
|
||
source directory in a sub-directory named ``nano`` in this case.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-manually-upgrading-a-recipe:
|
||
|
||
Manually Upgrading a Recipe
|
||
---------------------------
|
||
|
||
If for some reason you choose not to upgrade recipes using the `Auto
|
||
Upgrade Helper (AUH) <#gs-using-the-auto-upgrade-helper>`__ or by using
|
||
```devtool upgrade`` <#gs-using-devtool-upgrade>`__, you can manually
|
||
edit the recipe files to upgrade the versions.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Manually updating multiple recipes scales poorly and involves many
|
||
steps. The recommendation to upgrade recipe versions is through AUH
|
||
or
|
||
devtool upgrade
|
||
, both of which automate some steps and provide guidance for others
|
||
needed for the manual process.
|
||
|
||
To manually upgrade recipe versions, follow these general steps:
|
||
|
||
1. *Change the Version:* Rename the recipe such that the version (i.e.
|
||
the :term:`PV` part of the recipe name)
|
||
changes appropriately. If the version is not part of the recipe name,
|
||
change the value as it is set for ``PV`` within the recipe itself.
|
||
|
||
2. *Update ``SRCREV`` if Needed:* If the source code your recipe builds
|
||
is fetched from Git or some other version control system, update
|
||
:term:`SRCREV` to point to the
|
||
commit hash that matches the new version.
|
||
|
||
3. *Build the Software:* Try to build the recipe using BitBake. Typical
|
||
build failures include the following:
|
||
|
||
- License statements were updated for the new version. For this
|
||
case, you need to review any changes to the license and update the
|
||
values of :term:`LICENSE` and
|
||
:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
|
||
as needed.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
License changes are often inconsequential. For example, the
|
||
license text's copyright year might have changed.
|
||
|
||
- Custom patches carried by the older version of the recipe might
|
||
fail to apply to the new version. For these cases, you need to
|
||
review the failures. Patches might not be necessary for the new
|
||
version of the software if the upgraded version has fixed those
|
||
issues. If a patch is necessary and failing, you need to rebase it
|
||
into the new version.
|
||
|
||
4. *Optionally Attempt to Build for Several Architectures:* Once you
|
||
successfully build the new software for a given architecture, you
|
||
could test the build for other architectures by changing the
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` variable and
|
||
rebuilding the software. This optional step is especially important
|
||
if the recipe is to be released publicly.
|
||
|
||
5. *Check the Upstream Change Log or Release Notes:* Checking both these
|
||
reveals if new features exist that could break
|
||
backwards-compatibility. If so, you need to take steps to mitigate or
|
||
eliminate that situation.
|
||
|
||
6. *Optionally Create a Bootable Image and Test:* If you want, you can
|
||
test the new software by booting it onto actual hardware.
|
||
|
||
7. *Create a Commit with the Change in the Layer Repository:* After all
|
||
builds work and any testing is successful, you can create commits for
|
||
any changes in the layer holding your upgraded recipe.
|
||
|
||
.. _finding-the-temporary-source-code:
|
||
|
||
Finding Temporary Source Code
|
||
=============================
|
||
|
||
You might find it helpful during development to modify the temporary
|
||
source code used by recipes to build packages. For example, suppose you
|
||
are developing a patch and you need to experiment a bit to figure out
|
||
your solution. After you have initially built the package, you can
|
||
iteratively tweak the source code, which is located in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`, and then you can
|
||
force a re-compile and quickly test your altered code. Once you settle
|
||
on a solution, you can then preserve your changes in the form of
|
||
patches.
|
||
|
||
During a build, the unpacked temporary source code used by recipes to
|
||
build packages is available in the Build Directory as defined by the
|
||
:term:`S` variable. Below is the default
|
||
value for the ``S`` variable as defined in the
|
||
``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory`: S =
|
||
"${WORKDIR}/${BP}" You should be aware that many recipes override the
|
||
``S`` variable. For example, recipes that fetch their source from Git
|
||
usually set ``S`` to ``${WORKDIR}/git``.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The
|
||
BP
|
||
represents the base recipe name, which consists of the name and
|
||
version:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
BP = "${BPN}-${PV}"
|
||
|
||
|
||
The path to the work directory for the recipe
|
||
(:term:`WORKDIR`) is defined as
|
||
follows:
|
||
${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR} The
|
||
actual directory depends on several things:
|
||
|
||
- :term:`TMPDIR`: The top-level build
|
||
output directory.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`:
|
||
The target system identifier.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PN`: The recipe name.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`EXTENDPE`: The epoch - (if
|
||
:term:`PE` is not specified, which is
|
||
usually the case for most recipes, then ``EXTENDPE`` is blank).
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PV`: The recipe version.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PR`: The recipe revision.
|
||
|
||
As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder named
|
||
``poky``, a default Build Directory at ``poky/build``, and a
|
||
``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose your
|
||
recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0.bb``. In this case, the work directory the
|
||
build system uses to build the package would be as follows:
|
||
poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0
|
||
|
||
.. _using-a-quilt-workflow:
|
||
|
||
Using Quilt in Your Workflow
|
||
============================
|
||
|
||
`Quilt <http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt>`__ is a powerful tool
|
||
that allows you to capture source code changes without having a clean
|
||
source tree. This section outlines the typical workflow you can use to
|
||
modify source code, test changes, and then preserve the changes in the
|
||
form of a patch all using Quilt.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
With regard to preserving changes to source files, if you clean a
|
||
recipe or have
|
||
rm_work
|
||
enabled, the
|
||
devtool
|
||
workflow
|
||
as described in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
|
||
Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual is a safer
|
||
development flow than the flow that uses Quilt.
|
||
|
||
Follow these general steps:
|
||
|
||
1. *Find the Source Code:* Temporary source code used by the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system is kept in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. See the
|
||
"`Finding Temporary Source
|
||
Code <#finding-the-temporary-source-code>`__" section to learn how to
|
||
locate the directory that has the temporary source code for a
|
||
particular package.
|
||
|
||
2. *Change Your Working Directory:* You need to be in the directory that
|
||
has the temporary source code. That directory is defined by the
|
||
:term:`S` variable.
|
||
|
||
3. *Create a New Patch:* Before modifying source code, you need to
|
||
create a new patch. To create a new patch file, use ``quilt new`` as
|
||
below: $ quilt new my_changes.patch
|
||
|
||
4. *Notify Quilt and Add Files:* After creating the patch, you need to
|
||
notify Quilt about the files you plan to edit. You notify Quilt by
|
||
adding the files to the patch you just created: $ quilt add file1.c
|
||
file2.c file3.c
|
||
|
||
5. *Edit the Files:* Make your changes in the source code to the files
|
||
you added to the patch.
|
||
|
||
6. *Test Your Changes:* Once you have modified the source code, the
|
||
easiest way to test your changes is by calling the ``do_compile``
|
||
task as shown in the following example: $ bitbake -c compile -f
|
||
package The ``-f`` or ``--force`` option forces the specified task to
|
||
execute. If you find problems with your code, you can just keep
|
||
editing and re-testing iteratively until things work as expected.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
All the modifications you make to the temporary source code
|
||
disappear once you run the
|
||
do_clean
|
||
or
|
||
do_cleanall
|
||
tasks using BitBake (i.e.
|
||
bitbake -c clean
|
||
package
|
||
and
|
||
bitbake -c cleanall
|
||
package
|
||
). Modifications will also disappear if you use the
|
||
rm_work
|
||
feature as described in the "
|
||
Conserving Disk Space During Builds
|
||
" section.
|
||
|
||
7. *Generate the Patch:* Once your changes work as expected, you need to
|
||
use Quilt to generate the final patch that contains all your
|
||
modifications. $ quilt refresh At this point, the
|
||
``my_changes.patch`` file has all your edits made to the ``file1.c``,
|
||
``file2.c``, and ``file3.c`` files.
|
||
|
||
You can find the resulting patch file in the ``patches/``
|
||
subdirectory of the source (``S``) directory.
|
||
|
||
8. *Copy the Patch File:* For simplicity, copy the patch file into a
|
||
directory named ``files``, which you can create in the same directory
|
||
that holds the recipe (``.bb``) file or the append (``.bbappend``)
|
||
file. Placing the patch here guarantees that the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system will find the patch. Next, add the patch into the ``SRC_URI``
|
||
of the recipe. Here is an example: SRC_URI +=
|
||
"file://my_changes.patch"
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-appdev-devshell:
|
||
|
||
Using a Development Shell
|
||
=========================
|
||
|
||
When debugging certain commands or even when just editing packages,
|
||
``devshell`` can be a useful tool. When you invoke ``devshell``, all
|
||
tasks up to and including
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` are run for the
|
||
specified target. Then, a new terminal is opened and you are placed in
|
||
``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``, the source
|
||
directory. In the new terminal, all the OpenEmbedded build-related
|
||
environment variables are still defined so you can use commands such as
|
||
``configure`` and ``make``. The commands execute just as if the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system were executing them. Consequently, working
|
||
this way can be helpful when debugging a build or preparing software to
|
||
be used with the OpenEmbedded build system.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example that uses ``devshell`` on a target named
|
||
``matchbox-desktop``: $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c devshell
|
||
|
||
This command spawns a terminal with a shell prompt within the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build environment. The
|
||
:term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable
|
||
controls what type of shell is opened.
|
||
|
||
For spawned terminals, the following occurs:
|
||
|
||
- The ``PATH`` variable includes the cross-toolchain.
|
||
|
||
- The ``pkgconfig`` variables find the correct ``.pc`` files.
|
||
|
||
- The ``configure`` command finds the Yocto Project site files as well
|
||
as any other necessary files.
|
||
|
||
Within this environment, you can run configure or compile commands as if
|
||
they were being run by the OpenEmbedded build system itself. As noted
|
||
earlier, the working directory also automatically changes to the Source
|
||
Directory (:term:`S`).
|
||
|
||
To manually run a specific task using ``devshell``, run the
|
||
corresponding ``run.*`` script in the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/temp``
|
||
directory (e.g., ``run.do_configure.``\ pid). If a task's script does
|
||
not exist, which would be the case if the task was skipped by way of the
|
||
sstate cache, you can create the task by first running it outside of the
|
||
``devshell``: $ bitbake -c task
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- Execution of a task's ``run.*`` script and BitBake's execution of
|
||
a task are identical. In other words, running the script re-runs
|
||
the task just as it would be run using the ``bitbake -c`` command.
|
||
|
||
- Any ``run.*`` file that does not have a ``.pid`` extension is a
|
||
symbolic link (symlink) to the most recent version of that file.
|
||
|
||
Remember, that the ``devshell`` is a mechanism that allows you to get
|
||
into the BitBake task execution environment. And as such, all commands
|
||
must be called just as BitBake would call them. That means you need to
|
||
provide the appropriate options for cross-compilation and so forth as
|
||
applicable.
|
||
|
||
When you are finished using ``devshell``, exit the shell or close the
|
||
terminal window.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- It is worth remembering that when using ``devshell`` you need to
|
||
use the full compiler name such as ``arm-poky-linux-gnueabi-gcc``
|
||
instead of just using ``gcc``. The same applies to other
|
||
applications such as ``binutils``, ``libtool`` and so forth.
|
||
BitBake sets up environment variables such as ``CC`` to assist
|
||
applications, such as ``make`` to find the correct tools.
|
||
|
||
- It is also worth noting that ``devshell`` still works over X11
|
||
forwarding and similar situations.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-appdev-devpyshell:
|
||
|
||
Using a Development Python Shell
|
||
================================
|
||
|
||
Similar to working within a development shell as described in the
|
||
previous section, you can also spawn and work within an interactive
|
||
Python development shell. When debugging certain commands or even when
|
||
just editing packages, ``devpyshell`` can be a useful tool. When you
|
||
invoke ``devpyshell``, all tasks up to and including
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` are run for the
|
||
specified target. Then a new terminal is opened. Additionally, key
|
||
Python objects and code are available in the same way they are to
|
||
BitBake tasks, in particular, the data store 'd'. So, commands such as
|
||
the following are useful when exploring the data store and running
|
||
functions: pydevshell> d.getVar("STAGING_DIR")
|
||
'/media/build1/poky/build/tmp/sysroots' pydevshell>
|
||
d.getVar("STAGING_DIR") '${TMPDIR}/sysroots' pydevshell> d.setVar("FOO",
|
||
"bar") pydevshell> d.getVar("FOO") 'bar' pydevshell> d.delVar("FOO")
|
||
pydevshell> d.getVar("FOO") pydevshell> bb.build.exec_func("do_unpack",
|
||
d) pydevshell> The commands execute just as if the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system were executing them. Consequently, working this way can be
|
||
helpful when debugging a build or preparing software to be used with the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example that uses ``devpyshell`` on a target named
|
||
``matchbox-desktop``: $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c devpyshell
|
||
|
||
This command spawns a terminal and places you in an interactive Python
|
||
interpreter within the OpenEmbedded build environment. The
|
||
:term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable
|
||
controls what type of shell is opened.
|
||
|
||
When you are finished using ``devpyshell``, you can exit the shell
|
||
either by using Ctrl+d or closing the terminal window.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-building:
|
||
|
||
Building
|
||
========
|
||
|
||
This section describes various build procedures. For example, the steps
|
||
needed for a simple build, a target that uses multiple configurations,
|
||
building an image for more than one machine, and so forth.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-building-a-simple-image:
|
||
|
||
Building a Simple Image
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
In the development environment, you need to build an image whenever you
|
||
change hardware support, add or change system libraries, or add or
|
||
change services that have dependencies. Several methods exist that allow
|
||
you to build an image within the Yocto Project. This section presents
|
||
the basic steps you need to build a simple image using BitBake from a
|
||
build host running Linux.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- For information on how to build an image using
|
||
`Toaster <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#toaster-term>`__, see the `Toaster
|
||
User Manual <&YOCTO_DOCS_TOAST_URL;>`__.
|
||
|
||
- For information on how to use ``devtool`` to build images, see the
|
||
"`Using ``devtool`` in Your SDK
|
||
Workflow <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#using-devtool-in-your-sdk-workflow>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
|
||
Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
|
||
|
||
- For a quick example on how to build an image using the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system, see the `Yocto Project Quick
|
||
Build <&YOCTO_DOCS_BRIEF_URL;>`__ document.
|
||
|
||
The build process creates an entire Linux distribution from source and
|
||
places it in your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` under
|
||
``tmp/deploy/images``. For detailed information on the build process
|
||
using BitBake, see the
|
||
"`Images <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#images-dev-environment>`__" section in the
|
||
Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
The following figure and list overviews the build process:
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/bitbake-build-flow.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
1. *Set up Your Host Development System to Support Development Using the
|
||
Yocto Project*: See the "`Setting Up to Use the Yocto
|
||
Project <#dev-manual-start>`__" section for options on how to get a
|
||
build host ready to use the Yocto Project.
|
||
|
||
2. *Initialize the Build Environment:* Initialize the build environment
|
||
by sourcing the build environment script (i.e.
|
||
````` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__): $ source
|
||
OE_INIT_FILE [build_dir]
|
||
|
||
When you use the initialization script, the OpenEmbedded build system
|
||
uses ``build`` as the default Build Directory in your current work
|
||
directory. You can use a build_dir argument with the script to
|
||
specify a different build directory.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A common practice is to use a different Build Directory for
|
||
different targets. For example,
|
||
~/build/x86
|
||
for a
|
||
qemux86
|
||
target, and
|
||
~/build/arm
|
||
for a
|
||
qemuarm
|
||
target.
|
||
|
||
3. *Make Sure Your ``local.conf`` File is Correct:* Ensure the
|
||
``conf/local.conf`` configuration file, which is found in the Build
|
||
Directory, is set up how you want it. This file defines many aspects
|
||
of the build environment including the target machine architecture
|
||
through the ``MACHINE`` variable, the packaging format used during
|
||
the build
|
||
(:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`),
|
||
and a centralized tarball download directory through the
|
||
:term:`DL_DIR` variable.
|
||
|
||
4. *Build the Image:* Build the image using the ``bitbake`` command: $
|
||
bitbake target
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For information on BitBake, see the
|
||
BitBake User Manual
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
The target is the name of the recipe you want to build. Common
|
||
targets are the images in ``meta/recipes-core/images``,
|
||
``meta/recipes-sato/images``, and so forth all found in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory`. Or, the target
|
||
can be the name of a recipe for a specific piece of software such as
|
||
BusyBox. For more details about the images the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system supports, see the
|
||
":ref:`ref-manual/ref-images:Images`" chapter in the Yocto
|
||
Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
As an example, the following command builds the
|
||
``core-image-minimal`` image: $ bitbake core-image-minimal Once an
|
||
image has been built, it often needs to be installed. The images and
|
||
kernels built by the OpenEmbedded build system are placed in the
|
||
Build Directory in ``tmp/deploy/images``. For information on how to
|
||
run pre-built images such as ``qemux86`` and ``qemuarm``, see the
|
||
`Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible Software
|
||
Development Kit (eSDK) <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;>`__ manual. For
|
||
information about how to install these images, see the documentation
|
||
for your particular board or machine.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-building-images-for-multiple-targets-using-multiple-configurations:
|
||
|
||
Building Images for Multiple Targets Using Multiple Configurations
|
||
------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can use a single ``bitbake`` command to build multiple images or
|
||
packages for different targets where each image or package requires a
|
||
different configuration (multiple configuration builds). The builds, in
|
||
this scenario, are sometimes referred to as "multiconfigs", and this
|
||
section uses that term throughout.
|
||
|
||
This section describes how to set up for multiple configuration builds
|
||
and how to account for cross-build dependencies between the
|
||
multiconfigs.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-setting-up-and-running-a-multiple-configuration-build:
|
||
|
||
Setting Up and Running a Multiple Configuration Build
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To accomplish a multiple configuration build, you must define each
|
||
target's configuration separately using a parallel configuration file in
|
||
the :term:`Build Directory`, and you
|
||
must follow a required file hierarchy. Additionally, you must enable the
|
||
multiple configuration builds in your ``local.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
Follow these steps to set up and execute multiple configuration builds:
|
||
|
||
- *Create Separate Configuration Files*: You need to create a single
|
||
configuration file for each build target (each multiconfig).
|
||
Minimally, each configuration file must define the machine and the
|
||
temporary directory BitBake uses for the build. Suggested practice
|
||
dictates that you do not overlap the temporary directories used
|
||
during the builds. However, it is possible that you can share the
|
||
temporary directory
|
||
(:term:`TMPDIR`). For example,
|
||
consider a scenario with two different multiconfigs for the same
|
||
:term:`MACHINE`: "qemux86" built
|
||
for two distributions such as "poky" and "poky-lsb". In this case,
|
||
you might want to use the same ``TMPDIR``.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example showing the minimal statements needed in a
|
||
configuration file for a "qemux86" target whose temporary build
|
||
directory is ``tmpmultix86``: MACHINE="qemux86"
|
||
TMPDIR="${TOPDIR}/tmpmultix86"
|
||
|
||
The location for these multiconfig configuration files is specific.
|
||
They must reside in the current build directory in a sub-directory of
|
||
``conf`` named ``multiconfig``. Following is an example that defines
|
||
two configuration files for the "x86" and "arm" multiconfigs:
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/multiconfig_files.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
The reason for this required file hierarchy is because the ``BBPATH``
|
||
variable is not constructed until the layers are parsed.
|
||
Consequently, using the configuration file as a pre-configuration
|
||
file is not possible unless it is located in the current working
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
- *Add the BitBake Multi-configuration Variable to the Local
|
||
Configuration File*: Use the
|
||
:term:`BBMULTICONFIG`
|
||
variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file to specify
|
||
each multiconfig. Continuing with the example from the previous
|
||
figure, the ``BBMULTICONFIG`` variable needs to enable two
|
||
multiconfigs: "x86" and "arm" by specifying each configuration file:
|
||
BBMULTICONFIG = "x86 arm"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A "default" configuration already exists by definition. This
|
||
configuration is named: "" (i.e. empty string) and is defined by
|
||
the variables coming from your
|
||
local.conf
|
||
file. Consequently, the previous example actually adds two
|
||
additional configurations to your build: "arm" and "x86" along
|
||
with "".
|
||
|
||
- *Launch BitBake*: Use the following BitBake command form to launch
|
||
the multiple configuration build: $ bitbake
|
||
[mc:multiconfigname:]target [[[mc:multiconfigname:]target] ... ] For
|
||
the example in this section, the following command applies: $ bitbake
|
||
mc:x86:core-image-minimal mc:arm:core-image-sato mc::core-image-base
|
||
The previous BitBake command builds a ``core-image-minimal`` image
|
||
that is configured through the ``x86.conf`` configuration file, a
|
||
``core-image-sato`` image that is configured through the ``arm.conf``
|
||
configuration file and a ``core-image-base`` that is configured
|
||
through your ``local.conf`` configuration file.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Support for multiple configuration builds in the Yocto Project DISTRO
|
||
(DISTRO_NAME) Release does not include Shared State (sstate)
|
||
optimizations. Consequently, if a build uses the same object twice
|
||
in, for example, two different
|
||
TMPDIR
|
||
directories, the build either loads from an existing sstate cache for
|
||
that build at the start or builds the object fresh.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-enabling-multiple-configuration-build-dependencies:
|
||
|
||
Enabling Multiple Configuration Build Dependencies
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Sometimes dependencies can exist between targets (multiconfigs) in a
|
||
multiple configuration build. For example, suppose that in order to
|
||
build a ``core-image-sato`` image for an "x86" multiconfig, the root
|
||
filesystem of an "arm" multiconfig must exist. This dependency is
|
||
essentially that the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-image` task in the
|
||
``core-image-sato`` recipe depends on the completion of the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task of the
|
||
``core-image-minimal`` recipe.
|
||
|
||
To enable dependencies in a multiple configuration build, you must
|
||
declare the dependencies in the recipe using the following statement
|
||
form: task_or_package[mcdepends] =
|
||
"mc:from_multiconfig:to_multiconfig:recipe_name:task_on_which_to_depend"
|
||
To better show how to use this statement, consider the example scenario
|
||
from the first paragraph of this section. The following statement needs
|
||
to be added to the recipe that builds the ``core-image-sato`` image:
|
||
do_image[mcdepends] = "mc:x86:arm:core-image-minimal:do_rootfs" In this
|
||
example, the from_multiconfig is "x86". The to_multiconfig is "arm". The
|
||
task on which the ``do_image`` task in the recipe depends is the
|
||
``do_rootfs`` task from the ``core-image-minimal`` recipe associated
|
||
with the "arm" multiconfig.
|
||
|
||
Once you set up this dependency, you can build the "x86" multiconfig
|
||
using a BitBake command as follows: $ bitbake mc:x86:core-image-sato
|
||
This command executes all the tasks needed to create the
|
||
``core-image-sato`` image for the "x86" multiconfig. Because of the
|
||
dependency, BitBake also executes through the ``do_rootfs`` task for the
|
||
"arm" multiconfig build.
|
||
|
||
Having a recipe depend on the root filesystem of another build might not
|
||
seem that useful. Consider this change to the statement in the
|
||
``core-image-sato`` recipe: do_image[mcdepends] =
|
||
"mc:x86:arm:core-image-minimal:do_image" In this case, BitBake must
|
||
create the ``core-image-minimal`` image for the "arm" build since the
|
||
"x86" build depends on it.
|
||
|
||
Because "x86" and "arm" are enabled for multiple configuration builds
|
||
and have separate configuration files, BitBake places the artifacts for
|
||
each build in the respective temporary build directories (i.e.
|
||
:term:`TMPDIR`).
|
||
|
||
.. _building-an-initramfs-image:
|
||
|
||
Building an Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) Image
|
||
----------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
An initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) image provides a temporary root
|
||
filesystem used for early system initialization (e.g. loading of modules
|
||
needed to locate and mount the "real" root filesystem).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The initramfs image is the successor of initial RAM disk (initrd). It
|
||
is a "copy in and out" (cpio) archive of the initial filesystem that
|
||
gets loaded into memory during the Linux startup process. Because
|
||
Linux uses the contents of the archive during initialization, the
|
||
initramfs image needs to contain all of the device drivers and tools
|
||
needed to mount the final root filesystem.
|
||
|
||
Follow these steps to create an initramfs image:
|
||
|
||
1. *Create the initramfs Image Recipe:* You can reference the
|
||
``core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb`` recipe found in the
|
||
``meta/recipes-core`` directory of the :term:`Source Directory`
|
||
as an example
|
||
from which to work.
|
||
|
||
2. *Decide if You Need to Bundle the initramfs Image Into the Kernel
|
||
Image:* If you want the initramfs image that is built to be bundled
|
||
in with the kernel image, set the
|
||
:term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE`
|
||
variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` configuration file and set the
|
||
:term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE`
|
||
variable in the recipe that builds the kernel image.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
It is recommended that you do bundle the initramfs image with the
|
||
kernel image to avoid circular dependencies between the kernel
|
||
recipe and the initramfs recipe should the initramfs image include
|
||
kernel modules.
|
||
|
||
Setting the ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE`` flag causes the initramfs
|
||
image to be unpacked into the ``${B}/usr/`` directory. The unpacked
|
||
initramfs image is then passed to the kernel's ``Makefile`` using the
|
||
:term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE`
|
||
variable, allowing the initramfs image to be built into the kernel
|
||
normally.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you choose to not bundle the initramfs image with the kernel
|
||
image, you are essentially using an
|
||
Initial RAM Disk (initrd)
|
||
. Creating an initrd is handled primarily through the
|
||
INITRD_IMAGE
|
||
,
|
||
INITRD_LIVE
|
||
, and
|
||
INITRD_IMAGE_LIVE
|
||
variables. For more information, see the
|
||
image-live.bbclass
|
||
file.
|
||
|
||
3. *Optionally Add Items to the initramfs Image Through the initramfs
|
||
Image Recipe:* If you add items to the initramfs image by way of its
|
||
recipe, you should use
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL`
|
||
rather than
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`.
|
||
``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` gives more direct control of what is added to the
|
||
image as compared to the defaults you might not necessarily want that
|
||
are set by the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>`
|
||
or :ref:`core-image <ref-classes-core-image>`
|
||
classes.
|
||
|
||
4. *Build the Kernel Image and the initramfs Image:* Build your kernel
|
||
image using BitBake. Because the initramfs image recipe is a
|
||
dependency of the kernel image, the initramfs image is built as well
|
||
and bundled with the kernel image if you used the
|
||
:term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE`
|
||
variable described earlier.
|
||
|
||
Building a Tiny System
|
||
----------------------
|
||
|
||
Very small distributions have some significant advantages such as
|
||
requiring less on-die or in-package memory (cheaper), better performance
|
||
through efficient cache usage, lower power requirements due to less
|
||
memory, faster boot times, and reduced development overhead. Some
|
||
real-world examples where a very small distribution gives you distinct
|
||
advantages are digital cameras, medical devices, and small headless
|
||
systems.
|
||
|
||
This section presents information that shows you how you can trim your
|
||
distribution to even smaller sizes than the ``poky-tiny`` distribution,
|
||
which is around 5 Mbytes, that can be built out-of-the-box using the
|
||
Yocto Project.
|
||
|
||
.. _tiny-system-overview:
|
||
|
||
Overview
|
||
~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The following list presents the overall steps you need to consider and
|
||
perform to create distributions with smaller root filesystems, achieve
|
||
faster boot times, maintain your critical functionality, and avoid
|
||
initial RAM disks:
|
||
|
||
- `Determine your goals and guiding
|
||
principles. <#goals-and-guiding-principles>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Understand what contributes to your image
|
||
size. <#understand-what-gives-your-image-size>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Reduce the size of the root
|
||
filesystem. <#trim-the-root-filesystem>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Reduce the size of the kernel. <#trim-the-kernel>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Eliminate packaging
|
||
requirements. <#remove-package-management-requirements>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Look for other ways to minimize
|
||
size. <#look-for-other-ways-to-minimize-size>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Iterate on the process. <#iterate-on-the-process>`__
|
||
|
||
Goals and Guiding Principles
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Before you can reach your destination, you need to know where you are
|
||
going. Here is an example list that you can use as a guide when creating
|
||
very small distributions:
|
||
|
||
- Determine how much space you need (e.g. a kernel that is 1 Mbyte or
|
||
less and a root filesystem that is 3 Mbytes or less).
|
||
|
||
- Find the areas that are currently taking 90% of the space and
|
||
concentrate on reducing those areas.
|
||
|
||
- Do not create any difficult "hacks" to achieve your goals.
|
||
|
||
- Leverage the device-specific options.
|
||
|
||
- Work in a separate layer so that you keep changes isolated. For
|
||
information on how to create layers, see the "`Understanding and
|
||
Creating Layers <#understanding-and-creating-layers>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
.. _understand-what-gives-your-image-size:
|
||
|
||
Understand What Contributes to Your Image Size
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
It is easiest to have something to start with when creating your own
|
||
distribution. You can use the Yocto Project out-of-the-box to create the
|
||
``poky-tiny`` distribution. Ultimately, you will want to make changes in
|
||
your own distribution that are likely modeled after ``poky-tiny``.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
To use
|
||
poky-tiny
|
||
in your build, set the
|
||
DISTRO
|
||
variable in your
|
||
local.conf
|
||
file to "poky-tiny" as described in the "
|
||
Creating Your Own Distribution
|
||
" section.
|
||
|
||
Understanding some memory concepts will help you reduce the system size.
|
||
Memory consists of static, dynamic, and temporary memory. Static memory
|
||
is the TEXT (code), DATA (initialized data in the code), and BSS
|
||
(uninitialized data) sections. Dynamic memory represents memory that is
|
||
allocated at runtime: stacks, hash tables, and so forth. Temporary
|
||
memory is recovered after the boot process. This memory consists of
|
||
memory used for decompressing the kernel and for the ``__init__``
|
||
functions.
|
||
|
||
To help you see where you currently are with kernel and root filesystem
|
||
sizes, you can use two tools found in the :term:`Source Directory`
|
||
in the
|
||
``scripts/tiny/`` directory:
|
||
|
||
- ``ksize.py``: Reports component sizes for the kernel build objects.
|
||
|
||
- ``dirsize.py``: Reports component sizes for the root filesystem.
|
||
|
||
This next tool and command help you organize configuration fragments and
|
||
view file dependencies in a human-readable form:
|
||
|
||
- ``merge_config.sh``: Helps you manage configuration files and
|
||
fragments within the kernel. With this tool, you can merge individual
|
||
configuration fragments together. The tool allows you to make
|
||
overrides and warns you of any missing configuration options. The
|
||
tool is ideal for allowing you to iterate on configurations, create
|
||
minimal configurations, and create configuration files for different
|
||
machines without having to duplicate your process.
|
||
|
||
The ``merge_config.sh`` script is part of the Linux Yocto kernel Git
|
||
repositories (i.e. ``linux-yocto-3.14``, ``linux-yocto-3.10``,
|
||
``linux-yocto-3.8``, and so forth) in the ``scripts/kconfig``
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
For more information on configuration fragments, see the "`Creating
|
||
Configuration
|
||
Fragments <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#creating-config-fragments>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
|
||
|
||
- ``bitbake -u taskexp -g bitbake_target``: Using the BitBake command
|
||
with these options brings up a Dependency Explorer from which you can
|
||
view file dependencies. Understanding these dependencies allows you
|
||
to make informed decisions when cutting out various pieces of the
|
||
kernel and root filesystem.
|
||
|
||
Trim the Root Filesystem
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The root filesystem is made up of packages for booting, libraries, and
|
||
applications. To change things, you can configure how the packaging
|
||
happens, which changes the way you build them. You can also modify the
|
||
filesystem itself or select a different filesystem.
|
||
|
||
First, find out what is hogging your root filesystem by running the
|
||
``dirsize.py`` script from your root directory: $ cd
|
||
root-directory-of-image $ dirsize.py 100000 > dirsize-100k.log $ cat
|
||
dirsize-100k.log You can apply a filter to the script to ignore files
|
||
under a certain size. The previous example filters out any files below
|
||
100 Kbytes. The sizes reported by the tool are uncompressed, and thus
|
||
will be smaller by a relatively constant factor in a compressed root
|
||
filesystem. When you examine your log file, you can focus on areas of
|
||
the root filesystem that take up large amounts of memory.
|
||
|
||
You need to be sure that what you eliminate does not cripple the
|
||
functionality you need. One way to see how packages relate to each other
|
||
is by using the Dependency Explorer UI with the BitBake command: $ cd
|
||
image-directory $ bitbake -u taskexp -g image Use the interface to
|
||
select potential packages you wish to eliminate and see their dependency
|
||
relationships.
|
||
|
||
When deciding how to reduce the size, get rid of packages that result in
|
||
minimal impact on the feature set. For example, you might not need a VGA
|
||
display. Or, you might be able to get by with ``devtmpfs`` and ``mdev``
|
||
instead of ``udev``.
|
||
|
||
Use your ``local.conf`` file to make changes. For example, to eliminate
|
||
``udev`` and ``glib``, set the following in the local configuration
|
||
file: VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = ""
|
||
|
||
Finally, you should consider exactly the type of root filesystem you
|
||
need to meet your needs while also reducing its size. For example,
|
||
consider ``cramfs``, ``squashfs``, ``ubifs``, ``ext2``, or an
|
||
``initramfs`` using ``initramfs``. Be aware that ``ext3`` requires a 1
|
||
Mbyte journal. If you are okay with running read-only, you do not need
|
||
this journal.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
After each round of elimination, you need to rebuild your system and
|
||
then use the tools to see the effects of your reductions.
|
||
|
||
Trim the Kernel
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The kernel is built by including policies for hardware-independent
|
||
aspects. What subsystems do you enable? For what architecture are you
|
||
building? Which drivers do you build by default?
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can modify the kernel source if you want to help with boot time.
|
||
|
||
Run the ``ksize.py`` script from the top-level Linux build directory to
|
||
get an idea of what is making up the kernel: $ cd
|
||
top-level-linux-build-directory $ ksize.py > ksize.log $ cat ksize.log
|
||
When you examine the log, you will see how much space is taken up with
|
||
the built-in ``.o`` files for drivers, networking, core kernel files,
|
||
filesystem, sound, and so forth. The sizes reported by the tool are
|
||
uncompressed, and thus will be smaller by a relatively constant factor
|
||
in a compressed kernel image. Look to reduce the areas that are large
|
||
and taking up around the "90% rule."
|
||
|
||
To examine, or drill down, into any particular area, use the ``-d``
|
||
option with the script: $ ksize.py -d > ksize.log Using this option
|
||
breaks out the individual file information for each area of the kernel
|
||
(e.g. drivers, networking, and so forth).
|
||
|
||
Use your log file to see what you can eliminate from the kernel based on
|
||
features you can let go. For example, if you are not going to need
|
||
sound, you do not need any drivers that support sound.
|
||
|
||
After figuring out what to eliminate, you need to reconfigure the kernel
|
||
to reflect those changes during the next build. You could run
|
||
``menuconfig`` and make all your changes at once. However, that makes it
|
||
difficult to see the effects of your individual eliminations and also
|
||
makes it difficult to replicate the changes for perhaps another target
|
||
device. A better method is to start with no configurations using
|
||
``allnoconfig``, create configuration fragments for individual changes,
|
||
and then manage the fragments into a single configuration file using
|
||
``merge_config.sh``. The tool makes it easy for you to iterate using the
|
||
configuration change and build cycle.
|
||
|
||
Each time you make configuration changes, you need to rebuild the kernel
|
||
and check to see what impact your changes had on the overall size.
|
||
|
||
Remove Package Management Requirements
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Packaging requirements add size to the image. One way to reduce the size
|
||
of the image is to remove all the packaging requirements from the image.
|
||
This reduction includes both removing the package manager and its unique
|
||
dependencies as well as removing the package management data itself.
|
||
|
||
To eliminate all the packaging requirements for an image, be sure that
|
||
"package-management" is not part of your
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
|
||
statement for the image. When you remove this feature, you are removing
|
||
the package manager as well as its dependencies from the root
|
||
filesystem.
|
||
|
||
Look for Other Ways to Minimize Size
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Depending on your particular circumstances, other areas that you can
|
||
trim likely exist. The key to finding these areas is through tools and
|
||
methods described here combined with experimentation and iteration. Here
|
||
are a couple of areas to experiment with:
|
||
|
||
- ``glibc``: In general, follow this process:
|
||
|
||
1. Remove ``glibc`` features from
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
|
||
that you think you do not need.
|
||
|
||
2. Build your distribution.
|
||
|
||
3. If the build fails due to missing symbols in a package, determine
|
||
if you can reconfigure the package to not need those features. For
|
||
example, change the configuration to not support wide character
|
||
support as is done for ``ncurses``. Or, if support for those
|
||
characters is needed, determine what ``glibc`` features provide
|
||
the support and restore the configuration.
|
||
|
||
4. Rebuild and repeat the process.
|
||
|
||
- ``busybox``: For BusyBox, use a process similar as described for
|
||
``glibc``. A difference is you will need to boot the resulting system
|
||
to see if you are able to do everything you expect from the running
|
||
system. You need to be sure to integrate configuration fragments into
|
||
Busybox because BusyBox handles its own core features and then allows
|
||
you to add configuration fragments on top.
|
||
|
||
Iterate on the Process
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
If you have not reached your goals on system size, you need to iterate
|
||
on the process. The process is the same. Use the tools and see just what
|
||
is taking up 90% of the root filesystem and the kernel. Decide what you
|
||
can eliminate without limiting your device beyond what you need.
|
||
|
||
Depending on your system, a good place to look might be Busybox, which
|
||
provides a stripped down version of Unix tools in a single, executable
|
||
file. You might be able to drop virtual terminal services or perhaps
|
||
ipv6.
|
||
|
||
Building Images for More than One Machine
|
||
-----------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
A common scenario developers face is creating images for several
|
||
different machines that use the same software environment. In this
|
||
situation, it is tempting to set the tunings and optimization flags for
|
||
each build specifically for the targeted hardware (i.e. "maxing out" the
|
||
tunings). Doing so can considerably add to build times and package feed
|
||
maintenance collectively for the machines. For example, selecting tunes
|
||
that are extremely specific to a CPU core used in a system might enable
|
||
some micro optimizations in GCC for that particular system but would
|
||
otherwise not gain you much of a performance difference across the other
|
||
systems as compared to using a more general tuning across all the builds
|
||
(e.g. setting :term:`DEFAULTTUNE`
|
||
specifically for each machine's build). Rather than "max out" each
|
||
build's tunings, you can take steps that cause the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system to reuse software across the various machines where it makes
|
||
sense.
|
||
|
||
If build speed and package feed maintenance are considerations, you
|
||
should consider the points in this section that can help you optimize
|
||
your tunings to best consider build times and package feed maintenance.
|
||
|
||
- *Share the Build Directory:* If at all possible, share the
|
||
:term:`TMPDIR` across builds. The
|
||
Yocto Project supports switching between different
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` values in the same
|
||
``TMPDIR``. This practice is well supported and regularly used by
|
||
developers when building for multiple machines. When you use the same
|
||
``TMPDIR`` for multiple machine builds, the OpenEmbedded build system
|
||
can reuse the existing native and often cross-recipes for multiple
|
||
machines. Thus, build time decreases.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If
|
||
DISTRO
|
||
settings change or fundamental configuration settings such as the
|
||
filesystem layout, you need to work with a clean
|
||
TMPDIR
|
||
. Sharing
|
||
TMPDIR
|
||
under these circumstances might work but since it is not
|
||
guaranteed, you should use a clean
|
||
TMPDIR
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
- *Enable the Appropriate Package Architecture:* By default, the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system enables three levels of package
|
||
architectures: "all", "tune" or "package", and "machine". Any given
|
||
recipe usually selects one of these package architectures (types) for
|
||
its output. Depending for what a given recipe creates packages,
|
||
making sure you enable the appropriate package architecture can
|
||
directly impact the build time.
|
||
|
||
A recipe that just generates scripts can enable "all" architecture
|
||
because there are no binaries to build. To specifically enable "all"
|
||
architecture, be sure your recipe inherits the
|
||
:ref:`allarch <ref-classes-allarch>` class.
|
||
This class is useful for "all" architectures because it configures
|
||
many variables so packages can be used across multiple architectures.
|
||
|
||
If your recipe needs to generate packages that are machine-specific
|
||
or when one of the build or runtime dependencies is already
|
||
machine-architecture dependent, which makes your recipe also
|
||
machine-architecture dependent, make sure your recipe enables the
|
||
"machine" package architecture through the
|
||
:term:`MACHINE_ARCH`
|
||
variable: PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}" When you do not
|
||
specifically enable a package architecture through the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_ARCH`, The
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system defaults to the
|
||
:term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` setting:
|
||
PACKAGE_ARCH = "${TUNE_PKGARCH}"
|
||
|
||
- *Choose a Generic Tuning File if Possible:* Some tunes are more
|
||
generic and can run on multiple targets (e.g. an ``armv5`` set of
|
||
packages could run on ``armv6`` and ``armv7`` processors in most
|
||
cases). Similarly, ``i486`` binaries could work on ``i586`` and
|
||
higher processors. You should realize, however, that advances on
|
||
newer processor versions would not be used.
|
||
|
||
If you select the same tune for several different machines, the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system reuses software previously built, thus
|
||
speeding up the overall build time. Realize that even though a new
|
||
sysroot for each machine is generated, the software is not recompiled
|
||
and only one package feed exists.
|
||
|
||
- *Manage Granular Level Packaging:* Sometimes cases exist where
|
||
injecting another level of package architecture beyond the three
|
||
higher levels noted earlier can be useful. For example, consider how
|
||
NXP (formerly Freescale) allows for the easy reuse of binary packages
|
||
in their layer
|
||
```meta-freescale`` <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;/cgit/cgit.cgi/meta-freescale/>`__.
|
||
In this example, the
|
||
```fsl-dynamic-packagearch`` <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;/cgit/cgit.cgi/meta-freescale/tree/classes/fsl-dynamic-packagearch.bbclass>`__
|
||
class shares GPU packages for i.MX53 boards because all boards share
|
||
the AMD GPU. The i.MX6-based boards can do the same because all
|
||
boards share the Vivante GPU. This class inspects the BitBake
|
||
datastore to identify if the package provides or depends on one of
|
||
the sub-architecture values. If so, the class sets the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` value
|
||
based on the ``MACHINE_SUBARCH`` value. If the package does not
|
||
provide or depend on one of the sub-architecture values but it
|
||
matches a value in the machine-specific filter, it sets
|
||
:term:`MACHINE_ARCH`. This
|
||
behavior reduces the number of packages built and saves build time by
|
||
reusing binaries.
|
||
|
||
- *Use Tools to Debug Issues:* Sometimes you can run into situations
|
||
where software is being rebuilt when you think it should not be. For
|
||
example, the OpenEmbedded build system might not be using shared
|
||
state between machines when you think it should be. These types of
|
||
situations are usually due to references to machine-specific
|
||
variables such as :term:`MACHINE`,
|
||
:term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`,
|
||
:term:`XSERVER`,
|
||
:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`,
|
||
and so forth in code that is supposed to only be tune-specific or
|
||
when the recipe depends
|
||
(:term:`DEPENDS`,
|
||
:term:`RDEPENDS`,
|
||
:term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
|
||
:term:`RSUGGESTS`, and so forth)
|
||
on some other recipe that already has
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` defined
|
||
as "${MACHINE_ARCH}".
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Patches to fix any issues identified are most welcome as these
|
||
issues occasionally do occur.
|
||
|
||
For such cases, you can use some tools to help you sort out the
|
||
situation:
|
||
|
||
- *``sstate-diff-machines.sh``:* You can find this tool in the
|
||
``scripts`` directory of the Source Repositories. See the comments
|
||
in the script for information on how to use the tool.
|
||
|
||
- *BitBake's "-S printdiff" Option:* Using this option causes
|
||
BitBake to try to establish the closest signature match it can
|
||
(e.g. in the shared state cache) and then run ``bitbake-diffsigs``
|
||
over the matches to determine the stamps and delta where these two
|
||
stamp trees diverge.
|
||
|
||
Building Software from an External Source
|
||
-----------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` when building source
|
||
code. The build process involves fetching the source files, unpacking
|
||
them, and then patching them if necessary before the build takes place.
|
||
|
||
Situations exist where you might want to build software from source
|
||
files that are external to and thus outside of the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system. For example, suppose you have a project that includes a new BSP
|
||
with a heavily customized kernel. And, you want to minimize exposing the
|
||
build system to the development team so that they can focus on their
|
||
project and maintain everyone's workflow as much as possible. In this
|
||
case, you want a kernel source directory on the development machine
|
||
where the development occurs. You want the recipe's
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` variable to point to
|
||
the external directory and use it as is, not copy it.
|
||
|
||
To build from software that comes from an external source, all you need
|
||
to do is inherit the
|
||
:ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` class
|
||
and then set the
|
||
:term:`EXTERNALSRC` variable to
|
||
point to your external source code. Here are the statements to put in
|
||
your ``local.conf`` file: INHERIT += "externalsrc"
|
||
EXTERNALSRC_pn-myrecipe = "path-to-your-source-tree"
|
||
|
||
This next example shows how to accomplish the same thing by setting
|
||
``EXTERNALSRC`` in the recipe itself or in the recipe's append file:
|
||
EXTERNALSRC = "path" EXTERNALSRC_BUILD = "path"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
In order for these settings to take effect, you must globally or
|
||
locally inherit the
|
||
externalsrc
|
||
class.
|
||
|
||
By default, ``externalsrc.bbclass`` builds the source code in a
|
||
directory separate from the external source directory as specified by
|
||
:term:`EXTERNALSRC`. If you need
|
||
to have the source built in the same directory in which it resides, or
|
||
some other nominated directory, you can set
|
||
:term:`EXTERNALSRC_BUILD`
|
||
to point to that directory: EXTERNALSRC_BUILD_pn-myrecipe =
|
||
"path-to-your-source-tree"
|
||
|
||
Replicating a Build Offline
|
||
---------------------------
|
||
|
||
It can be useful to take a "snapshot" of upstream sources used in a
|
||
build and then use that "snapshot" later to replicate the build offline.
|
||
To do so, you need to first prepare and populate your downloads
|
||
directory your "snapshot" of files. Once your downloads directory is
|
||
ready, you can use it at any time and from any machine to replicate your
|
||
build.
|
||
|
||
Follow these steps to populate your Downloads directory:
|
||
|
||
1. *Create a Clean Downloads Directory:* Start with an empty downloads
|
||
directory (:term:`DL_DIR`). You
|
||
start with an empty downloads directory by either removing the files
|
||
in the existing directory or by setting ``DL_DIR`` to point to either
|
||
an empty location or one that does not yet exist.
|
||
|
||
2. *Generate Tarballs of the Source Git Repositories:* Edit your
|
||
``local.conf`` configuration file as follows: DL_DIR =
|
||
"/home/your-download-dir/" BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1" During
|
||
the fetch process in the next step, BitBake gathers the source files
|
||
and creates tarballs in the directory pointed to by ``DL_DIR``. See
|
||
the
|
||
:term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS`
|
||
variable for more information.
|
||
|
||
3. *Populate Your Downloads Directory Without Building:* Use BitBake to
|
||
fetch your sources but inhibit the build: $ bitbake target
|
||
--runonly=fetch The downloads directory (i.e. ``${DL_DIR}``) now has
|
||
a "snapshot" of the source files in the form of tarballs, which can
|
||
be used for the build.
|
||
|
||
4. *Optionally Remove Any Git or other SCM Subdirectories From the
|
||
Downloads Directory:* If you want, you can clean up your downloads
|
||
directory by removing any Git or other Source Control Management
|
||
(SCM) subdirectories such as ``${DL_DIR}/git2/*``. The tarballs
|
||
already contain these subdirectories.
|
||
|
||
Once your downloads directory has everything it needs regarding source
|
||
files, you can create your "own-mirror" and build your target.
|
||
Understand that you can use the files to build the target offline from
|
||
any machine and at any time.
|
||
|
||
Follow these steps to build your target using the files in the downloads
|
||
directory:
|
||
|
||
1. *Using Local Files Only:* Inside your ``local.conf`` file, add the
|
||
:term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL`
|
||
variable, inherit the
|
||
:ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>`
|
||
class, and use the
|
||
```BB_NO_NETWORK`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#var-bb-BB_NO_NETWORK>`__
|
||
variable to your ``local.conf``. SOURCE_MIRROR_URL ?=
|
||
"file:///home/your-download-dir/" INHERIT += "own-mirrors"
|
||
BB_NO_NETWORK = "1" The ``SOURCE_MIRROR_URL`` and ``own-mirror``
|
||
class set up the system to use the downloads directory as your "own
|
||
mirror". Using the ``BB_NO_NETWORK`` variable makes sure that
|
||
BitBake's fetching process in step 3 stays local, which means files
|
||
from your "own-mirror" are used.
|
||
|
||
2. *Start With a Clean Build:* You can start with a clean build by
|
||
removing the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}``
|
||
directory or using a new :term:`Build Directory`.
|
||
|
||
3. *Build Your Target:* Use BitBake to build your target: $ bitbake
|
||
target The build completes using the known local "snapshot" of source
|
||
files from your mirror. The resulting tarballs for your "snapshot" of
|
||
source files are in the downloads directory.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The offline build does not work if recipes attempt to find the
|
||
latest version of software by setting
|
||
:term:`SRCREV` to
|
||
``${``\ :term:`AUTOREV`\ ``}``:
|
||
SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}" When a recipe sets ``SRCREV`` to
|
||
``${AUTOREV}``, the build system accesses the network in an
|
||
attempt to determine the latest version of software from the SCM.
|
||
Typically, recipes that use ``AUTOREV`` are custom or modified
|
||
recipes. Recipes that reside in public repositories usually do not
|
||
use ``AUTOREV``.
|
||
|
||
If you do have recipes that use ``AUTOREV``, you can take steps to
|
||
still use the recipes in an offline build. Do the following:
|
||
|
||
1. Use a configuration generated by enabling `build
|
||
history <#maintaining-build-output-quality>`__.
|
||
|
||
2. Use the ``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs`` command to collect the
|
||
stored ``SRCREV`` values from the build's history. For more
|
||
information on collecting these values, see the "`Build History
|
||
Package Information <#build-history-package-information>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
3. Once you have the correct source revisions, you can modify
|
||
those recipes to to set ``SRCREV`` to specific versions of the
|
||
software.
|
||
|
||
Speeding Up a Build
|
||
===================
|
||
|
||
Build time can be an issue. By default, the build system uses simple
|
||
controls to try and maximize build efficiency. In general, the default
|
||
settings for all the following variables result in the most efficient
|
||
build times when dealing with single socket systems (i.e. a single CPU).
|
||
If you have multiple CPUs, you might try increasing the default values
|
||
to gain more speed. See the descriptions in the glossary for each
|
||
variable for more information:
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS`:
|
||
The maximum number of threads BitBake simultaneously executes.
|
||
|
||
- ```BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS``: <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#var-BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS>`__
|
||
The number of threads BitBake uses during parsing.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`: Extra
|
||
options passed to the ``make`` command during the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task in
|
||
order to specify parallel compilation on the local build host.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST`:
|
||
Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in
|
||
order to specify parallel installation on the local build host.
|
||
|
||
As mentioned, these variables all scale to the number of processor cores
|
||
available on the build system. For single socket systems, this
|
||
auto-scaling ensures that the build system fundamentally takes advantage
|
||
of potential parallel operations during the build based on the build
|
||
machine's capabilities.
|
||
|
||
Following are additional factors that can affect build speed:
|
||
|
||
- File system type: The file system type that the build is being
|
||
performed on can also influence performance. Using ``ext4`` is
|
||
recommended as compared to ``ext2`` and ``ext3`` due to ``ext4``
|
||
improved features such as extents.
|
||
|
||
- Disabling the updating of access time using ``noatime``: The
|
||
``noatime`` mount option prevents the build system from updating file
|
||
and directory access times.
|
||
|
||
- Setting a longer commit: Using the "commit=" mount option increases
|
||
the interval in seconds between disk cache writes. Changing this
|
||
interval from the five second default to something longer increases
|
||
the risk of data loss but decreases the need to write to the disk,
|
||
thus increasing the build performance.
|
||
|
||
- Choosing the packaging backend: Of the available packaging backends,
|
||
IPK is the fastest. Additionally, selecting a singular packaging
|
||
backend also helps.
|
||
|
||
- Using ``tmpfs`` for :term:`TMPDIR`
|
||
as a temporary file system: While this can help speed up the build,
|
||
the benefits are limited due to the compiler using ``-pipe``. The
|
||
build system goes to some lengths to avoid ``sync()`` calls into the
|
||
file system on the principle that if there was a significant failure,
|
||
the :term:`Build Directory`
|
||
contents could easily be rebuilt.
|
||
|
||
- Inheriting the
|
||
:ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` class:
|
||
Inheriting this class has shown to speed up builds due to
|
||
significantly lower amounts of data stored in the data cache as well
|
||
as on disk. Inheriting this class also makes cleanup of
|
||
:term:`TMPDIR` faster, at the
|
||
expense of being easily able to dive into the source code. File
|
||
system maintainers have recommended that the fastest way to clean up
|
||
large numbers of files is to reformat partitions rather than delete
|
||
files due to the linear nature of partitions. This, of course,
|
||
assumes you structure the disk partitions and file systems in a way
|
||
that this is practical.
|
||
|
||
Aside from the previous list, you should keep some trade offs in mind
|
||
that can help you speed up the build:
|
||
|
||
- Remove items from
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
|
||
that you might not need.
|
||
|
||
- Exclude debug symbols and other debug information: If you do not need
|
||
these symbols and other debug information, disabling the ``*-dbg``
|
||
package generation can speed up the build. You can disable this
|
||
generation by setting the
|
||
:term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT`
|
||
variable to "1".
|
||
|
||
- Disable static library generation for recipes derived from
|
||
``autoconf`` or ``libtool``: Following is an example showing how to
|
||
disable static libraries and still provide an override to handle
|
||
exceptions: STATICLIBCONF = "--disable-static"
|
||
STATICLIBCONF_sqlite3-native = "" EXTRA_OECONF += "${STATICLIBCONF}"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- Some recipes need static libraries in order to work correctly
|
||
(e.g. ``pseudo-native`` needs ``sqlite3-native``). Overrides,
|
||
as in the previous example, account for these kinds of
|
||
exceptions.
|
||
|
||
- Some packages have packaging code that assumes the presence of
|
||
the static libraries. If so, you might need to exclude them as
|
||
well.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-working-with-libraries:
|
||
|
||
Working With Libraries
|
||
======================
|
||
|
||
Libraries are an integral part of your system. This section describes
|
||
some common practices you might find helpful when working with libraries
|
||
to build your system:
|
||
|
||
- `How to include static library
|
||
files <#including-static-library-files>`__
|
||
|
||
- `How to use the Multilib feature to combine multiple versions of
|
||
library files into a single
|
||
image <#combining-multiple-versions-library-files-into-one-image>`__
|
||
|
||
- `How to install multiple versions of the same library in parallel on
|
||
the same
|
||
system <#installing-multiple-versions-of-the-same-library>`__
|
||
|
||
Including Static Library Files
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
If you are building a library and the library offers static linking, you
|
||
can control which static library files (``*.a`` files) get included in
|
||
the built library.
|
||
|
||
The :term:`PACKAGES` and
|
||
:term:`FILES_* <FILES>` variables in the
|
||
``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file define how files installed
|
||
by the ``do_install`` task are packaged. By default, the ``PACKAGES``
|
||
variable includes ``${PN}-staticdev``, which represents all static
|
||
library files.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Some previously released versions of the Yocto Project defined the
|
||
static library files through
|
||
${PN}-dev
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
Following is part of the BitBake configuration file, where you can see
|
||
how the static library files are defined: PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN ?= ""
|
||
PACKAGES = "${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale
|
||
${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN}" PACKAGES_DYNAMIC = "^${PN}-locale-.*" FILES
|
||
= "" FILES_${PN} = "${bindir}/\* ${sbindir}/\* ${libexecdir}/\*
|
||
${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBS} \\ ${sysconfdir} ${sharedstatedir}
|
||
${localstatedir} \\ ${base_bindir}/\* ${base_sbindir}/\* \\
|
||
${base_libdir}/*${SOLIBS} \\ ${base_prefix}/lib/udev/rules.d
|
||
${prefix}/lib/udev/rules.d \\ ${datadir}/${BPN} ${libdir}/${BPN}/\* \\
|
||
${datadir}/pixmaps ${datadir}/applications \\ ${datadir}/idl
|
||
${datadir}/omf ${datadir}/sounds \\ ${libdir}/bonobo/servers"
|
||
FILES_${PN}-bin = "${bindir}/\* ${sbindir}/*" FILES_${PN}-doc =
|
||
"${docdir} ${mandir} ${infodir} ${datadir}/gtk-doc \\
|
||
${datadir}/gnome/help" SECTION_${PN}-doc = "doc" FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?=
|
||
"${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}"
|
||
FILES_${PN}-dev = "${includedir} ${FILES_SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/*.la \\
|
||
${libdir}/*.o ${libdir}/pkgconfig ${datadir}/pkgconfig \\
|
||
${datadir}/aclocal ${base_libdir}/*.o \\ ${libdir}/${BPN}/*.la
|
||
${base_libdir}/*.la" SECTION_${PN}-dev = "devel" ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-dev =
|
||
"1" RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev = "${PN} (= ${EXTENDPKGV})" FILES_${PN}-staticdev
|
||
= "${libdir}/*.a ${base_libdir}/*.a ${libdir}/${BPN}/*.a"
|
||
SECTION_${PN}-staticdev = "devel" RDEPENDS_${PN}-staticdev = "${PN}-dev
|
||
(= ${EXTENDPKGV})"
|
||
|
||
.. _combining-multiple-versions-library-files-into-one-image:
|
||
|
||
Combining Multiple Versions of Library Files into One Image
|
||
-----------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The build system offers the ability to build libraries with different
|
||
target optimizations or architecture formats and combine these together
|
||
into one system image. You can link different binaries in the image
|
||
against the different libraries as needed for specific use cases. This
|
||
feature is called "Multilib."
|
||
|
||
An example would be where you have most of a system compiled in 32-bit
|
||
mode using 32-bit libraries, but you have something large, like a
|
||
database engine, that needs to be a 64-bit application and uses 64-bit
|
||
libraries. Multilib allows you to get the best of both 32-bit and 64-bit
|
||
libraries.
|
||
|
||
While the Multilib feature is most commonly used for 32 and 64-bit
|
||
differences, the approach the build system uses facilitates different
|
||
target optimizations. You could compile some binaries to use one set of
|
||
libraries and other binaries to use a different set of libraries. The
|
||
libraries could differ in architecture, compiler options, or other
|
||
optimizations.
|
||
|
||
Several examples exist in the ``meta-skeleton`` layer found in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory`:
|
||
|
||
- ``conf/multilib-example.conf`` configuration file
|
||
|
||
- ``conf/multilib-example2.conf`` configuration file
|
||
|
||
- ``recipes-multilib/images/core-image-multilib-example.bb`` recipe
|
||
|
||
Preparing to Use Multilib
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
User-specific requirements drive the Multilib feature. Consequently,
|
||
there is no one "out-of-the-box" configuration that likely exists to
|
||
meet your needs.
|
||
|
||
In order to enable Multilib, you first need to ensure your recipe is
|
||
extended to support multiple libraries. Many standard recipes are
|
||
already extended and support multiple libraries. You can check in the
|
||
``meta/conf/multilib.conf`` configuration file in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` to see how this is
|
||
done using the
|
||
:term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` variable.
|
||
Eventually, all recipes will be covered and this list will not be
|
||
needed.
|
||
|
||
For the most part, the Multilib class extension works automatically to
|
||
extend the package name from ``${PN}`` to ``${MLPREFIX}${PN}``, where
|
||
``MLPREFIX`` is the particular multilib (e.g. "lib32-" or "lib64-").
|
||
Standard variables such as
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS`,
|
||
:term:`RDEPENDS`,
|
||
:term:`RPROVIDES`,
|
||
:term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
|
||
:term:`PACKAGES`, and
|
||
:term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` are
|
||
automatically extended by the system. If you are extending any manual
|
||
code in the recipe, you can use the ``${MLPREFIX}`` variable to ensure
|
||
those names are extended correctly. This automatic extension code
|
||
resides in ``multilib.bbclass``.
|
||
|
||
Using Multilib
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
After you have set up the recipes, you need to define the actual
|
||
combination of multiple libraries you want to build. You accomplish this
|
||
through your ``local.conf`` configuration file in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. An example
|
||
configuration would be as follows: MACHINE = "qemux86-64" require
|
||
conf/multilib.conf MULTILIBS = "multilib:lib32"
|
||
DEFAULTTUNE_virtclass-multilib-lib32 = "x86" IMAGE_INSTALL_append = "
|
||
lib32-glib-2.0" This example enables an additional library named
|
||
``lib32`` alongside the normal target packages. When combining these
|
||
"lib32" alternatives, the example uses "x86" for tuning. For information
|
||
on this particular tuning, see
|
||
``meta/conf/machine/include/ia32/arch-ia32.inc``.
|
||
|
||
The example then includes ``lib32-glib-2.0`` in all the images, which
|
||
illustrates one method of including a multiple library dependency. You
|
||
can use a normal image build to include this dependency, for example: $
|
||
bitbake core-image-sato You can also build Multilib packages
|
||
specifically with a command like this: $ bitbake lib32-glib-2.0
|
||
|
||
Additional Implementation Details
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Generic implementation details as well as details that are specific to
|
||
package management systems exist. Following are implementation details
|
||
that exist regardless of the package management system:
|
||
|
||
- The typical convention used for the class extension code as used by
|
||
Multilib assumes that all package names specified in
|
||
:term:`PACKAGES` that contain
|
||
``${PN}`` have ``${PN}`` at the start of the name. When that
|
||
convention is not followed and ``${PN}`` appears at the middle or the
|
||
end of a name, problems occur.
|
||
|
||
- The :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`
|
||
value under Multilib will be extended to "-vendormlmultilib" (e.g.
|
||
"-pokymllib32" for a "lib32" Multilib with Poky). The reason for this
|
||
slightly unwieldy contraction is that any "-" characters in the
|
||
vendor string presently break Autoconf's ``config.sub``, and other
|
||
separators are problematic for different reasons.
|
||
|
||
For the RPM Package Management System, the following implementation
|
||
details exist:
|
||
|
||
- A unique architecture is defined for the Multilib packages, along
|
||
with creating a unique deploy folder under ``tmp/deploy/rpm`` in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. For
|
||
example, consider ``lib32`` in a ``qemux86-64`` image. The possible
|
||
architectures in the system are "all", "qemux86_64",
|
||
"lib32_qemux86_64", and "lib32_x86".
|
||
|
||
- The ``${MLPREFIX}`` variable is stripped from ``${PN}`` during RPM
|
||
packaging. The naming for a normal RPM package and a Multilib RPM
|
||
package in a ``qemux86-64`` system resolves to something similar to
|
||
``bash-4.1-r2.x86_64.rpm`` and ``bash-4.1.r2.lib32_x86.rpm``,
|
||
respectively.
|
||
|
||
- When installing a Multilib image, the RPM backend first installs the
|
||
base image and then installs the Multilib libraries.
|
||
|
||
- The build system relies on RPM to resolve the identical files in the
|
||
two (or more) Multilib packages.
|
||
|
||
For the IPK Package Management System, the following implementation
|
||
details exist:
|
||
|
||
- The ``${MLPREFIX}`` is not stripped from ``${PN}`` during IPK
|
||
packaging. The naming for a normal RPM package and a Multilib IPK
|
||
package in a ``qemux86-64`` system resolves to something like
|
||
``bash_4.1-r2.x86_64.ipk`` and ``lib32-bash_4.1-rw_x86.ipk``,
|
||
respectively.
|
||
|
||
- The IPK deploy folder is not modified with ``${MLPREFIX}`` because
|
||
packages with and without the Multilib feature can exist in the same
|
||
folder due to the ``${PN}`` differences.
|
||
|
||
- IPK defines a sanity check for Multilib installation using certain
|
||
rules for file comparison, overridden, etc.
|
||
|
||
Installing Multiple Versions of the Same Library
|
||
------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Situations can exist where you need to install and use multiple versions
|
||
of the same library on the same system at the same time. These
|
||
situations almost always exist when a library API changes and you have
|
||
multiple pieces of software that depend on the separate versions of the
|
||
library. To accommodate these situations, you can install multiple
|
||
versions of the same library in parallel on the same system.
|
||
|
||
The process is straightforward as long as the libraries use proper
|
||
versioning. With properly versioned libraries, all you need to do to
|
||
individually specify the libraries is create separate, appropriately
|
||
named recipes where the :term:`PN` part of
|
||
the name includes a portion that differentiates each library version
|
||
(e.g.the major part of the version number). Thus, instead of having a
|
||
single recipe that loads one version of a library (e.g. ``clutter``),
|
||
you provide multiple recipes that result in different versions of the
|
||
libraries you want. As an example, the following two recipes would allow
|
||
the two separate versions of the ``clutter`` library to co-exist on the
|
||
same system: clutter-1.6_1.6.20.bb clutter-1.8_1.8.4.bb Additionally, if
|
||
you have other recipes that depend on a given library, you need to use
|
||
the :term:`DEPENDS` variable to
|
||
create the dependency. Continuing with the same example, if you want to
|
||
have a recipe depend on the 1.8 version of the ``clutter`` library, use
|
||
the following in your recipe: DEPENDS = "clutter-1.8"
|
||
|
||
Using x32 psABI
|
||
===============
|
||
|
||
x32 processor-specific Application Binary Interface (`x32
|
||
psABI <https://software.intel.com/en-us/node/628948>`__) is a native
|
||
32-bit processor-specific ABI for Intel 64 (x86-64) architectures. An
|
||
ABI defines the calling conventions between functions in a processing
|
||
environment. The interface determines what registers are used and what
|
||
the sizes are for various C data types.
|
||
|
||
Some processing environments prefer using 32-bit applications even when
|
||
running on Intel 64-bit platforms. Consider the i386 psABI, which is a
|
||
very old 32-bit ABI for Intel 64-bit platforms. The i386 psABI does not
|
||
provide efficient use and access of the Intel 64-bit processor
|
||
resources, leaving the system underutilized. Now consider the x86_64
|
||
psABI. This ABI is newer and uses 64-bits for data sizes and program
|
||
pointers. The extra bits increase the footprint size of the programs,
|
||
libraries, and also increases the memory and file system size
|
||
requirements. Executing under the x32 psABI enables user programs to
|
||
utilize CPU and system resources more efficiently while keeping the
|
||
memory footprint of the applications low. Extra bits are used for
|
||
registers but not for addressing mechanisms.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project supports the final specifications of x32 psABI as
|
||
follows:
|
||
|
||
- You can create packages and images in x32 psABI format on x86_64
|
||
architecture targets.
|
||
|
||
- You can successfully build recipes with the x32 toolchain.
|
||
|
||
- You can create and boot ``core-image-minimal`` and
|
||
``core-image-sato`` images.
|
||
|
||
- RPM Package Manager (RPM) support exists for x32 binaries.
|
||
|
||
- Support for large images exists.
|
||
|
||
To use the x32 psABI, you need to edit your ``conf/local.conf``
|
||
configuration file as follows: MACHINE = "qemux86-64" DEFAULTTUNE =
|
||
"x86-64-x32" baselib = "${@d.getVar('BASE_LIB_tune-' +
|
||
(d.getVar('DEFAULTTUNE') \\ or 'INVALID')) or 'lib'}" Once you have set
|
||
up your configuration file, use BitBake to build an image that supports
|
||
the x32 psABI. Here is an example: $ bitbake core-image-sato
|
||
|
||
Enabling GObject Introspection Support
|
||
======================================
|
||
|
||
`GObject
|
||
introspection <https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GObjectIntrospection>`__
|
||
is the standard mechanism for accessing GObject-based software from
|
||
runtime environments. GObject is a feature of the GLib library that
|
||
provides an object framework for the GNOME desktop and related software.
|
||
GObject Introspection adds information to GObject that allows objects
|
||
created within it to be represented across different programming
|
||
languages. If you want to construct GStreamer pipelines using Python, or
|
||
control UPnP infrastructure using Javascript and GUPnP, GObject
|
||
introspection is the only way to do it.
|
||
|
||
This section describes the Yocto Project support for generating and
|
||
packaging GObject introspection data. GObject introspection data is a
|
||
description of the API provided by libraries built on top of GLib
|
||
framework, and, in particular, that framework's GObject mechanism.
|
||
GObject Introspection Repository (GIR) files go to ``-dev`` packages,
|
||
``typelib`` files go to main packages as they are packaged together with
|
||
libraries that are introspected.
|
||
|
||
The data is generated when building such a library, by linking the
|
||
library with a small executable binary that asks the library to describe
|
||
itself, and then executing the binary and processing its output.
|
||
|
||
Generating this data in a cross-compilation environment is difficult
|
||
because the library is produced for the target architecture, but its
|
||
code needs to be executed on the build host. This problem is solved with
|
||
the OpenEmbedded build system by running the code through QEMU, which
|
||
allows precisely that. Unfortunately, QEMU does not always work
|
||
perfectly as mentioned in the "`Known Issues <#known-issues>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
Enabling the Generation of Introspection Data
|
||
---------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Enabling the generation of introspection data (GIR files) in your
|
||
library package involves the following:
|
||
|
||
1. Inherit the
|
||
:ref:`gobject-introspection <ref-classes-gobject-introspection>`
|
||
class.
|
||
|
||
2. Make sure introspection is not disabled anywhere in the recipe or
|
||
from anything the recipe includes. Also, make sure that
|
||
"gobject-introspection-data" is not in
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
|
||
and that "qemu-usermode" is not in
|
||
:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
|
||
If either of these conditions exist, nothing will happen.
|
||
|
||
3. Try to build the recipe. If you encounter build errors that look like
|
||
something is unable to find ``.so`` libraries, check where these
|
||
libraries are located in the source tree and add the following to the
|
||
recipe: GIR_EXTRA_LIBS_PATH = "${B}/something/.libs"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
See recipes in the
|
||
oe-core
|
||
repository that use that
|
||
GIR_EXTRA_LIBS_PATH
|
||
variable as an example.
|
||
|
||
4. Look for any other errors, which probably mean that introspection
|
||
support in a package is not entirely standard, and thus breaks down
|
||
in a cross-compilation environment. For such cases, custom-made fixes
|
||
are needed. A good place to ask and receive help in these cases is
|
||
the `Yocto Project mailing
|
||
lists <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#resources-mailinglist>`__.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Using a library that no longer builds against the latest Yocto
|
||
Project release and prints introspection related errors is a good
|
||
candidate for the previous procedure.
|
||
|
||
Disabling the Generation of Introspection Data
|
||
----------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You might find that you do not want to generate introspection data. Or,
|
||
perhaps QEMU does not work on your build host and target architecture
|
||
combination. If so, you can use either of the following methods to
|
||
disable GIR file generations:
|
||
|
||
- Add the following to your distro configuration:
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "gobject-introspection-data"
|
||
Adding this statement disables generating introspection data using
|
||
QEMU but will still enable building introspection tools and libraries
|
||
(i.e. building them does not require the use of QEMU).
|
||
|
||
- Add the following to your machine configuration:
|
||
MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "qemu-usermode" Adding this
|
||
statement disables the use of QEMU when building packages for your
|
||
machine. Currently, this feature is used only by introspection
|
||
recipes and has the same effect as the previously described option.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Future releases of the Yocto Project might have other features
|
||
affected by this option.
|
||
|
||
If you disable introspection data, you can still obtain it through other
|
||
means such as copying the data from a suitable sysroot, or by generating
|
||
it on the target hardware. The OpenEmbedded build system does not
|
||
currently provide specific support for these techniques.
|
||
|
||
Testing that Introspection Works in an Image
|
||
--------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Use the following procedure to test if generating introspection data is
|
||
working in an image:
|
||
|
||
1. Make sure that "gobject-introspection-data" is not in
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
|
||
and that "qemu-usermode" is not in
|
||
:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
|
||
|
||
2. Build ``core-image-sato``.
|
||
|
||
3. Launch a Terminal and then start Python in the terminal.
|
||
|
||
4. Enter the following in the terminal: >>> from gi.repository import
|
||
GLib >>> GLib.get_host_name()
|
||
|
||
5. For something a little more advanced, enter the following:
|
||
http://python-gtk-3-tutorial.readthedocs.org/en/latest/introduction.html
|
||
|
||
Known Issues
|
||
------------
|
||
|
||
The following know issues exist for GObject Introspection Support:
|
||
|
||
- ``qemu-ppc64`` immediately crashes. Consequently, you cannot build
|
||
introspection data on that architecture.
|
||
|
||
- x32 is not supported by QEMU. Consequently, introspection data is
|
||
disabled.
|
||
|
||
- musl causes transient GLib binaries to crash on assertion failures.
|
||
Consequently, generating introspection data is disabled.
|
||
|
||
- Because QEMU is not able to run the binaries correctly, introspection
|
||
is disabled for some specific packages under specific architectures
|
||
(e.g. ``gcr``, ``libsecret``, and ``webkit``).
|
||
|
||
- QEMU usermode might not work properly when running 64-bit binaries
|
||
under 32-bit host machines. In particular, "qemumips64" is known to
|
||
not work under i686.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-optionally-using-an-external-toolchain:
|
||
|
||
Optionally Using an External Toolchain
|
||
======================================
|
||
|
||
You might want to use an external toolchain as part of your development.
|
||
If this is the case, the fundamental steps you need to accomplish are as
|
||
follows:
|
||
|
||
- Understand where the installed toolchain resides. For cases where you
|
||
need to build the external toolchain, you would need to take separate
|
||
steps to build and install the toolchain.
|
||
|
||
- Make sure you add the layer that contains the toolchain to your
|
||
``bblayers.conf`` file through the
|
||
:term:`BBLAYERS` variable.
|
||
|
||
- Set the ``EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN`` variable in your ``local.conf`` file
|
||
to the location in which you installed the toolchain.
|
||
|
||
A good example of an external toolchain used with the Yocto Project is
|
||
Mentor Graphics Sourcery G++ Toolchain. You can see information on how
|
||
to use that particular layer in the ``README`` file at
|
||
` <http://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/>`__. You can find
|
||
further information by reading about the
|
||
:term:`TCMODE` variable in the Yocto
|
||
Project Reference Manual's variable glossary.
|
||
|
||
Creating Partitioned Images Using Wic
|
||
=====================================
|
||
|
||
Creating an image for a particular hardware target using the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system does not necessarily mean you can boot that
|
||
image as is on your device. Physical devices accept and boot images in
|
||
various ways depending on the specifics of the device. Usually,
|
||
information about the hardware can tell you what image format the device
|
||
requires. Should your device require multiple partitions on an SD card,
|
||
flash, or an HDD, you can use the OpenEmbedded Image Creator, Wic, to
|
||
create the properly partitioned image.
|
||
|
||
The ``wic`` command generates partitioned images from existing
|
||
OpenEmbedded build artifacts. Image generation is driven by partitioning
|
||
commands contained in an Openembedded kickstart file (``.wks``)
|
||
specified either directly on the command line or as one of a selection
|
||
of canned kickstart files as shown with the ``wic list images`` command
|
||
in the "`Using an Existing Kickstart
|
||
File <#using-a-provided-kickstart-file>`__" section. When you apply the
|
||
command to a given set of build artifacts, the result is an image or set
|
||
of images that can be directly written onto media and used on a
|
||
particular system.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For a kickstart file reference, see the "
|
||
OpenEmbedded Kickstart (
|
||
.wks
|
||
) Reference
|
||
" Chapter in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
The ``wic`` command and the infrastructure it is based on is by
|
||
definition incomplete. The purpose of the command is to allow the
|
||
generation of customized images, and as such, was designed to be
|
||
completely extensible through a plugin interface. See the "`Using the
|
||
Wic PlugIn Interface <#wic-using-the-wic-plugin-interface>`__" section
|
||
for information on these plugins.
|
||
|
||
This section provides some background information on Wic, describes what
|
||
you need to have in place to run the tool, provides instruction on how
|
||
to use the Wic utility, provides information on using the Wic plugins
|
||
interface, and provides several examples that show how to use Wic.
|
||
|
||
.. _wic-background:
|
||
|
||
Background
|
||
----------
|
||
|
||
This section provides some background on the Wic utility. While none of
|
||
this information is required to use Wic, you might find it interesting.
|
||
|
||
- The name "Wic" is derived from OpenEmbedded Image Creator (oeic). The
|
||
"oe" diphthong in "oeic" was promoted to the letter "w", because
|
||
"oeic" is both difficult to remember and to pronounce.
|
||
|
||
- Wic is loosely based on the Meego Image Creator (``mic``) framework.
|
||
The Wic implementation has been heavily modified to make direct use
|
||
of OpenEmbedded build artifacts instead of package installation and
|
||
configuration, which are already incorporated within the OpenEmbedded
|
||
artifacts.
|
||
|
||
- Wic is a completely independent standalone utility that initially
|
||
provides easier-to-use and more flexible replacements for an existing
|
||
functionality in OE-Core's
|
||
:ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>`
|
||
class. The difference between Wic and those examples is that with Wic
|
||
the functionality of those scripts is implemented by a
|
||
general-purpose partitioning language, which is based on Redhat
|
||
kickstart syntax.
|
||
|
||
.. _wic-requirements:
|
||
|
||
Requirements
|
||
------------
|
||
|
||
In order to use the Wic utility with the OpenEmbedded Build system, your
|
||
system needs to meet the following requirements:
|
||
|
||
- The Linux distribution on your development host must support the
|
||
Yocto Project. See the "`Supported Linux
|
||
Distributions <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#detailed-supported-distros>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual for the list of
|
||
distributions that support the Yocto Project.
|
||
|
||
- The standard system utilities, such as ``cp``, must be installed on
|
||
your development host system.
|
||
|
||
- You must have sourced the build environment setup script (i.e.
|
||
````` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__) found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`.
|
||
|
||
- You need to have the build artifacts already available, which
|
||
typically means that you must have already created an image using the
|
||
Openembedded build system (e.g. ``core-image-minimal``). While it
|
||
might seem redundant to generate an image in order to create an image
|
||
using Wic, the current version of Wic requires the artifacts in the
|
||
form generated by the OpenEmbedded build system.
|
||
|
||
- You must build several native tools, which are built to run on the
|
||
build system: $ bitbake parted-native dosfstools-native mtools-native
|
||
|
||
- Include "wic" as part of the
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
|
||
variable.
|
||
|
||
- Include the name of the `wic kickstart
|
||
file <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#openembedded-kickstart-wks-reference>`__
|
||
as part of the :term:`WKS_FILE`
|
||
variable
|
||
|
||
.. _wic-getting-help:
|
||
|
||
Getting Help
|
||
------------
|
||
|
||
You can get general help for the ``wic`` command by entering the ``wic``
|
||
command by itself or by entering the command with a help argument as
|
||
follows: $ wic -h $ wic --help $ wic help
|
||
|
||
Currently, Wic supports seven commands: ``cp``, ``create``, ``help``,
|
||
``list``, ``ls``, ``rm``, and ``write``. You can get help for all these
|
||
commands except "help" by using the following form: $ wic help command
|
||
For example, the following command returns help for the ``write``
|
||
command: $ wic help write
|
||
|
||
Wic supports help for three topics: ``overview``, ``plugins``, and
|
||
``kickstart``. You can get help for any topic using the following form:
|
||
$ wic help topic For example, the following returns overview help for
|
||
Wic: $ wic help overview
|
||
|
||
One additional level of help exists for Wic. You can get help on
|
||
individual images through the ``list`` command. You can use the ``list``
|
||
command to return the available Wic images as follows: $ wic list images
|
||
genericx86 Create an EFI disk image for genericx86\* beaglebone-yocto
|
||
Create SD card image for Beaglebone edgerouter Create SD card image for
|
||
Edgerouter qemux86-directdisk Create a qemu machine 'pcbios' direct disk
|
||
image directdisk-gpt Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image mkefidisk
|
||
Create an EFI disk image directdisk Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
|
||
systemd-bootdisk Create an EFI disk image with systemd-boot mkhybridiso
|
||
Create a hybrid ISO image sdimage-bootpart Create SD card image with a
|
||
boot partition directdisk-multi-rootfs Create multi rootfs image using
|
||
rootfs plugin directdisk-bootloader-config Create a 'pcbios' direct disk
|
||
image with custom bootloader config Once you know the list of available
|
||
Wic images, you can use ``help`` with the command to get help on a
|
||
particular image. For example, the following command returns help on the
|
||
"beaglebone-yocto" image: $ wic list beaglebone-yocto help Creates a
|
||
partitioned SD card image for Beaglebone. Boot files are located in the
|
||
first vfat partition.
|
||
|
||
Operational Modes
|
||
-----------------
|
||
|
||
You can use Wic in two different modes, depending on how much control
|
||
you need for specifying the Openembedded build artifacts that are used
|
||
for creating the image: Raw and Cooked:
|
||
|
||
- *Raw Mode:* You explicitly specify build artifacts through Wic
|
||
command-line arguments.
|
||
|
||
- *Cooked Mode:* The current
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` setting and image
|
||
name are used to automatically locate and provide the build
|
||
artifacts. You just supply a kickstart file and the name of the image
|
||
from which to use artifacts.
|
||
|
||
Regardless of the mode you use, you need to have the build artifacts
|
||
ready and available.
|
||
|
||
Raw Mode
|
||
~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Running Wic in raw mode allows you to specify all the partitions through
|
||
the ``wic`` command line. The primary use for raw mode is if you have
|
||
built your kernel outside of the Yocto Project
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. In other words, you
|
||
can point to arbitrary kernel, root filesystem locations, and so forth.
|
||
Contrast this behavior with cooked mode where Wic looks in the Build
|
||
Directory (e.g. ``tmp/deploy/images/``\ machine).
|
||
|
||
The general form of the ``wic`` command in raw mode is: $ wic create
|
||
wks_file options ... Where: wks_file: An OpenEmbedded kickstart file.
|
||
You can provide your own custom file or use a file from a set of
|
||
existing files as described by further options. optional arguments: -h,
|
||
--help show this help message and exit -o OUTDIR, --outdir OUTDIR name
|
||
of directory to create image in -e IMAGE_NAME, --image-name IMAGE_NAME
|
||
name of the image to use the artifacts from e.g. core- image-sato -r
|
||
ROOTFS_DIR, --rootfs-dir ROOTFS_DIR path to the /rootfs dir to use as
|
||
the .wks rootfs source -b BOOTIMG_DIR, --bootimg-dir BOOTIMG_DIR path to
|
||
the dir containing the boot artifacts (e.g. /EFI or /syslinux dirs) to
|
||
use as the .wks bootimg source -k KERNEL_DIR, --kernel-dir KERNEL_DIR
|
||
path to the dir containing the kernel to use in the .wks bootimg -n
|
||
NATIVE_SYSROOT, --native-sysroot NATIVE_SYSROOT path to the native
|
||
sysroot containing the tools to use to build the image -s,
|
||
--skip-build-check skip the build check -f, --build-rootfs build rootfs
|
||
-c {gzip,bzip2,xz}, --compress-with {gzip,bzip2,xz} compress image with
|
||
specified compressor -m, --bmap generate .bmap --no-fstab-update Do not
|
||
change fstab file. -v VARS_DIR, --vars VARS_DIR directory with
|
||
<image>.env files that store bitbake variables -D, --debug output debug
|
||
information
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You do not need root privileges to run Wic. In fact, you should not
|
||
run as root when using the utility.
|
||
|
||
Cooked Mode
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Running Wic in cooked mode leverages off artifacts in the Build
|
||
Directory. In other words, you do not have to specify kernel or root
|
||
filesystem locations as part of the command. All you need to provide is
|
||
a kickstart file and the name of the image from which to use artifacts
|
||
by using the "-e" option. Wic looks in the Build Directory (e.g.
|
||
``tmp/deploy/images/``\ machine) for artifacts.
|
||
|
||
The general form of the ``wic`` command using Cooked Mode is as follows:
|
||
$ wic create wks_file -e IMAGE_NAME Where: wks_file: An OpenEmbedded
|
||
kickstart file. You can provide your own custom file or use a file from
|
||
a set of existing files provided with the Yocto Project release.
|
||
required argument: -e IMAGE_NAME, --image-name IMAGE_NAME name of the
|
||
image to use the artifacts from e.g. core- image-sato
|
||
|
||
.. _using-a-provided-kickstart-file:
|
||
|
||
Using an Existing Kickstart File
|
||
--------------------------------
|
||
|
||
If you do not want to create your own kickstart file, you can use an
|
||
existing file provided by the Wic installation. As shipped, kickstart
|
||
files can be found in the Yocto Project `Source
|
||
Repositories <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#source-repositories>`__ in the
|
||
following two locations: poky/meta-yocto-bsp/wic
|
||
poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks Use the following command to list the
|
||
available kickstart files: $ wic list images genericx86 Create an EFI
|
||
disk image for genericx86\* beaglebone-yocto Create SD card image for
|
||
Beaglebone edgerouter Create SD card image for Edgerouter
|
||
qemux86-directdisk Create a qemu machine 'pcbios' direct disk image
|
||
directdisk-gpt Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image mkefidisk Create an
|
||
EFI disk image directdisk Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
|
||
systemd-bootdisk Create an EFI disk image with systemd-boot mkhybridiso
|
||
Create a hybrid ISO image sdimage-bootpart Create SD card image with a
|
||
boot partition directdisk-multi-rootfs Create multi rootfs image using
|
||
rootfs plugin directdisk-bootloader-config Create a 'pcbios' direct disk
|
||
image with custom bootloader config When you use an existing file, you
|
||
do not have to use the ``.wks`` extension. Here is an example in Raw
|
||
Mode that uses the ``directdisk`` file: $ wic create directdisk -r
|
||
rootfs_dir -b bootimg_dir \\ -k kernel_dir -n native_sysroot
|
||
|
||
Here are the actual partition language commands used in the
|
||
``genericx86.wks`` file to generate an image: # short-description:
|
||
Create an EFI disk image for genericx86\* # long-description: Creates a
|
||
partitioned EFI disk image for genericx86\* machines part /boot --source
|
||
bootimg-efi --sourceparams="loader=grub-efi" --ondisk sda --label msdos
|
||
--active --align 1024 part / --source rootfs --ondisk sda --fstype=ext4
|
||
--label platform --align 1024 --use-uuid part swap --ondisk sda --size
|
||
44 --label swap1 --fstype=swap bootloader --ptable gpt --timeout=5
|
||
--append="rootfstype=ext4 console=ttyS0,115200 console=tty0"
|
||
|
||
.. _wic-using-the-wic-plugin-interface:
|
||
|
||
Using the Wic Plugin Interface
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can extend and specialize Wic functionality by using Wic plugins.
|
||
This section explains the Wic plugin interface.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Wic plugins consist of "source" and "imager" plugins. Imager plugins
|
||
are beyond the scope of this section.
|
||
|
||
Source plugins provide a mechanism to customize partition content during
|
||
the Wic image generation process. You can use source plugins to map
|
||
values that you specify using ``--source`` commands in kickstart files
|
||
(i.e. ``*.wks``) to a plugin implementation used to populate a given
|
||
partition.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you use plugins that have build-time dependencies (e.g. native
|
||
tools, bootloaders, and so forth) when building a Wic image, you need
|
||
to specify those dependencies using the
|
||
WKS_FILE_DEPENDS
|
||
variable.
|
||
|
||
Source plugins are subclasses defined in plugin files. As shipped, the
|
||
Yocto Project provides several plugin files. You can see the source
|
||
plugin files that ship with the Yocto Project
|
||
`here <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/scripts/lib/wic/plugins/source>`__.
|
||
Each of these plugin files contains source plugins that are designed to
|
||
populate a specific Wic image partition.
|
||
|
||
Source plugins are subclasses of the ``SourcePlugin`` class, which is
|
||
defined in the ``poky/scripts/lib/wic/pluginbase.py`` file. For example,
|
||
the ``BootimgEFIPlugin`` source plugin found in the ``bootimg-efi.py``
|
||
file is a subclass of the ``SourcePlugin`` class, which is found in the
|
||
``pluginbase.py`` file.
|
||
|
||
You can also implement source plugins in a layer outside of the Source
|
||
Repositories (external layer). To do so, be sure that your plugin files
|
||
are located in a directory whose path is
|
||
``scripts/lib/wic/plugins/source/`` within your external layer. When the
|
||
plugin files are located there, the source plugins they contain are made
|
||
available to Wic.
|
||
|
||
When the Wic implementation needs to invoke a partition-specific
|
||
implementation, it looks for the plugin with the same name as the
|
||
``--source`` parameter used in the kickstart file given to that
|
||
partition. For example, if the partition is set up using the following
|
||
command in a kickstart file: part /boot --source bootimg-pcbios --ondisk
|
||
sda --label boot --active --align 1024 The methods defined as class
|
||
members of the matching source plugin (i.e. ``bootimg-pcbios``) in the
|
||
``bootimg-pcbios.py`` plugin file are used.
|
||
|
||
To be more concrete, here is the corresponding plugin definition from
|
||
the ``bootimg-pcbios.py`` file for the previous command along with an
|
||
example method called by the Wic implementation when it needs to prepare
|
||
a partition using an implementation-specific function: . . . class
|
||
BootimgPcbiosPlugin(SourcePlugin): """ Create MBR boot partition and
|
||
install syslinux on it. """ name = 'bootimg-pcbios' . . . @classmethod
|
||
def do_prepare_partition(cls, part, source_params, creator, cr_workdir,
|
||
oe_builddir, bootimg_dir, kernel_dir, rootfs_dir, native_sysroot): """
|
||
Called to do the actual content population for a partition i.e. it
|
||
'prepares' the partition to be incorporated into the image. In this
|
||
case, prepare content for legacy bios boot partition. """ . . . If a
|
||
subclass (plugin) itself does not implement a particular function, Wic
|
||
locates and uses the default version in the superclass. It is for this
|
||
reason that all source plugins are derived from the ``SourcePlugin``
|
||
class.
|
||
|
||
The ``SourcePlugin`` class defined in the ``pluginbase.py`` file defines
|
||
a set of methods that source plugins can implement or override. Any
|
||
plugins (subclass of ``SourcePlugin``) that do not implement a
|
||
particular method inherit the implementation of the method from the
|
||
``SourcePlugin`` class. For more information, see the ``SourcePlugin``
|
||
class in the ``pluginbase.py`` file for details:
|
||
|
||
The following list describes the methods implemented in the
|
||
``SourcePlugin`` class:
|
||
|
||
- *``do_prepare_partition()``:* Called to populate a partition with
|
||
actual content. In other words, the method prepares the final
|
||
partition image that is incorporated into the disk image.
|
||
|
||
- *``do_configure_partition()``:* Called before
|
||
``do_prepare_partition()`` to create custom configuration files for a
|
||
partition (e.g. syslinux or grub configuration files).
|
||
|
||
- *``do_install_disk()``:* Called after all partitions have been
|
||
prepared and assembled into a disk image. This method provides a hook
|
||
to allow finalization of a disk image (e.g. writing an MBR).
|
||
|
||
- *``do_stage_partition()``:* Special content-staging hook called
|
||
before ``do_prepare_partition()``. This method is normally empty.
|
||
|
||
Typically, a partition just uses the passed-in parameters (e.g. the
|
||
unmodified value of ``bootimg_dir``). However, in some cases, things
|
||
might need to be more tailored. As an example, certain files might
|
||
additionally need to be taken from ``bootimg_dir + /boot``. This hook
|
||
allows those files to be staged in a customized fashion.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
get_bitbake_var()
|
||
allows you to access non-standard variables that you might want to
|
||
use for this behavior.
|
||
|
||
You can extend the source plugin mechanism. To add more hooks, create
|
||
more source plugin methods within ``SourcePlugin`` and the corresponding
|
||
derived subclasses. The code that calls the plugin methods uses the
|
||
``plugin.get_source_plugin_methods()`` function to find the method or
|
||
methods needed by the call. Retrieval of those methods is accomplished
|
||
by filling up a dict with keys that contain the method names of
|
||
interest. On success, these will be filled in with the actual methods.
|
||
See the Wic implementation for examples and details.
|
||
|
||
.. _wic-usage-examples:
|
||
|
||
Examples
|
||
--------
|
||
|
||
This section provides several examples that show how to use the Wic
|
||
utility. All the examples assume the list of requirements in the
|
||
"`Requirements <#wic-requirements>`__" section have been met. The
|
||
examples assume the previously generated image is
|
||
``core-image-minimal``.
|
||
|
||
.. _generate-an-image-using-a-provided-kickstart-file:
|
||
|
||
Generate an Image using an Existing Kickstart File
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
This example runs in Cooked Mode and uses the ``mkefidisk`` kickstart
|
||
file: $ wic create mkefidisk -e core-image-minimal INFO: Building
|
||
wic-tools... . . . INFO: The new image(s) can be found here:
|
||
./mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct The following build artifacts were
|
||
used to create the image(s): ROOTFS_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
|
||
BOOTIMG_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
|
||
KERNEL_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
|
||
NATIVE_SYSROOT:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
|
||
INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/openembedded-core/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/mkefidisk.wks
|
||
The previous example shows the easiest way to create an image by running
|
||
in cooked mode and supplying a kickstart file and the "-e" option to
|
||
point to the existing build artifacts. Your ``local.conf`` file needs to
|
||
have the :term:`MACHINE` variable set
|
||
to the machine you are using, which is "qemux86" in this example.
|
||
|
||
Once the image builds, the output provides image location, artifact use,
|
||
and kickstart file information.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You should always verify the details provided in the output to make
|
||
sure that the image was indeed created exactly as expected.
|
||
|
||
Continuing with the example, you can now write the image from the Build
|
||
Directory onto a USB stick, or whatever media for which you built your
|
||
image, and boot from the media. You can write the image by using
|
||
``bmaptool`` or ``dd``: $ oe-run-native bmaptool copy
|
||
mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct /dev/sdX or $ sudo dd
|
||
if=mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct of=/dev/sdX
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For more information on how to use the
|
||
bmaptool
|
||
to flash a device with an image, see the "
|
||
Flashing Images Using
|
||
bmaptool
|
||
" section.
|
||
|
||
Using a Modified Kickstart File
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Because partitioned image creation is driven by the kickstart file, it
|
||
is easy to affect image creation by changing the parameters in the file.
|
||
This next example demonstrates that through modification of the
|
||
``directdisk-gpt`` kickstart file.
|
||
|
||
As mentioned earlier, you can use the command ``wic list images`` to
|
||
show the list of existing kickstart files. The directory in which the
|
||
``directdisk-gpt.wks`` file resides is
|
||
``scripts/lib/image/canned-wks/``, which is located in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
|
||
Because available files reside in this directory, you can create and add
|
||
your own custom files to the directory. Subsequent use of the
|
||
``wic list images`` command would then include your kickstart files.
|
||
|
||
In this example, the existing ``directdisk-gpt`` file already does most
|
||
of what is needed. However, for the hardware in this example, the image
|
||
will need to boot from ``sdb`` instead of ``sda``, which is what the
|
||
``directdisk-gpt`` kickstart file uses.
|
||
|
||
The example begins by making a copy of the ``directdisk-gpt.wks`` file
|
||
in the ``scripts/lib/image/canned-wks`` directory and then by changing
|
||
the lines that specify the target disk from which to boot. $ cp
|
||
/home/stephano/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisk-gpt.wks \\
|
||
/home/stephano/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisksdb-gpt.wks
|
||
Next, the example modifies the ``directdisksdb-gpt.wks`` file and
|
||
changes all instances of "``--ondisk sda``" to "``--ondisk sdb``". The
|
||
example changes the following two lines and leaves the remaining lines
|
||
untouched: part /boot --source bootimg-pcbios --ondisk sdb --label boot
|
||
--active --align 1024 part / --source rootfs --ondisk sdb --fstype=ext4
|
||
--label platform --align 1024 --use-uuid Once the lines are changed, the
|
||
example generates the ``directdisksdb-gpt`` image. The command points
|
||
the process at the ``core-image-minimal`` artifacts for the Next Unit of
|
||
Computing (nuc) :term:`MACHINE` the
|
||
``local.conf``. $ wic create directdisksdb-gpt -e core-image-minimal
|
||
INFO: Building wic-tools... . . . Initialising tasks: 100%
|
||
\|#######################################\| Time: 0:00:01 NOTE:
|
||
Executing SetScene Tasks NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks NOTE: Tasks
|
||
Summary: Attempted 1161 tasks of which 1157 didn't need to be rerun and
|
||
all succeeded. INFO: Creating image(s)... INFO: The new image(s) can be
|
||
found here: ./directdisksdb-gpt-201710090938-sdb.direct The following
|
||
build artifacts were used to create the image(s): ROOTFS_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
|
||
BOOTIMG_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
|
||
KERNEL_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
|
||
NATIVE_SYSROOT:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
|
||
INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
|
||
/home/stephano/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisksdb-gpt.wks
|
||
Continuing with the example, you can now directly ``dd`` the image to a
|
||
USB stick, or whatever media for which you built your image, and boot
|
||
the resulting media: $ sudo dd
|
||
if=directdisksdb-gpt-201710090938-sdb.direct of=/dev/sdb 140966+0
|
||
records in 140966+0 records out 72174592 bytes (72 MB, 69 MiB) copied,
|
||
78.0282 s, 925 kB/s $ sudo eject /dev/sdb
|
||
|
||
Using a Modified Kickstart File and Running in Raw Mode
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
This next example manually specifies each build artifact (runs in Raw
|
||
Mode) and uses a modified kickstart file. The example also uses the
|
||
``-o`` option to cause Wic to create the output somewhere other than the
|
||
default output directory, which is the current directory: $ wic create
|
||
/home/stephano/my_yocto/test.wks -o /home/stephano/testwic \\
|
||
--rootfs-dir
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
|
||
\\ --bootimg-dir
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
|
||
\\ --kernel-dir
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp/deploy/images/qemux86 \\
|
||
--native-sysroot
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
|
||
INFO: Creating image(s)... INFO: The new image(s) can be found here:
|
||
/home/stephano/testwic/test-201710091445-sdb.direct The following build
|
||
artifacts were used to create the image(s): ROOTFS_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
|
||
BOOTIMG_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
|
||
KERNEL_DIR:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
|
||
NATIVE_SYSROOT:
|
||
/home/stephano/build/master/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
|
||
INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
|
||
/home/stephano/my_yocto/test.wks For this example,
|
||
:term:`MACHINE` did not have to be
|
||
specified in the ``local.conf`` file since the artifact is manually
|
||
specified.
|
||
|
||
Using Wic to Manipulate an Image
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Wic image manipulation allows you to shorten turnaround time during
|
||
image development. For example, you can use Wic to delete the kernel
|
||
partition of a Wic image and then insert a newly built kernel. This
|
||
saves you time from having to rebuild the entire image each time you
|
||
modify the kernel.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
In order to use Wic to manipulate a Wic image as in this example,
|
||
your development machine must have the
|
||
mtools
|
||
package installed.
|
||
|
||
The following example examines the contents of the Wic image, deletes
|
||
the existing kernel, and then inserts a new kernel:
|
||
|
||
1. *List the Partitions:* Use the ``wic ls`` command to list all the
|
||
partitions in the Wic image: $ wic ls
|
||
tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic Num Start
|
||
End Size Fstype 1 1048576 25041919 23993344 fat16 2 25165824 72157183
|
||
46991360 ext4 The previous output shows two partitions in the
|
||
``core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic`` image.
|
||
|
||
2. *Examine a Particular Partition:* Use the ``wic ls`` command again
|
||
but in a different form to examine a particular partition.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can get command usage on any Wic command using the following
|
||
form:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
$ wic help command
|
||
|
||
|
||
For example, the following command shows you the various ways to
|
||
use the
|
||
wic ls
|
||
command:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
$ wic help ls
|
||
|
||
|
||
The following command shows what is in Partition one: $ wic ls
|
||
tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1 Volume in
|
||
drive : is boot Volume Serial Number is E894-1809 Directory for ::/
|
||
libcom32 c32 186500 2017-10-09 16:06 libutil c32 24148 2017-10-09
|
||
16:06 syslinux cfg 220 2017-10-09 16:06 vesamenu c32 27104 2017-10-09
|
||
16:06 vmlinuz 6904608 2017-10-09 16:06 5 files 7 142 580 bytes 16 582
|
||
656 bytes free The previous output shows five files, with the
|
||
``vmlinuz`` being the kernel.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you see the following error, you need to update or create a
|
||
~/.mtoolsrc
|
||
file and be sure to have the line “mtools_skip_check=1“ in the
|
||
file. Then, run the Wic command again:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
ERROR: _exec_cmd: /usr/bin/mdir -i /tmp/wic-parttfokuwra ::/ returned '1' instead of 0
|
||
output: Total number of sectors (47824) not a multiple of sectors per track (32)!
|
||
Add mtools_skip_check=1 to your .mtoolsrc file to skip this test
|
||
|
||
|
||
3. *Remove the Old Kernel:* Use the ``wic rm`` command to remove the
|
||
``vmlinuz`` file (kernel): $ wic rm
|
||
tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1/vmlinuz
|
||
|
||
4. *Add In the New Kernel:* Use the ``wic cp`` command to add the
|
||
updated kernel to the Wic image. Depending on how you built your
|
||
kernel, it could be in different places. If you used ``devtool`` and
|
||
an SDK to build your kernel, it resides in the ``tmp/work`` directory
|
||
of the extensible SDK. If you used ``make`` to build the kernel, the
|
||
kernel will be in the ``workspace/sources`` area.
|
||
|
||
The following example assumes ``devtool`` was used to build the
|
||
kernel: cp
|
||
~/poky_sdk/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/linux-yocto/4.12.12+git999-r0/linux-yocto-4.12.12+git999/arch/x86/boot/bzImage
|
||
\\
|
||
~/poky/build/tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1/vmlinuz
|
||
Once the new kernel is added back into the image, you can use the
|
||
``dd`` command or ```bmaptool`` <#flashing-images-using-bmaptool>`__
|
||
to flash your wic image onto an SD card or USB stick and test your
|
||
target.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Using
|
||
bmaptool
|
||
is generally 10 to 20 times faster than using
|
||
dd
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
Flashing Images Using ``bmaptool``
|
||
==================================
|
||
|
||
A fast and easy way to flash an image to a bootable device is to use
|
||
Bmaptool, which is integrated into the OpenEmbedded build system.
|
||
Bmaptool is a generic tool that creates a file's block map (bmap) and
|
||
then uses that map to copy the file. As compared to traditional tools
|
||
such as dd or cp, Bmaptool can copy (or flash) large files like raw
|
||
system image files much faster.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- If you are using Ubuntu or Debian distributions, you can install
|
||
the ``bmap-tools`` package using the following command and then
|
||
use the tool without specifying ``PATH`` even from the root
|
||
account: $ sudo apt-get install bmap-tools
|
||
|
||
- If you are unable to install the ``bmap-tools`` package, you will
|
||
need to build Bmaptool before using it. Use the following command:
|
||
$ bitbake bmap-tools-native
|
||
|
||
Following, is an example that shows how to flash a Wic image. Realize
|
||
that while this example uses a Wic image, you can use Bmaptool to flash
|
||
any type of image. Use these steps to flash an image using Bmaptool:
|
||
|
||
1. *Update your ``local.conf`` File:* You need to have the following set
|
||
in your ``local.conf`` file before building your image: IMAGE_FSTYPES
|
||
+= "wic wic.bmap"
|
||
|
||
2. *Get Your Image:* Either have your image ready (pre-built with the
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
|
||
setting previously mentioned) or take the step to build the image: $
|
||
bitbake image
|
||
|
||
3. *Flash the Device:* Flash the device with the image by using Bmaptool
|
||
depending on your particular setup. The following commands assume the
|
||
image resides in the Build Directory's ``deploy/images/`` area:
|
||
|
||
- If you have write access to the media, use this command form: $
|
||
oe-run-native bmap-tools-native bmaptool copy
|
||
build-directory/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image.wic /dev/sdX
|
||
|
||
- If you do not have write access to the media, set your permissions
|
||
first and then use the same command form: $ sudo chmod 666
|
||
/dev/sdX $ oe-run-native bmap-tools-native bmaptool copy
|
||
build-directory/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image.wic /dev/sdX
|
||
|
||
For help on the ``bmaptool`` command, use the following command: $
|
||
bmaptool --help
|
||
|
||
Making Images More Secure
|
||
=========================
|
||
|
||
Security is of increasing concern for embedded devices. Consider the
|
||
issues and problems discussed in just this sampling of work found across
|
||
the Internet:
|
||
|
||
- *"*\ `Security Risks of Embedded
|
||
Systems <https://www.schneier.com/blog/archives/2014/01/security_risks_9.html>`__\ *"*
|
||
by Bruce Schneier
|
||
|
||
- *"*\ `Internet Census
|
||
2012 <http://census2012.sourceforge.net/paper.html>`__\ *"* by Carna
|
||
Botnet
|
||
|
||
- *"*\ `Security Issues for Embedded
|
||
Devices <http://elinux.org/images/6/6f/Security-issues.pdf>`__\ *"*
|
||
by Jake Edge
|
||
|
||
When securing your image is of concern, there are steps, tools, and
|
||
variables that you can consider to help you reach the security goals you
|
||
need for your particular device. Not all situations are identical when
|
||
it comes to making an image secure. Consequently, this section provides
|
||
some guidance and suggestions for consideration when you want to make
|
||
your image more secure.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Because the security requirements and risks are different for every
|
||
type of device, this section cannot provide a complete reference on
|
||
securing your custom OS. It is strongly recommended that you also
|
||
consult other sources of information on embedded Linux system
|
||
hardening and on security.
|
||
|
||
General Considerations
|
||
----------------------
|
||
|
||
General considerations exist that help you create more secure images.
|
||
You should consider the following suggestions to help make your device
|
||
more secure:
|
||
|
||
- Scan additional code you are adding to the system (e.g. application
|
||
code) by using static analysis tools. Look for buffer overflows and
|
||
other potential security problems.
|
||
|
||
- Pay particular attention to the security for any web-based
|
||
administration interface.
|
||
|
||
Web interfaces typically need to perform administrative functions and
|
||
tend to need to run with elevated privileges. Thus, the consequences
|
||
resulting from the interface's security becoming compromised can be
|
||
serious. Look for common web vulnerabilities such as
|
||
cross-site-scripting (XSS), unvalidated inputs, and so forth.
|
||
|
||
As with system passwords, the default credentials for accessing a
|
||
web-based interface should not be the same across all devices. This
|
||
is particularly true if the interface is enabled by default as it can
|
||
be assumed that many end-users will not change the credentials.
|
||
|
||
- Ensure you can update the software on the device to mitigate
|
||
vulnerabilities discovered in the future. This consideration
|
||
especially applies when your device is network-enabled.
|
||
|
||
- Ensure you remove or disable debugging functionality before producing
|
||
the final image. For information on how to do this, see the
|
||
"`Considerations Specific to the OpenEmbedded Build
|
||
System <#considerations-specific-to-the-openembedded-build-system>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
- Ensure you have no network services listening that are not needed.
|
||
|
||
- Remove any software from the image that is not needed.
|
||
|
||
- Enable hardware support for secure boot functionality when your
|
||
device supports this functionality.
|
||
|
||
Security Flags
|
||
--------------
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project has security flags that you can enable that help make
|
||
your build output more secure. The security flags are in the
|
||
``meta/conf/distro/include/security_flags.inc`` file in your
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Depending on the recipe, certain security flags are enabled and
|
||
disabled by default.
|
||
|
||
Use the following line in your ``local.conf`` file or in your custom
|
||
distribution configuration file to enable the security compiler and
|
||
linker flags for your build: require
|
||
conf/distro/include/security_flags.inc
|
||
|
||
Considerations Specific to the OpenEmbedded Build System
|
||
--------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can take some steps that are specific to the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system to make your images more secure:
|
||
|
||
- Ensure "debug-tweaks" is not one of your selected
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`.
|
||
When creating a new project, the default is to provide you with an
|
||
initial ``local.conf`` file that enables this feature using the
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
|
||
variable with the line: EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES = "debug-tweaks" To
|
||
disable that feature, simply comment out that line in your
|
||
``local.conf`` file, or make sure ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` does not contain
|
||
"debug-tweaks" before producing your final image. Among other things,
|
||
leaving this in place sets the root password as blank, which makes
|
||
logging in for debugging or inspection easy during development but
|
||
also means anyone can easily log in during production.
|
||
|
||
- It is possible to set a root password for the image and also to set
|
||
passwords for any extra users you might add (e.g. administrative or
|
||
service type users). When you set up passwords for multiple images or
|
||
users, you should not duplicate passwords.
|
||
|
||
To set up passwords, use the
|
||
:ref:`extrausers <ref-classes-extrausers>`
|
||
class, which is the preferred method. For an example on how to set up
|
||
both root and user passwords, see the
|
||
":ref:`extrausers.bbclass <ref-classes-extrausers>`"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
When adding extra user accounts or setting a root password, be
|
||
cautious about setting the same password on every device. If you
|
||
do this, and the password you have set is exposed, then every
|
||
device is now potentially compromised. If you need this access but
|
||
want to ensure security, consider setting a different, random
|
||
password for each device. Typically, you do this as a separate
|
||
step after you deploy the image onto the device.
|
||
|
||
- Consider enabling a Mandatory Access Control (MAC) framework such as
|
||
SMACK or SELinux and tuning it appropriately for your device's usage.
|
||
You can find more information in the
|
||
```meta-selinux`` <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/meta-selinux/>`__
|
||
layer.
|
||
|
||
Tools for Hardening Your Image
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides tools for making your image more secure. You
|
||
can find these tools in the ``meta-security`` layer of the `Yocto
|
||
Project Source Repositories <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;>`__.
|
||
|
||
Creating Your Own Distribution
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
When you build an image using the Yocto Project and do not alter any
|
||
distribution :term:`Metadata`, you are
|
||
creating a Poky distribution. If you wish to gain more control over
|
||
package alternative selections, compile-time options, and other
|
||
low-level configurations, you can create your own distribution.
|
||
|
||
To create your own distribution, the basic steps consist of creating
|
||
your own distribution layer, creating your own distribution
|
||
configuration file, and then adding any needed code and Metadata to the
|
||
layer. The following steps provide some more detail:
|
||
|
||
- *Create a layer for your new distro:* Create your distribution layer
|
||
so that you can keep your Metadata and code for the distribution
|
||
separate. It is strongly recommended that you create and use your own
|
||
layer for configuration and code. Using your own layer as compared to
|
||
just placing configurations in a ``local.conf`` configuration file
|
||
makes it easier to reproduce the same build configuration when using
|
||
multiple build machines. See the "`Creating a General Layer Using the
|
||
``bitbake-layers``
|
||
Script <#creating-a-general-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__"
|
||
section for information on how to quickly set up a layer.
|
||
|
||
- *Create the distribution configuration file:* The distribution
|
||
configuration file needs to be created in the ``conf/distro``
|
||
directory of your layer. You need to name it using your distribution
|
||
name (e.g. ``mydistro.conf``).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The
|
||
DISTRO
|
||
variable in your
|
||
local.conf
|
||
file determines the name of your distribution.
|
||
|
||
You can split out parts of your configuration file into include files
|
||
and then "require" them from within your distribution configuration
|
||
file. Be sure to place the include files in the
|
||
``conf/distro/include`` directory of your layer. A common example
|
||
usage of include files would be to separate out the selection of
|
||
desired version and revisions for individual recipes.
|
||
|
||
Your configuration file needs to set the following required
|
||
variables: :term:`DISTRO_NAME`
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_VERSION`
|
||
These following variables are optional and you typically set them
|
||
from the distribution configuration file:
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`
|
||
:term:`TCLIBC`
|
||
|
||
.. tip::
|
||
|
||
If you want to base your distribution configuration file on the
|
||
very basic configuration from OE-Core, you can use
|
||
conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf
|
||
as a reference and just include variables that differ as compared
|
||
to
|
||
defaultsetup.conf
|
||
. Alternatively, you can create a distribution configuration file
|
||
from scratch using the
|
||
defaultsetup.conf
|
||
file or configuration files from other distributions such as Poky
|
||
or Angstrom as references.
|
||
|
||
- *Provide miscellaneous variables:* Be sure to define any other
|
||
variables for which you want to create a default or enforce as part
|
||
of the distribution configuration. You can include nearly any
|
||
variable from the ``local.conf`` file. The variables you use are not
|
||
limited to the list in the previous bulleted item.
|
||
|
||
- *Point to Your distribution configuration file:* In your
|
||
``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`,
|
||
set your
|
||
:term:`DISTRO` variable to point to
|
||
your distribution's configuration file. For example, if your
|
||
distribution's configuration file is named ``mydistro.conf``, then
|
||
you point to it as follows: DISTRO = "mydistro"
|
||
|
||
- *Add more to the layer if necessary:* Use your layer to hold other
|
||
information needed for the distribution:
|
||
|
||
- Add recipes for installing distro-specific configuration files
|
||
that are not already installed by another recipe. If you have
|
||
distro-specific configuration files that are included by an
|
||
existing recipe, you should add an append file (``.bbappend``) for
|
||
those. For general information and recommendations on how to add
|
||
recipes to your layer, see the "`Creating Your Own
|
||
Layer <#creating-your-own-layer>`__" and "`Following Best
|
||
Practices When Creating
|
||
Layers <#best-practices-to-follow-when-creating-layers>`__"
|
||
sections.
|
||
|
||
- Add any image recipes that are specific to your distribution.
|
||
|
||
- Add a ``psplash`` append file for a branded splash screen. For
|
||
information on append files, see the "`Using .bbappend Files in
|
||
Your Layer <#using-bbappend-files>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
- Add any other append files to make custom changes that are
|
||
specific to individual recipes.
|
||
|
||
Creating a Custom Template Configuration Directory
|
||
==================================================
|
||
|
||
If you are producing your own customized version of the build system for
|
||
use by other users, you might want to customize the message shown by the
|
||
setup script or you might want to change the template configuration
|
||
files (i.e. ``local.conf`` and ``bblayers.conf``) that are created in a
|
||
new build directory.
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system uses the environment variable
|
||
``TEMPLATECONF`` to locate the directory from which it gathers
|
||
configuration information that ultimately ends up in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` ``conf`` directory.
|
||
By default, ``TEMPLATECONF`` is set as follows in the ``poky``
|
||
repository: TEMPLATECONF=${TEMPLATECONF:-meta-poky/conf} This is the
|
||
directory used by the build system to find templates from which to build
|
||
some key configuration files. If you look at this directory, you will
|
||
see the ``bblayers.conf.sample``, ``local.conf.sample``, and
|
||
``conf-notes.txt`` files. The build system uses these files to form the
|
||
respective ``bblayers.conf`` file, ``local.conf`` file, and display the
|
||
list of BitBake targets when running the setup script.
|
||
|
||
To override these default configuration files with configurations you
|
||
want used within every new Build Directory, simply set the
|
||
``TEMPLATECONF`` variable to your directory. The ``TEMPLATECONF``
|
||
variable is set in the ``.templateconf`` file, which is in the top-level
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` folder
|
||
(e.g. ``poky``). Edit the ``.templateconf`` so that it can locate your
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
Best practices dictate that you should keep your template configuration
|
||
directory in your custom distribution layer. For example, suppose you
|
||
have a layer named ``meta-mylayer`` located in your home directory and
|
||
you want your template configuration directory named ``myconf``.
|
||
Changing the ``.templateconf`` as follows causes the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system to look in your directory and base its configuration files on the
|
||
``*.sample`` configuration files it finds. The final configuration files
|
||
(i.e. ``local.conf`` and ``bblayers.conf`` ultimately still end up in
|
||
your Build Directory, but they are based on your ``*.sample`` files.
|
||
TEMPLATECONF=${TEMPLATECONF:-meta-mylayer/myconf}
|
||
|
||
Aside from the ``*.sample`` configuration files, the ``conf-notes.txt``
|
||
also resides in the default ``meta-poky/conf`` directory. The script
|
||
that sets up the build environment (i.e.
|
||
````` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-core-script>`__) uses this file to
|
||
display BitBake targets as part of the script output. Customizing this
|
||
``conf-notes.txt`` file is a good way to make sure your list of custom
|
||
targets appears as part of the script's output.
|
||
|
||
Here is the default list of targets displayed as a result of running
|
||
either of the setup scripts: You can now run 'bitbake <target>' Common
|
||
targets are: core-image-minimal core-image-sato meta-toolchain
|
||
meta-ide-support
|
||
|
||
Changing the listed common targets is as easy as editing your version of
|
||
``conf-notes.txt`` in your custom template configuration directory and
|
||
making sure you have ``TEMPLATECONF`` set to your directory.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-saving-memory-during-a-build:
|
||
|
||
Conserving Disk Space During Builds
|
||
===================================
|
||
|
||
To help conserve disk space during builds, you can add the following
|
||
statement to your project's ``local.conf`` configuration file found in
|
||
the :term:`Build Directory`: INHERIT
|
||
+= "rm_work" Adding this statement deletes the work directory used for
|
||
building a recipe once the recipe is built. For more information on
|
||
"rm_work", see the
|
||
:ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` class in the
|
||
Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
Working with Packages
|
||
=====================
|
||
|
||
This section describes a few tasks that involve packages:
|
||
|
||
- `Excluding packages from an
|
||
image <#excluding-packages-from-an-image>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Incrementing a binary package
|
||
version <#incrementing-a-binary-package-version>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Handling optional module
|
||
packaging <#handling-optional-module-packaging>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Using runtime package
|
||
management <#using-runtime-package-management>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Generating and using signed
|
||
packages <#generating-and-using-signed-packages>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Setting up and running package test
|
||
(ptest) <#testing-packages-with-ptest>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Creating node package manager (NPM)
|
||
packages <#creating-node-package-manager-npm-packages>`__
|
||
|
||
- `Adding custom metadata to
|
||
packages <#adding-custom-metadata-to-packages>`__
|
||
|
||
Excluding Packages from an Image
|
||
--------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You might find it necessary to prevent specific packages from being
|
||
installed into an image. If so, you can use several variables to direct
|
||
the build system to essentially ignore installing recommended packages
|
||
or to not install a package at all.
|
||
|
||
The following list introduces variables you can use to prevent packages
|
||
from being installed into your image. Each of these variables only works
|
||
with IPK and RPM package types. Support for Debian packages does not
|
||
exist. Also, you can use these variables from your ``local.conf`` file
|
||
or attach them to a specific image recipe by using a recipe name
|
||
override. For more detail on the variables, see the descriptions in the
|
||
Yocto Project Reference Manual's glossary chapter.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`:
|
||
Use this variable to specify "recommended-only" packages that you do
|
||
not want installed.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`:
|
||
Use this variable to prevent all "recommended-only" packages from
|
||
being installed.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE`:
|
||
Use this variable to prevent specific packages from being installed
|
||
regardless of whether they are "recommended-only" or not. You need to
|
||
realize that the build process could fail with an error when you
|
||
prevent the installation of a package whose presence is required by
|
||
an installed package.
|
||
|
||
.. _incrementing-a-binary-package-version:
|
||
|
||
Incrementing a Package Version
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
This section provides some background on how binary package versioning
|
||
is accomplished and presents some of the services, variables, and
|
||
terminology involved.
|
||
|
||
In order to understand binary package versioning, you need to consider
|
||
the following:
|
||
|
||
- Binary Package: The binary package that is eventually built and
|
||
installed into an image.
|
||
|
||
- Binary Package Version: The binary package version is composed of two
|
||
components - a version and a revision.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Technically, a third component, the "epoch" (i.e.
|
||
PE
|
||
) is involved but this discussion for the most part ignores
|
||
PE
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
The version and revision are taken from the
|
||
:term:`PV` and
|
||
:term:`PR` variables, respectively.
|
||
|
||
- ``PV``: The recipe version. ``PV`` represents the version of the
|
||
software being packaged. Do not confuse ``PV`` with the binary
|
||
package version.
|
||
|
||
- ``PR``: The recipe revision.
|
||
|
||
- :term:`SRCPV`: The OpenEmbedded
|
||
build system uses this string to help define the value of ``PV`` when
|
||
the source code revision needs to be included in it.
|
||
|
||
- `PR Service <https://wiki.yoctoproject.org/wiki/PR_Service>`__: A
|
||
network-based service that helps automate keeping package feeds
|
||
compatible with existing package manager applications such as RPM,
|
||
APT, and OPKG.
|
||
|
||
Whenever the binary package content changes, the binary package version
|
||
must change. Changing the binary package version is accomplished by
|
||
changing or "bumping" the ``PR`` and/or ``PV`` values. Increasing these
|
||
values occurs one of two ways:
|
||
|
||
- Automatically using a Package Revision Service (PR Service).
|
||
|
||
- Manually incrementing the ``PR`` and/or ``PV`` variables.
|
||
|
||
Given a primary challenge of any build system and its users is how to
|
||
maintain a package feed that is compatible with existing package manager
|
||
applications such as RPM, APT, and OPKG, using an automated system is
|
||
much preferred over a manual system. In either system, the main
|
||
requirement is that binary package version numbering increases in a
|
||
linear fashion and that a number of version components exist that
|
||
support that linear progression. For information on how to ensure
|
||
package revisioning remains linear, see the "`Automatically Incrementing
|
||
a Binary Package Revision
|
||
Number <#automatically-incrementing-a-binary-package-revision-number>`__"
|
||
section.
|
||
|
||
The following three sections provide related information on the PR
|
||
Service, the manual method for "bumping" ``PR`` and/or ``PV``, and on
|
||
how to ensure binary package revisioning remains linear.
|
||
|
||
Working With a PR Service
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
As mentioned, attempting to maintain revision numbers in the
|
||
:term:`Metadata` is error prone, inaccurate,
|
||
and causes problems for people submitting recipes. Conversely, the PR
|
||
Service automatically generates increasing numbers, particularly the
|
||
revision field, which removes the human element.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For additional information on using a PR Service, you can see the
|
||
PR Service
|
||
wiki page.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project uses variables in order of decreasing priority to
|
||
facilitate revision numbering (i.e.
|
||
:term:`PE`,
|
||
:term:`PV`, and
|
||
:term:`PR` for epoch, version, and
|
||
revision, respectively). The values are highly dependent on the policies
|
||
and procedures of a given distribution and package feed.
|
||
|
||
Because the OpenEmbedded build system uses
|
||
"`signatures <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#overview-checksums>`__", which are
|
||
unique to a given build, the build system knows when to rebuild
|
||
packages. All the inputs into a given task are represented by a
|
||
signature, which can trigger a rebuild when different. Thus, the build
|
||
system itself does not rely on the ``PR``, ``PV``, and ``PE`` numbers to
|
||
trigger a rebuild. The signatures, however, can be used to generate
|
||
these values.
|
||
|
||
The PR Service works with both ``OEBasic`` and ``OEBasicHash``
|
||
generators. The value of ``PR`` bumps when the checksum changes and the
|
||
different generator mechanisms change signatures under different
|
||
circumstances.
|
||
|
||
As implemented, the build system includes values from the PR Service
|
||
into the ``PR`` field as an addition using the form "``.x``" so ``r0``
|
||
becomes ``r0.1``, ``r0.2`` and so forth. This scheme allows existing
|
||
``PR`` values to be used for whatever reasons, which include manual
|
||
``PR`` bumps, should it be necessary.
|
||
|
||
By default, the PR Service is not enabled or running. Thus, the packages
|
||
generated are just "self consistent". The build system adds and removes
|
||
packages and there are no guarantees about upgrade paths but images will
|
||
be consistent and correct with the latest changes.
|
||
|
||
The simplest form for a PR Service is for it to exist for a single host
|
||
development system that builds the package feed (building system). For
|
||
this scenario, you can enable a local PR Service by setting
|
||
:term:`PRSERV_HOST` in your
|
||
``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`: PRSERV_HOST =
|
||
"localhost:0" Once the service is started, packages will automatically
|
||
get increasing ``PR`` values and BitBake takes care of starting and
|
||
stopping the server.
|
||
|
||
If you have a more complex setup where multiple host development systems
|
||
work against a common, shared package feed, you have a single PR Service
|
||
running and it is connected to each building system. For this scenario,
|
||
you need to start the PR Service using the ``bitbake-prserv`` command:
|
||
bitbake-prserv --host ip --port port --start In addition to
|
||
hand-starting the service, you need to update the ``local.conf`` file of
|
||
each building system as described earlier so each system points to the
|
||
server and port.
|
||
|
||
It is also recommended you use build history, which adds some sanity
|
||
checks to binary package versions, in conjunction with the server that
|
||
is running the PR Service. To enable build history, add the following to
|
||
each building system's ``local.conf`` file: # It is recommended to
|
||
activate "buildhistory" for testing the PR service INHERIT +=
|
||
"buildhistory" BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1" For information on build
|
||
history, see the "`Maintaining Build Output
|
||
Quality <#maintaining-build-output-quality>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system does not maintain ``PR`` information as
|
||
part of the shared state (sstate) packages. If you maintain an sstate
|
||
feed, its expected that either all your building systems that
|
||
contribute to the sstate feed use a shared PR Service, or you do not
|
||
run a PR Service on any of your building systems. Having some systems
|
||
use a PR Service while others do not leads to obvious problems.
|
||
|
||
For more information on shared state, see the "`Shared State
|
||
Cache <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#shared-state-cache>`__" section in the
|
||
Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
Manually Bumping PR
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The alternative to setting up a PR Service is to manually "bump" the
|
||
:term:`PR` variable.
|
||
|
||
If a committed change results in changing the package output, then the
|
||
value of the PR variable needs to be increased (or "bumped") as part of
|
||
that commit. For new recipes you should add the ``PR`` variable and set
|
||
its initial value equal to "r0", which is the default. Even though the
|
||
default value is "r0", the practice of adding it to a new recipe makes
|
||
it harder to forget to bump the variable when you make changes to the
|
||
recipe in future.
|
||
|
||
If you are sharing a common ``.inc`` file with multiple recipes, you can
|
||
also use the ``INC_PR`` variable to ensure that the recipes sharing the
|
||
``.inc`` file are rebuilt when the ``.inc`` file itself is changed. The
|
||
``.inc`` file must set ``INC_PR`` (initially to "r0"), and all recipes
|
||
referring to it should set ``PR`` to "${INC_PR}.0" initially,
|
||
incrementing the last number when the recipe is changed. If the ``.inc``
|
||
file is changed then its ``INC_PR`` should be incremented.
|
||
|
||
When upgrading the version of a binary package, assuming the ``PV``
|
||
changes, the ``PR`` variable should be reset to "r0" (or "${INC_PR}.0"
|
||
if you are using ``INC_PR``).
|
||
|
||
Usually, version increases occur only to binary packages. However, if
|
||
for some reason ``PV`` changes but does not increase, you can increase
|
||
the ``PE`` variable (Package Epoch). The ``PE`` variable defaults to
|
||
"0".
|
||
|
||
Binary package version numbering strives to follow the `Debian Version
|
||
Field Policy
|
||
Guidelines <http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/ch-controlfields.html>`__.
|
||
These guidelines define how versions are compared and what "increasing"
|
||
a version means.
|
||
|
||
.. _automatically-incrementing-a-binary-package-revision-number:
|
||
|
||
Automatically Incrementing a Package Version Number
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
When fetching a repository, BitBake uses the
|
||
:term:`SRCREV` variable to determine
|
||
the specific source code revision from which to build. You set the
|
||
``SRCREV`` variable to
|
||
:term:`AUTOREV` to cause the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system to automatically use the latest revision of
|
||
the software: SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
|
||
Furthermore, you need to reference ``SRCPV`` in ``PV`` in order to
|
||
automatically update the version whenever the revision of the source
|
||
code changes. Here is an example: PV = "1.0+git${SRCPV}" The
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system substitutes ``SRCPV`` with the following:
|
||
AUTOINC+source_code_revision The build system replaces the ``AUTOINC``
|
||
with a number. The number used depends on the state of the PR Service:
|
||
|
||
- If PR Service is enabled, the build system increments the number,
|
||
which is similar to the behavior of
|
||
:term:`PR`. This behavior results in
|
||
linearly increasing package versions, which is desirable. Here is an
|
||
example: hello-world-git_0.0+git0+b6558dd387-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
|
||
hello-world-git_0.0+git1+dd2f5c3565-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
|
||
|
||
- If PR Service is not enabled, the build system replaces the
|
||
``AUTOINC`` placeholder with zero (i.e. "0"). This results in
|
||
changing the package version since the source revision is included.
|
||
However, package versions are not increased linearly. Here is an
|
||
example: hello-world-git_0.0+git0+b6558dd387-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
|
||
hello-world-git_0.0+git0+dd2f5c3565-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
|
||
|
||
In summary, the OpenEmbedded build system does not track the history of
|
||
binary package versions for this purpose. ``AUTOINC``, in this case, is
|
||
comparable to ``PR``. If PR server is not enabled, ``AUTOINC`` in the
|
||
package version is simply replaced by "0". If PR server is enabled, the
|
||
build system keeps track of the package versions and bumps the number
|
||
when the package revision changes.
|
||
|
||
Handling Optional Module Packaging
|
||
----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Many pieces of software split functionality into optional modules (or
|
||
plugins) and the plugins that are built might depend on configuration
|
||
options. To avoid having to duplicate the logic that determines what
|
||
modules are available in your recipe or to avoid having to package each
|
||
module by hand, the OpenEmbedded build system provides functionality to
|
||
handle module packaging dynamically.
|
||
|
||
To handle optional module packaging, you need to do two things:
|
||
|
||
- Ensure the module packaging is actually done.
|
||
|
||
- Ensure that any dependencies on optional modules from other recipes
|
||
are satisfied by your recipe.
|
||
|
||
Making Sure the Packaging is Done
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To ensure the module packaging actually gets done, you use the
|
||
``do_split_packages`` function within the ``populate_packages`` Python
|
||
function in your recipe. The ``do_split_packages`` function searches for
|
||
a pattern of files or directories under a specified path and creates a
|
||
package for each one it finds by appending to the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGES` variable and
|
||
setting the appropriate values for ``FILES_packagename``,
|
||
``RDEPENDS_packagename``, ``DESCRIPTION_packagename``, and so forth.
|
||
Here is an example from the ``lighttpd`` recipe: python
|
||
populate_packages_prepend () { lighttpd_libdir = d.expand('${libdir}')
|
||
do_split_packages(d, lighttpd_libdir, '^mod_(.*)\.so$',
|
||
'lighttpd-module-%s', 'Lighttpd module for %s', extra_depends='') } The
|
||
previous example specifies a number of things in the call to
|
||
``do_split_packages``.
|
||
|
||
- A directory within the files installed by your recipe through
|
||
``do_install`` in which to search.
|
||
|
||
- A regular expression used to match module files in that directory. In
|
||
the example, note the parentheses () that mark the part of the
|
||
expression from which the module name should be derived.
|
||
|
||
- A pattern to use for the package names.
|
||
|
||
- A description for each package.
|
||
|
||
- An empty string for ``extra_depends``, which disables the default
|
||
dependency on the main ``lighttpd`` package. Thus, if a file in
|
||
``${libdir}`` called ``mod_alias.so`` is found, a package called
|
||
``lighttpd-module-alias`` is created for it and the
|
||
:term:`DESCRIPTION` is set to
|
||
"Lighttpd module for alias".
|
||
|
||
Often, packaging modules is as simple as the previous example. However,
|
||
more advanced options exist that you can use within
|
||
``do_split_packages`` to modify its behavior. And, if you need to, you
|
||
can add more logic by specifying a hook function that is called for each
|
||
package. It is also perfectly acceptable to call ``do_split_packages``
|
||
multiple times if you have more than one set of modules to package.
|
||
|
||
For more examples that show how to use ``do_split_packages``, see the
|
||
``connman.inc`` file in the ``meta/recipes-connectivity/connman/``
|
||
directory of the ``poky`` `source
|
||
repository <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#yocto-project-repositories>`__. You can
|
||
also find examples in ``meta/classes/kernel.bbclass``.
|
||
|
||
Following is a reference that shows ``do_split_packages`` mandatory and
|
||
optional arguments: Mandatory arguments root The path in which to search
|
||
file_regex Regular expression to match searched files. Use parentheses
|
||
() to mark the part of this expression that should be used to derive the
|
||
module name (to be substituted where %s is used in other function
|
||
arguments as noted below) output_pattern Pattern to use for the package
|
||
names. Must include %s. description Description to set for each package.
|
||
Must include %s. Optional arguments postinst Postinstall script to use
|
||
for all packages (as a string) recursive True to perform a recursive
|
||
search - default False hook A hook function to be called for every
|
||
match. The function will be called with the following arguments (in the
|
||
order listed): f Full path to the file/directory match pkg The package
|
||
name file_regex As above output_pattern As above modulename The module
|
||
name derived using file_regex extra_depends Extra runtime dependencies
|
||
(RDEPENDS) to be set for all packages. The default value of None causes
|
||
a dependency on the main package (${PN}) - if you do not want this, pass
|
||
empty string '' for this parameter. aux_files_pattern Extra item(s) to
|
||
be added to FILES for each package. Can be a single string item or a
|
||
list of strings for multiple items. Must include %s. postrm postrm
|
||
script to use for all packages (as a string) allow_dirs True to allow
|
||
directories to be matched - default False prepend If True, prepend
|
||
created packages to PACKAGES instead of the default False which appends
|
||
them match_path match file_regex on the whole relative path to the root
|
||
rather than just the file name aux_files_pattern_verbatim Extra item(s)
|
||
to be added to FILES for each package, using the actual derived module
|
||
name rather than converting it to something legal for a package name.
|
||
Can be a single string item or a list of strings for multiple items.
|
||
Must include %s. allow_links True to allow symlinks to be matched -
|
||
default False summary Summary to set for each package. Must include %s;
|
||
defaults to description if not set.
|
||
|
||
Satisfying Dependencies
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The second part for handling optional module packaging is to ensure that
|
||
any dependencies on optional modules from other recipes are satisfied by
|
||
your recipe. You can be sure these dependencies are satisfied by using
|
||
the :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`
|
||
variable. Here is an example that continues with the ``lighttpd`` recipe
|
||
shown earlier: PACKAGES_DYNAMIC = "lighttpd-module-.*" The name
|
||
specified in the regular expression can of course be anything. In this
|
||
example, it is ``lighttpd-module-`` and is specified as the prefix to
|
||
ensure that any :term:`RDEPENDS` and
|
||
:term:`RRECOMMENDS` on a package
|
||
name starting with the prefix are satisfied during build time. If you
|
||
are using ``do_split_packages`` as described in the previous section,
|
||
the value you put in ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`` should correspond to the name
|
||
pattern specified in the call to ``do_split_packages``.
|
||
|
||
Using Runtime Package Management
|
||
--------------------------------
|
||
|
||
During a build, BitBake always transforms a recipe into one or more
|
||
packages. For example, BitBake takes the ``bash`` recipe and produces a
|
||
number of packages (e.g. ``bash``, ``bash-bashbug``,
|
||
``bash-completion``, ``bash-completion-dbg``, ``bash-completion-dev``,
|
||
``bash-completion-extra``, ``bash-dbg``, and so forth). Not all
|
||
generated packages are included in an image.
|
||
|
||
In several situations, you might need to update, add, remove, or query
|
||
the packages on a target device at runtime (i.e. without having to
|
||
generate a new image). Examples of such situations include:
|
||
|
||
- You want to provide in-the-field updates to deployed devices (e.g.
|
||
security updates).
|
||
|
||
- You want to have a fast turn-around development cycle for one or more
|
||
applications that run on your device.
|
||
|
||
- You want to temporarily install the "debug" packages of various
|
||
applications on your device so that debugging can be greatly improved
|
||
by allowing access to symbols and source debugging.
|
||
|
||
- You want to deploy a more minimal package selection of your device
|
||
but allow in-the-field updates to add a larger selection for
|
||
customization.
|
||
|
||
In all these situations, you have something similar to a more
|
||
traditional Linux distribution in that in-field devices are able to
|
||
receive pre-compiled packages from a server for installation or update.
|
||
Being able to install these packages on a running, in-field device is
|
||
what is termed "runtime package management".
|
||
|
||
In order to use runtime package management, you need a host or server
|
||
machine that serves up the pre-compiled packages plus the required
|
||
metadata. You also need package manipulation tools on the target. The
|
||
build machine is a likely candidate to act as the server. However, that
|
||
machine does not necessarily have to be the package server. The build
|
||
machine could push its artifacts to another machine that acts as the
|
||
server (e.g. Internet-facing). In fact, doing so is advantageous for a
|
||
production environment as getting the packages away from the development
|
||
system's build directory prevents accidental overwrites.
|
||
|
||
A simple build that targets just one device produces more than one
|
||
package database. In other words, the packages produced by a build are
|
||
separated out into a couple of different package groupings based on
|
||
criteria such as the target's CPU architecture, the target board, or the
|
||
C library used on the target. For example, a build targeting the
|
||
``qemux86`` device produces the following three package databases:
|
||
``noarch``, ``i586``, and ``qemux86``. If you wanted your ``qemux86``
|
||
device to be aware of all the packages that were available to it, you
|
||
would need to point it to each of these databases individually. In a
|
||
similar way, a traditional Linux distribution usually is configured to
|
||
be aware of a number of software repositories from which it retrieves
|
||
packages.
|
||
|
||
Using runtime package management is completely optional and not required
|
||
for a successful build or deployment in any way. But if you want to make
|
||
use of runtime package management, you need to do a couple things above
|
||
and beyond the basics. The remainder of this section describes what you
|
||
need to do.
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-build:
|
||
|
||
Build Considerations
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
This section describes build considerations of which you need to be
|
||
aware in order to provide support for runtime package management.
|
||
|
||
When BitBake generates packages, it needs to know what format or formats
|
||
to use. In your configuration, you use the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
|
||
variable to specify the format:
|
||
|
||
1. Open the ``local.conf`` file inside your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` (e.g.
|
||
``~/poky/build/conf/local.conf``).
|
||
|
||
2. Select the desired package format as follows: PACKAGE_CLASSES ?=
|
||
“package_packageformat” where packageformat can be "ipk", "rpm",
|
||
"deb", or "tar" which are the supported package formats.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Because the Yocto Project supports four different package formats,
|
||
you can set the variable with more than one argument. However, the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system only uses the first argument when
|
||
creating an image or Software Development Kit (SDK).
|
||
|
||
If you would like your image to start off with a basic package database
|
||
containing the packages in your current build as well as to have the
|
||
relevant tools available on the target for runtime package management,
|
||
you can include "package-management" in the
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
|
||
variable. Including "package-management" in this configuration variable
|
||
ensures that when the image is assembled for your target, the image
|
||
includes the currently-known package databases as well as the
|
||
target-specific tools required for runtime package management to be
|
||
performed on the target. However, this is not strictly necessary. You
|
||
could start your image off without any databases but only include the
|
||
required on-target package tool(s). As an example, you could include
|
||
"opkg" in your
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable
|
||
if you are using the IPK package format. You can then initialize your
|
||
target's package database(s) later once your image is up and running.
|
||
|
||
Whenever you perform any sort of build step that can potentially
|
||
generate a package or modify existing package, it is always a good idea
|
||
to re-generate the package index after the build by using the following
|
||
command: $ bitbake package-index It might be tempting to build the
|
||
package and the package index at the same time with a command such as
|
||
the following: $ bitbake some-package package-index Do not do this as
|
||
BitBake does not schedule the package index for after the completion of
|
||
the package you are building. Consequently, you cannot be sure of the
|
||
package index including information for the package you just built.
|
||
Thus, be sure to run the package update step separately after building
|
||
any packages.
|
||
|
||
You can use the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
|
||
and
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
|
||
variables to pre-configure target images to use a package feed. If you
|
||
do not define these variables, then manual steps as described in the
|
||
subsequent sections are necessary to configure the target. You should
|
||
set these variables before building the image in order to produce a
|
||
correctly configured image.
|
||
|
||
When your build is complete, your packages reside in the
|
||
``${TMPDIR}/deploy/packageformat`` directory. For example, if
|
||
``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}`` is
|
||
``tmp`` and your selected package type is RPM, then your RPM packages
|
||
are available in ``tmp/deploy/rpm``.
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-server:
|
||
|
||
Host or Server Machine Setup
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Although other protocols are possible, a server using HTTP typically
|
||
serves packages. If you want to use HTTP, then set up and configure a
|
||
web server such as Apache 2, lighttpd, or SimpleHTTPServer on the
|
||
machine serving the packages.
|
||
|
||
To keep things simple, this section describes how to set up a
|
||
SimpleHTTPServer web server to share package feeds from the developer's
|
||
machine. Although this server might not be the best for a production
|
||
environment, the setup is simple and straight forward. Should you want
|
||
to use a different server more suited for production (e.g. Apache 2,
|
||
Lighttpd, or Nginx), take the appropriate steps to do so.
|
||
|
||
From within the build directory where you have built an image based on
|
||
your packaging choice (i.e. the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
|
||
setting), simply start the server. The following example assumes a build
|
||
directory of ``~/poky/build/tmp/deploy/rpm`` and a ``PACKAGE_CLASSES``
|
||
setting of "package_rpm": $ cd ~/poky/build/tmp/deploy/rpm $ python -m
|
||
SimpleHTTPServer
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-target:
|
||
|
||
Target Setup
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Setting up the target differs depending on the package management
|
||
system. This section provides information for RPM, IPK, and DEB.
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-target-rpm:
|
||
|
||
Using RPM
|
||
^^^^^^^^^
|
||
|
||
The `Dandified Packaging
|
||
Tool <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/DNF_(software)>`__ (DNF) performs
|
||
runtime package management of RPM packages. In order to use DNF for
|
||
runtime package management, you must perform an initial setup on the
|
||
target machine for cases where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_*`` variables were not
|
||
set as part of the image that is running on the target. This means if
|
||
you built your image and did not not use these variables as part of the
|
||
build and your image is now running on the target, you need to perform
|
||
the steps in this section if you want to use runtime package management.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For information on the
|
||
PACKAGE_FEED_\*
|
||
variables, see
|
||
PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS
|
||
,
|
||
PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS
|
||
, and
|
||
PACKAGE_FEED_URIS
|
||
in the Yocto Project Reference Manual variables glossary.
|
||
|
||
On the target, you must inform DNF that package databases are available.
|
||
You do this by creating a file named
|
||
``/etc/yum.repos.d/oe-packages.repo`` and defining the ``oe-packages``.
|
||
|
||
As an example, assume the target is able to use the following package
|
||
databases: ``all``, ``i586``, and ``qemux86`` from a server named
|
||
``my.server``. The specifics for setting up the web server are up to
|
||
you. The critical requirement is that the URIs in the target repository
|
||
configuration point to the correct remote location for the feeds.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For development purposes, you can point the web server to the build
|
||
system's
|
||
deploy
|
||
directory. However, for production use, it is better to copy the
|
||
package directories to a location outside of the build area and use
|
||
that location. Doing so avoids situations where the build system
|
||
overwrites or changes the
|
||
deploy
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
When telling DNF where to look for the package databases, you must
|
||
declare individual locations per architecture or a single location used
|
||
for all architectures. You cannot do both:
|
||
|
||
- *Create an Explicit List of Architectures:* Define individual base
|
||
URLs to identify where each package database is located:
|
||
[oe-packages] baseurl=http://my.server/rpm/i586
|
||
http://my.server/rpm/qemux86 http://my.server/rpm/all This example
|
||
informs DNF about individual package databases for all three
|
||
architectures.
|
||
|
||
- *Create a Single (Full) Package Index:* Define a single base URL that
|
||
identifies where a full package database is located: [oe-packages]
|
||
baseurl=http://my.server/rpm This example informs DNF about a single
|
||
package database that contains all the package index information for
|
||
all supported architectures.
|
||
|
||
Once you have informed DNF where to find the package databases, you need
|
||
to fetch them: # dnf makecache DNF is now able to find, install, and
|
||
upgrade packages from the specified repository or repositories.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
See the
|
||
DNF documentation
|
||
for additional information.
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-target-ipk:
|
||
|
||
Using IPK
|
||
^^^^^^^^^
|
||
|
||
The ``opkg`` application performs runtime package management of IPK
|
||
packages. You must perform an initial setup for ``opkg`` on the target
|
||
machine if the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
|
||
and
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
|
||
variables have not been set or the target image was built before the
|
||
variables were set.
|
||
|
||
The ``opkg`` application uses configuration files to find available
|
||
package databases. Thus, you need to create a configuration file inside
|
||
the ``/etc/opkg/`` direction, which informs ``opkg`` of any repository
|
||
you want to use.
|
||
|
||
As an example, suppose you are serving packages from a ``ipk/``
|
||
directory containing the ``i586``, ``all``, and ``qemux86`` databases
|
||
through an HTTP server named ``my.server``. On the target, create a
|
||
configuration file (e.g. ``my_repo.conf``) inside the ``/etc/opkg/``
|
||
directory containing the following: src/gz all http://my.server/ipk/all
|
||
src/gz i586 http://my.server/ipk/i586 src/gz qemux86
|
||
http://my.server/ipk/qemux86 Next, instruct ``opkg`` to fetch the
|
||
repository information: # opkg update The ``opkg`` application is now
|
||
able to find, install, and upgrade packages from the specified
|
||
repository.
|
||
|
||
.. _runtime-package-management-target-deb:
|
||
|
||
Using DEB
|
||
^^^^^^^^^
|
||
|
||
The ``apt`` application performs runtime package management of DEB
|
||
packages. This application uses a source list file to find available
|
||
package databases. You must perform an initial setup for ``apt`` on the
|
||
target machine if the
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
|
||
and
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
|
||
variables have not been set or the target image was built before the
|
||
variables were set.
|
||
|
||
To inform ``apt`` of the repository you want to use, you might create a
|
||
list file (e.g. ``my_repo.list``) inside the
|
||
``/etc/apt/sources.list.d/`` directory. As an example, suppose you are
|
||
serving packages from a ``deb/`` directory containing the ``i586``,
|
||
``all``, and ``qemux86`` databases through an HTTP server named
|
||
``my.server``. The list file should contain: deb
|
||
http://my.server/deb/all ./ deb http://my.server/deb/i586 ./ deb
|
||
http://my.server/deb/qemux86 ./ Next, instruct the ``apt`` application
|
||
to fetch the repository information: # apt-get update After this step,
|
||
``apt`` is able to find, install, and upgrade packages from the
|
||
specified repository.
|
||
|
||
Generating and Using Signed Packages
|
||
------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
In order to add security to RPM packages used during a build, you can
|
||
take steps to securely sign them. Once a signature is verified, the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system can use the package in the build. If security
|
||
fails for a signed package, the build system aborts the build.
|
||
|
||
This section describes how to sign RPM packages during a build and how
|
||
to use signed package feeds (repositories) when doing a build.
|
||
|
||
Signing RPM Packages
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To enable signing RPM packages, you must set up the following
|
||
configurations in either your ``local.config`` or ``distro.config``
|
||
file: # Inherit sign_rpm.bbclass to enable signing functionality INHERIT
|
||
+= " sign_rpm" # Define the GPG key that will be used for signing.
|
||
RPM_GPG_NAME = "key_name" # Provide passphrase for the key
|
||
RPM_GPG_PASSPHRASE = "passphrase"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Be sure to supply appropriate values for both
|
||
key_name
|
||
and
|
||
passphrase
|
||
|
||
Aside from the ``RPM_GPG_NAME`` and ``RPM_GPG_PASSPHRASE`` variables in
|
||
the previous example, two optional variables related to signing exist:
|
||
|
||
- *``GPG_BIN``:* Specifies a ``gpg`` binary/wrapper that is executed
|
||
when the package is signed.
|
||
|
||
- *``GPG_PATH``:* Specifies the ``gpg`` home directory used when the
|
||
package is signed.
|
||
|
||
Processing Package Feeds
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
In addition to being able to sign RPM packages, you can also enable
|
||
signed package feeds for IPK and RPM packages.
|
||
|
||
The steps you need to take to enable signed package feed use are similar
|
||
to the steps used to sign RPM packages. You must define the following in
|
||
your ``local.config`` or ``distro.config`` file: INHERIT +=
|
||
"sign_package_feed" PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_NAME = "key_name"
|
||
PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE = "path_to_file_containing_passphrase"
|
||
For signed package feeds, the passphrase must exist in a separate file,
|
||
which is pointed to by the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE``
|
||
variable. Regarding security, keeping a plain text passphrase out of the
|
||
configuration is more secure.
|
||
|
||
Aside from the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_NAME`` and
|
||
``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE`` variables, three optional variables
|
||
related to signed package feeds exist:
|
||
|
||
- *``GPG_BIN``:* Specifies a ``gpg`` binary/wrapper that is executed
|
||
when the package is signed.
|
||
|
||
- *``GPG_PATH``:* Specifies the ``gpg`` home directory used when the
|
||
package is signed.
|
||
|
||
- *``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_SIGNATURE_TYPE``:* Specifies the type of ``gpg``
|
||
signature. This variable applies only to RPM and IPK package feeds.
|
||
Allowable values for the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_SIGNATURE_TYPE`` are
|
||
"ASC", which is the default and specifies ascii armored, and "BIN",
|
||
which specifies binary.
|
||
|
||
Testing Packages With ptest
|
||
---------------------------
|
||
|
||
A Package Test (ptest) runs tests against packages built by the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system on the target machine. A ptest contains at
|
||
least two items: the actual test, and a shell script (``run-ptest``)
|
||
that starts the test. The shell script that starts the test must not
|
||
contain the actual test - the script only starts the test. On the other
|
||
hand, the test can be anything from a simple shell script that runs a
|
||
binary and checks the output to an elaborate system of test binaries and
|
||
data files.
|
||
|
||
The test generates output in the format used by Automake: result:
|
||
testname where the result can be ``PASS``, ``FAIL``, or ``SKIP``, and
|
||
the testname can be any identifying string.
|
||
|
||
For a list of Yocto Project recipes that are already enabled with ptest,
|
||
see the `Ptest <https://wiki.yoctoproject.org/wiki/Ptest>`__ wiki page.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A recipe is "ptest-enabled" if it inherits the
|
||
ptest
|
||
class.
|
||
|
||
Adding ptest to Your Build
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To add package testing to your build, add the
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` and
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
|
||
variables to your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`:
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_append = " ptest" EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES += "ptest-pkgs"
|
||
Once your build is complete, the ptest files are installed into the
|
||
``/usr/lib/package/ptest`` directory within the image, where ``package``
|
||
is the name of the package.
|
||
|
||
Running ptest
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The ``ptest-runner`` package installs a shell script that loops through
|
||
all installed ptest test suites and runs them in sequence. Consequently,
|
||
you might want to add this package to your image.
|
||
|
||
Getting Your Package Ready
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
In order to enable a recipe to run installed ptests on target hardware,
|
||
you need to prepare the recipes that build the packages you want to
|
||
test. Here is what you have to do for each recipe:
|
||
|
||
- *Be sure the recipe inherits
|
||
the*\ :ref:`ptest <ref-classes-ptest>`\ *class:*
|
||
Include the following line in each recipe: inherit ptest
|
||
|
||
- *Create ``run-ptest``:* This script starts your test. Locate the
|
||
script where you will refer to it using
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI`. Here is an
|
||
example that starts a test for ``dbus``: #!/bin/sh cd test make -k
|
||
runtest-TESTS
|
||
|
||
- *Ensure dependencies are met:* If the test adds build or runtime
|
||
dependencies that normally do not exist for the package (such as
|
||
requiring "make" to run the test suite), use the
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS` and
|
||
:term:`RDEPENDS` variables in
|
||
your recipe in order for the package to meet the dependencies. Here
|
||
is an example where the package has a runtime dependency on "make":
|
||
RDEPENDS_${PN}-ptest += "make"
|
||
|
||
- *Add a function to build the test suite:* Not many packages support
|
||
cross-compilation of their test suites. Consequently, you usually
|
||
need to add a cross-compilation function to the package.
|
||
|
||
Many packages based on Automake compile and run the test suite by
|
||
using a single command such as ``make check``. However, the host
|
||
``make check`` builds and runs on the same computer, while
|
||
cross-compiling requires that the package is built on the host but
|
||
executed for the target architecture (though often, as in the case
|
||
for ptest, the execution occurs on the host). The built version of
|
||
Automake that ships with the Yocto Project includes a patch that
|
||
separates building and execution. Consequently, packages that use the
|
||
unaltered, patched version of ``make check`` automatically
|
||
cross-compiles.
|
||
|
||
Regardless, you still must add a ``do_compile_ptest`` function to
|
||
build the test suite. Add a function similar to the following to your
|
||
recipe: do_compile_ptest() { oe_runmake buildtest-TESTS }
|
||
|
||
- *Ensure special configurations are set:* If the package requires
|
||
special configurations prior to compiling the test code, you must
|
||
insert a ``do_configure_ptest`` function into the recipe.
|
||
|
||
- *Install the test suite:* The ``ptest`` class automatically copies
|
||
the file ``run-ptest`` to the target and then runs make
|
||
``install-ptest`` to run the tests. If this is not enough, you need
|
||
to create a ``do_install_ptest`` function and make sure it gets
|
||
called after the "make install-ptest" completes.
|
||
|
||
Creating Node Package Manager (NPM) Packages
|
||
--------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
`NPM <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Npm_(software)>`__ is a package
|
||
manager for the JavaScript programming language. The Yocto Project
|
||
supports the NPM `fetcher <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#bb-fetchers>`__. You can
|
||
use this fetcher in combination with
|
||
```devtool`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#ref-devtool-reference>`__ to create
|
||
recipes that produce NPM packages.
|
||
|
||
Two workflows exist that allow you to create NPM packages using
|
||
``devtool``: the NPM registry modules method and the NPM project code
|
||
method.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
While it is possible to create NPM recipes manually, using
|
||
devtool
|
||
is far simpler.
|
||
|
||
Additionally, some requirements and caveats exist.
|
||
|
||
.. _npm-package-creation-requirements:
|
||
|
||
Requirements and Caveats
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
You need to be aware of the following before using ``devtool`` to create
|
||
NPM packages:
|
||
|
||
- Of the two methods that you can use ``devtool`` to create NPM
|
||
packages, the registry approach is slightly simpler. However, you
|
||
might consider the project approach because you do not have to
|
||
publish your module in the NPM registry
|
||
(```npm-registry`` <https://docs.npmjs.com/misc/registry>`__), which
|
||
is NPM's public registry.
|
||
|
||
- Be familiar with
|
||
```devtool`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#ref-devtool-reference>`__.
|
||
|
||
- The NPM host tools need the native ``nodejs-npm`` package, which is
|
||
part of the OpenEmbedded environment. You need to get the package by
|
||
cloning the ` <https://github.com/openembedded/meta-openembedded>`__
|
||
repository out of GitHub. Be sure to add the path to your local copy
|
||
to your ``bblayers.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
- ``devtool`` cannot detect native libraries in module dependencies.
|
||
Consequently, you must manually add packages to your recipe.
|
||
|
||
- While deploying NPM packages, ``devtool`` cannot determine which
|
||
dependent packages are missing on the target (e.g. the node runtime
|
||
``nodejs``). Consequently, you need to find out what files are
|
||
missing and be sure they are on the target.
|
||
|
||
- Although you might not need NPM to run your node package, it is
|
||
useful to have NPM on your target. The NPM package name is
|
||
``nodejs-npm``.
|
||
|
||
.. _npm-using-the-registry-modules-method:
|
||
|
||
Using the Registry Modules Method
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
This section presents an example that uses the ``cute-files`` module,
|
||
which is a file browser web application.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You must know the
|
||
cute-files
|
||
module version.
|
||
|
||
The first thing you need to do is use ``devtool`` and the NPM fetcher to
|
||
create the recipe: $ devtool add
|
||
"npm://registry.npmjs.org;package=cute-files;version=1.0.2" The
|
||
``devtool add`` command runs ``recipetool create`` and uses the same
|
||
fetch URI to download each dependency and capture license details where
|
||
possible. The result is a generated recipe.
|
||
|
||
The recipe file is fairly simple and contains every license that
|
||
``recipetool`` finds and includes the licenses in the recipe's
|
||
:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
|
||
variables. You need to examine the variables and look for those with
|
||
"unknown" in the :term:`LICENSE`
|
||
field. You need to track down the license information for "unknown"
|
||
modules and manually add the information to the recipe.
|
||
|
||
``recipetool`` creates a "shrinkwrap" file for your recipe. Shrinkwrap
|
||
files capture the version of all dependent modules. Many packages do not
|
||
provide shrinkwrap files. ``recipetool`` create a shrinkwrap file as it
|
||
runs.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A package is created for each sub-module. This policy is the only
|
||
practical way to have the licenses for all of the dependencies
|
||
represented in the license manifest of the image.
|
||
|
||
The ``devtool edit-recipe`` command lets you take a look at the recipe:
|
||
$ devtool edit-recipe cute-files SUMMARY = "Turn any folder on your
|
||
computer into a cute file browser, available on the local network."
|
||
LICENSE = "MIT & ISC & Unknown" LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://LICENSE;md5=71d98c0a1db42956787b1909c74a86ca \\
|
||
file://node_modules/toidentifier/LICENSE;md5=1a261071a044d02eb6f2bb47f51a3502
|
||
\\
|
||
file://node_modules/debug/LICENSE;md5=ddd815a475e7338b0be7a14d8ee35a99
|
||
\\ ... SRC_URI = " \\
|
||
npm://registry.npmjs.org/;package=cute-files;version=${PV} \\
|
||
npmsw://${THISDIR}/${BPN}/npm-shrinkwrap.json \\ " S = "${WORKDIR}/npm"
|
||
inherit npm LICENSE_${PN} = "MIT" LICENSE_${PN}-accepts = "MIT"
|
||
LICENSE_${PN}-array-flatten = "MIT" ... LICENSE_${PN}-vary = "MIT" Three
|
||
key points exist in the previous example:
|
||
|
||
- :term:`SRC_URI` uses the NPM
|
||
scheme so that the NPM fetcher is used.
|
||
|
||
- ``recipetool`` collects all the license information. If a
|
||
sub-module's license is unavailable, the sub-module's name appears in
|
||
the comments.
|
||
|
||
- The ``inherit npm`` statement causes the
|
||
:ref:`npm <ref-classes-npm>` class to package
|
||
up all the modules.
|
||
|
||
You can run the following command to build the ``cute-files`` package: $
|
||
devtool build cute-files Remember that ``nodejs`` must be installed on
|
||
the target before your package.
|
||
|
||
Assuming 192.168.7.2 for the target's IP address, use the following
|
||
command to deploy your package: $ devtool deploy-target -s cute-files
|
||
root@192.168.7.2 Once the package is installed on the target, you can
|
||
test the application:
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Because of a know issue, you cannot simply run
|
||
cute-files
|
||
as you would if you had run
|
||
npm install
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
$ cd /usr/lib/node_modules/cute-files $ node cute-files.js On a browser,
|
||
go to ``http://192.168.7.2:3000`` and you see the following:
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/cute-files-npm-example.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
You can find the recipe in ``workspace/recipes/cute-files``. You can use
|
||
the recipe in any layer you choose.
|
||
|
||
.. _npm-using-the-npm-projects-method:
|
||
|
||
Using the NPM Projects Code Method
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Although it is useful to package modules already in the NPM registry,
|
||
adding ``node.js`` projects under development is a more common developer
|
||
use case.
|
||
|
||
This section covers the NPM projects code method, which is very similar
|
||
to the "registry" approach described in the previous section. In the NPM
|
||
projects method, you provide ``devtool`` with an URL that points to the
|
||
source files.
|
||
|
||
Replicating the same example, (i.e. ``cute-files``) use the following
|
||
command: $ devtool add https://github.com/martinaglv/cute-files.git The
|
||
recipe this command generates is very similar to the recipe created in
|
||
the previous section. However, the ``SRC_URI`` looks like the following:
|
||
SRC_URI = " \\ git://github.com/martinaglv/cute-files.git;protocol=https
|
||
\\ npmsw://${THISDIR}/${BPN}/npm-shrinkwrap.json \\ " In this example,
|
||
the main module is taken from the Git repository and dependents are
|
||
taken from the NPM registry. Other than those differences, the recipe is
|
||
basically the same between the two methods. You can build and deploy the
|
||
package exactly as described in the previous section that uses the
|
||
registry modules method.
|
||
|
||
Adding custom metadata to packages
|
||
----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The variable
|
||
:term:`PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA`
|
||
can be used to add additional metadata to packages. This is reflected in
|
||
the package control/spec file. To take the ipk format for example, the
|
||
CONTROL file stored inside would contain the additional metadata as
|
||
additional lines.
|
||
|
||
The variable can be used in multiple ways, including using suffixes to
|
||
set it for a specific package type and/or package. Note that the order
|
||
of precedence is the same as this list:
|
||
|
||
- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_<PKGTYPE>_<PN>``
|
||
|
||
- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_<PKGTYPE>``
|
||
|
||
- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_<PN>``
|
||
|
||
- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA``
|
||
|
||
<PKGTYPE> is a parameter and expected to be a distinct name of specific
|
||
package type:
|
||
|
||
- IPK for .ipk packages
|
||
|
||
- DEB for .deb packages
|
||
|
||
- RPM for .rpm packages
|
||
|
||
<PN> is a parameter and expected to be a package name.
|
||
|
||
The variable can contain multiple [one-line] metadata fields separated
|
||
by the literal sequence '\n'. The separator can be redefined using the
|
||
variable flag ``separator``.
|
||
|
||
The following is an example that adds two custom fields for ipk
|
||
packages: PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_IPK = "Vendor: CustomIpk\nGroup:
|
||
Applications/Spreadsheets"
|
||
|
||
Efficiently Fetching Source Files During a Build
|
||
================================================
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system works with source files located through
|
||
the :term:`SRC_URI` variable. When
|
||
you build something using BitBake, a big part of the operation is
|
||
locating and downloading all the source tarballs. For images,
|
||
downloading all the source for various packages can take a significant
|
||
amount of time.
|
||
|
||
This section shows you how you can use mirrors to speed up fetching
|
||
source files and how you can pre-fetch files all of which leads to more
|
||
efficient use of resources and time.
|
||
|
||
Setting up Effective Mirrors
|
||
----------------------------
|
||
|
||
A good deal that goes into a Yocto Project build is simply downloading
|
||
all of the source tarballs. Maybe you have been working with another
|
||
build system (OpenEmbedded or Angstrom) for which you have built up a
|
||
sizable directory of source tarballs. Or, perhaps someone else has such
|
||
a directory for which you have read access. If so, you can save time by
|
||
adding statements to your configuration file so that the build process
|
||
checks local directories first for existing tarballs before checking the
|
||
Internet.
|
||
|
||
Here is an efficient way to set it up in your ``local.conf`` file:
|
||
SOURCE_MIRROR_URL ?= "file:///home/you/your-download-dir/" INHERIT +=
|
||
"own-mirrors" BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1" # BB_NO_NETWORK = "1"
|
||
|
||
In the previous example, the
|
||
:term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS`
|
||
variable causes the OpenEmbedded build system to generate tarballs of
|
||
the Git repositories and store them in the
|
||
:term:`DL_DIR` directory. Due to
|
||
performance reasons, generating and storing these tarballs is not the
|
||
build system's default behavior.
|
||
|
||
You can also use the
|
||
:term:`PREMIRRORS` variable. For
|
||
an example, see the variable's glossary entry in the Yocto Project
|
||
Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
Getting Source Files and Suppressing the Build
|
||
----------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Another technique you can use to ready yourself for a successive string
|
||
of build operations, is to pre-fetch all the source files without
|
||
actually starting a build. This technique lets you work through any
|
||
download issues and ultimately gathers all the source files into your
|
||
download directory
|
||
```build/downloads`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#structure-build-downloads>`__,
|
||
which is located with :term:`DL_DIR`.
|
||
|
||
Use the following BitBake command form to fetch all the necessary
|
||
sources without starting the build: $ bitbake target --runall=fetch This
|
||
variation of the BitBake command guarantees that you have all the
|
||
sources for that BitBake target should you disconnect from the Internet
|
||
and want to do the build later offline.
|
||
|
||
Selecting an Initialization Manager
|
||
===================================
|
||
|
||
By default, the Yocto Project uses SysVinit as the initialization
|
||
manager. However, support also exists for systemd, which is a full
|
||
replacement for init with parallel starting of services, reduced shell
|
||
overhead and other features that are used by many distributions.
|
||
|
||
Within the system, SysVinit treats system components as services. These
|
||
services are maintained as shell scripts stored in the ``/etc/init.d/``
|
||
directory. Services organize into different run levels. This
|
||
organization is maintained by putting links to the services in the
|
||
``/etc/rcN.d/`` directories, where N/ is one of the following options:
|
||
"S", "0", "1", "2", "3", "4", "5", or "6".
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Each runlevel has a dependency on the previous runlevel. This
|
||
dependency allows the services to work properly.
|
||
|
||
In comparison, systemd treats components as units. Using units is a
|
||
broader concept as compared to using a service. A unit includes several
|
||
different types of entities. Service is one of the types of entities.
|
||
The runlevel concept in SysVinit corresponds to the concept of a target
|
||
in systemd, where target is also a type of supported unit.
|
||
|
||
In a SysVinit-based system, services load sequentially (i.e. one by one)
|
||
during and parallelization is not supported. With systemd, services
|
||
start in parallel. Needless to say, the method can have an impact on
|
||
system startup performance.
|
||
|
||
If you want to use SysVinit, you do not have to do anything. But, if you
|
||
want to use systemd, you must take some steps as described in the
|
||
following sections.
|
||
|
||
Using systemd Exclusively
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
Set these variables in your distribution configuration file as follows:
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_append = " systemd" VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager =
|
||
"systemd" You can also prevent the SysVinit distribution feature from
|
||
being automatically enabled as follows:
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "sysvinit" Doing so removes any
|
||
redundant SysVinit scripts.
|
||
|
||
To remove initscripts from your image altogether, set this variable
|
||
also: VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_initscripts = ""
|
||
|
||
For information on the backfill variable, see
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
|
||
|
||
Using systemd for the Main Image and Using SysVinit for the Rescue Image
|
||
------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Set these variables in your distribution configuration file as follows:
|
||
DISTRO_FEATURES_append = " systemd" VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager =
|
||
"systemd" Doing so causes your main image to use the
|
||
``packagegroup-core-boot.bb`` recipe and systemd. The rescue/minimal
|
||
image cannot use this package group. However, it can install SysVinit
|
||
and the appropriate packages will have support for both systemd and
|
||
SysVinit.
|
||
|
||
.. _selecting-dev-manager:
|
||
|
||
Selecting a Device Manager
|
||
==========================
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides multiple ways to manage the device manager
|
||
(``/dev``):
|
||
|
||
- *Persistent and Pre-Populated\ ``/dev``:* For this case, the ``/dev``
|
||
directory is persistent and the required device nodes are created
|
||
during the build.
|
||
|
||
- *Use ``devtmpfs`` with a Device Manager:* For this case, the ``/dev``
|
||
directory is provided by the kernel as an in-memory file system and
|
||
is automatically populated by the kernel at runtime. Additional
|
||
configuration of device nodes is done in user space by a device
|
||
manager like ``udev`` or ``busybox-mdev``.
|
||
|
||
.. _static-dev-management:
|
||
|
||
Using Persistent and Pre-Populated\ ``/dev``
|
||
--------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
To use the static method for device population, you need to set the
|
||
:term:`USE_DEVFS` variable to "0"
|
||
as follows: USE_DEVFS = "0"
|
||
|
||
The content of the resulting ``/dev`` directory is defined in a Device
|
||
Table file. The
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES`
|
||
variable defines the Device Table to use and should be set in the
|
||
machine or distro configuration file. Alternatively, you can set this
|
||
variable in your ``local.conf`` configuration file.
|
||
|
||
If you do not define the ``IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES`` variable, the default
|
||
``device_table-minimal.txt`` is used: IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES =
|
||
"device_table-mymachine.txt"
|
||
|
||
The population is handled by the ``makedevs`` utility during image
|
||
creation:
|
||
|
||
.. _devtmpfs-dev-management:
|
||
|
||
Using ``devtmpfs`` and a Device Manager
|
||
---------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
To use the dynamic method for device population, you need to use (or be
|
||
sure to set) the :term:`USE_DEVFS`
|
||
variable to "1", which is the default: USE_DEVFS = "1" With this
|
||
setting, the resulting ``/dev`` directory is populated by the kernel
|
||
using ``devtmpfs``. Make sure the corresponding kernel configuration
|
||
variable ``CONFIG_DEVTMPFS`` is set when building you build a Linux
|
||
kernel.
|
||
|
||
All devices created by ``devtmpfs`` will be owned by ``root`` and have
|
||
permissions ``0600``.
|
||
|
||
To have more control over the device nodes, you can use a device manager
|
||
like ``udev`` or ``busybox-mdev``. You choose the device manager by
|
||
defining the ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager`` variable in your machine or
|
||
distro configuration file. Alternatively, you can set this variable in
|
||
your ``local.conf`` configuration file: VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager =
|
||
"udev" # Some alternative values # VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager =
|
||
"busybox-mdev" # VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "systemd"
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-appdev-srcrev:
|
||
|
||
Using an External SCM
|
||
=====================
|
||
|
||
If you're working on a recipe that pulls from an external Source Code
|
||
Manager (SCM), it is possible to have the OpenEmbedded build system
|
||
notice new recipe changes added to the SCM and then build the resulting
|
||
packages that depend on the new recipes by using the latest versions.
|
||
This only works for SCMs from which it is possible to get a sensible
|
||
revision number for changes. Currently, you can do this with Apache
|
||
Subversion (SVN), Git, and Bazaar (BZR) repositories.
|
||
|
||
To enable this behavior, the :term:`PV` of
|
||
the recipe needs to reference
|
||
:term:`SRCPV`. Here is an example: PV =
|
||
"1.2.3+git${SRCPV}" Then, you can add the following to your
|
||
``local.conf``: SRCREV_pn-PN = "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
:term:`PN` is the name of the recipe for
|
||
which you want to enable automatic source revision updating.
|
||
|
||
If you do not want to update your local configuration file, you can add
|
||
the following directly to the recipe to finish enabling the feature:
|
||
SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides a distribution named ``poky-bleeding``, whose
|
||
configuration file contains the line: require
|
||
conf/distro/include/poky-floating-revisions.inc This line pulls in the
|
||
listed include file that contains numerous lines of exactly that form:
|
||
#SRCREV_pn-opkg-native ?= "${AUTOREV}" #SRCREV_pn-opkg-sdk ?=
|
||
"${AUTOREV}" #SRCREV_pn-opkg ?= "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
#SRCREV_pn-opkg-utils-native ?= "${AUTOREV}" #SRCREV_pn-opkg-utils ?=
|
||
"${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-gconf-dbus ?= "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
SRCREV_pn-matchbox-common ?= "${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-matchbox-config-gtk
|
||
?= "${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-matchbox-desktop ?= "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
SRCREV_pn-matchbox-keyboard ?= "${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-matchbox-panel-2
|
||
?= "${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-matchbox-themes-extra ?= "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
SRCREV_pn-matchbox-terminal ?= "${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-matchbox-wm ?=
|
||
"${AUTOREV}" SRCREV_pn-settings-daemon ?= "${AUTOREV}"
|
||
SRCREV_pn-screenshot ?= "${AUTOREV}" . . . These lines allow you to
|
||
experiment with building a distribution that tracks the latest
|
||
development source for numerous packages.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The
|
||
poky-bleeding
|
||
distribution is not tested on a regular basis. Keep this in mind if
|
||
you use it.
|
||
|
||
Creating a Read-Only Root Filesystem
|
||
====================================
|
||
|
||
Suppose, for security reasons, you need to disable your target device's
|
||
root filesystem's write permissions (i.e. you need a read-only root
|
||
filesystem). Or, perhaps you are running the device's operating system
|
||
from a read-only storage device. For either case, you can customize your
|
||
image for that behavior.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Supporting a read-only root filesystem requires that the system and
|
||
applications do not try to write to the root filesystem. You must
|
||
configure all parts of the target system to write elsewhere, or to
|
||
gracefully fail in the event of attempting to write to the root
|
||
filesystem.
|
||
|
||
Creating the Root Filesystem
|
||
----------------------------
|
||
|
||
To create the read-only root filesystem, simply add the
|
||
"read-only-rootfs" feature to your image, normally in one of two ways.
|
||
The first way is to add the "read-only-rootfs" image feature in the
|
||
image's recipe file via the ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` variable: IMAGE_FEATURES
|
||
+= "read-only-rootfs" As an alternative, you can add the same feature
|
||
from within your build directory's ``local.conf`` file with the
|
||
associated ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` variable, as in:
|
||
EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES = "read-only-rootfs"
|
||
|
||
For more information on how to use these variables, see the
|
||
"`Customizing Images Using Custom ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and
|
||
``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` <#usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures>`__"
|
||
section. For information on the variables, see
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and
|
||
:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`.
|
||
|
||
Post-Installation Scripts
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
It is very important that you make sure all post-Installation
|
||
(``pkg_postinst``) scripts for packages that are installed into the
|
||
image can be run at the time when the root filesystem is created during
|
||
the build on the host system. These scripts cannot attempt to run during
|
||
first-boot on the target device. With the "read-only-rootfs" feature
|
||
enabled, the build system checks during root filesystem creation to make
|
||
sure all post-installation scripts succeed. If any of these scripts
|
||
still need to be run after the root filesystem is created, the build
|
||
immediately fails. These build-time checks ensure that the build fails
|
||
rather than the target device fails later during its initial boot
|
||
operation.
|
||
|
||
Most of the common post-installation scripts generated by the build
|
||
system for the out-of-the-box Yocto Project are engineered so that they
|
||
can run during root filesystem creation (e.g. post-installation scripts
|
||
for caching fonts). However, if you create and add custom scripts, you
|
||
need to be sure they can be run during this file system creation.
|
||
|
||
Here are some common problems that prevent post-installation scripts
|
||
from running during root filesystem creation:
|
||
|
||
- *Not using $D in front of absolute paths:* The build system defines
|
||
``$``\ :term:`D` when the root
|
||
filesystem is created. Furthermore, ``$D`` is blank when the script
|
||
is run on the target device. This implies two purposes for ``$D``:
|
||
ensuring paths are valid in both the host and target environments,
|
||
and checking to determine which environment is being used as a method
|
||
for taking appropriate actions.
|
||
|
||
- *Attempting to run processes that are specific to or dependent on the
|
||
target architecture:* You can work around these attempts by using
|
||
native tools, which run on the host system, to accomplish the same
|
||
tasks, or by alternatively running the processes under QEMU, which
|
||
has the ``qemu_run_binary`` function. For more information, see the
|
||
:ref:`qemu <ref-classes-qemu>` class.
|
||
|
||
Areas With Write Access
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
With the "read-only-rootfs" feature enabled, any attempt by the target
|
||
to write to the root filesystem at runtime fails. Consequently, you must
|
||
make sure that you configure processes and applications that attempt
|
||
these types of writes do so to directories with write access (e.g.
|
||
``/tmp`` or ``/var/run``).
|
||
|
||
Maintaining Build Output Quality
|
||
================================
|
||
|
||
Many factors can influence the quality of a build. For example, if you
|
||
upgrade a recipe to use a new version of an upstream software package or
|
||
you experiment with some new configuration options, subtle changes can
|
||
occur that you might not detect until later. Consider the case where
|
||
your recipe is using a newer version of an upstream package. In this
|
||
case, a new version of a piece of software might introduce an optional
|
||
dependency on another library, which is auto-detected. If that library
|
||
has already been built when the software is building, the software will
|
||
link to the built library and that library will be pulled into your
|
||
image along with the new software even if you did not want the library.
|
||
|
||
The :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
|
||
class exists to help you maintain the quality of your build output. You
|
||
can use the class to highlight unexpected and possibly unwanted changes
|
||
in the build output. When you enable build history, it records
|
||
information about the contents of each package and image and then
|
||
commits that information to a local Git repository where you can examine
|
||
the information.
|
||
|
||
The remainder of this section describes the following:
|
||
|
||
- How you can enable and disable build history
|
||
|
||
- How to understand what the build history contains
|
||
|
||
- How to limit the information used for build history
|
||
|
||
- How to examine the build history from both a command-line and web
|
||
interface
|
||
|
||
Enabling and Disabling Build History
|
||
------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Build history is disabled by default. To enable it, add the following
|
||
``INHERIT`` statement and set the
|
||
:term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT`
|
||
variable to "1" at the end of your ``conf/local.conf`` file found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`: INHERIT +=
|
||
"buildhistory" BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1" Enabling build history as
|
||
previously described causes the OpenEmbedded build system to collect
|
||
build output information and commit it as a single commit to a local
|
||
`Git <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#git>`__ repository.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Enabling build history increases your build times slightly,
|
||
particularly for images, and increases the amount of disk space used
|
||
during the build.
|
||
|
||
You can disable build history by removing the previous statements from
|
||
your ``conf/local.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
Understanding What the Build History Contains
|
||
---------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Build history information is kept in
|
||
``${``\ :term:`TOPDIR`\ ``}/buildhistory``
|
||
in the Build Directory as defined by the
|
||
:term:`BUILDHISTORY_DIR`
|
||
variable. The following is an example abbreviated listing:
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/buildhistory.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
At the top level, a ``metadata-revs`` file exists that lists the
|
||
revisions of the repositories for the enabled layers when the build was
|
||
produced. The rest of the data splits into separate ``packages``,
|
||
``images`` and ``sdk`` directories, the contents of which are described
|
||
as follows.
|
||
|
||
Build History Package Information
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The history for each package contains a text file that has name-value
|
||
pairs with information about the package. For example,
|
||
``buildhistory/packages/i586-poky-linux/busybox/busybox/latest``
|
||
contains the following: PV = 1.22.1 PR = r32 RPROVIDES = RDEPENDS =
|
||
glibc (>= 2.20) update-alternatives-opkg RRECOMMENDS = busybox-syslog
|
||
busybox-udhcpc update-rc.d PKGSIZE = 540168 FILES = /usr/bin/\*
|
||
/usr/sbin/\* /usr/lib/busybox/\* /usr/lib/lib*.so.\* \\ /etc /com /var
|
||
/bin/\* /sbin/\* /lib/*.so.\* /lib/udev/rules.d \\ /usr/lib/udev/rules.d
|
||
/usr/share/busybox /usr/lib/busybox/\* \\ /usr/share/pixmaps
|
||
/usr/share/applications /usr/share/idl \\ /usr/share/omf
|
||
/usr/share/sounds /usr/lib/bonobo/servers FILELIST = /bin/busybox
|
||
/bin/busybox.nosuid /bin/busybox.suid /bin/sh \\
|
||
/etc/busybox.links.nosuid /etc/busybox.links.suid Most of these
|
||
name-value pairs correspond to variables used to produce the package.
|
||
The exceptions are ``FILELIST``, which is the actual list of files in
|
||
the package, and ``PKGSIZE``, which is the total size of files in the
|
||
package in bytes.
|
||
|
||
A file also exists that corresponds to the recipe from which the package
|
||
came (e.g. ``buildhistory/packages/i586-poky-linux/busybox/latest``): PV
|
||
= 1.22.1 PR = r32 DEPENDS = initscripts kern-tools-native
|
||
update-rc.d-native \\ virtual/i586-poky-linux-compilerlibs
|
||
virtual/i586-poky-linux-gcc \\ virtual/libc virtual/update-alternatives
|
||
PACKAGES = busybox-ptest busybox-httpd busybox-udhcpd busybox-udhcpc \\
|
||
busybox-syslog busybox-mdev busybox-hwclock busybox-dbg \\
|
||
busybox-staticdev busybox-dev busybox-doc busybox-locale busybox
|
||
|
||
Finally, for those recipes fetched from a version control system (e.g.,
|
||
Git), a file exists that lists source revisions that are specified in
|
||
the recipe and lists the actual revisions used during the build. Listed
|
||
and actual revisions might differ when
|
||
:term:`SRCREV` is set to
|
||
${:term:`AUTOREV`}. Here is an
|
||
example assuming
|
||
``buildhistory/packages/qemux86-poky-linux/linux-yocto/latest_srcrev``):
|
||
# SRCREV_machine = "38cd560d5022ed2dbd1ab0dca9642e47c98a0aa1"
|
||
SRCREV_machine = "38cd560d5022ed2dbd1ab0dca9642e47c98a0aa1" #
|
||
SRCREV_meta = "a227f20eff056e511d504b2e490f3774ab260d6f" SRCREV_meta =
|
||
"a227f20eff056e511d504b2e490f3774ab260d6f" You can use the
|
||
``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs`` command with the ``-a`` option to
|
||
collect the stored ``SRCREV`` values from build history and report them
|
||
in a format suitable for use in global configuration (e.g.,
|
||
``local.conf`` or a distro include file) to override floating
|
||
``AUTOREV`` values to a fixed set of revisions. Here is some example
|
||
output from this command: $ buildhistory-collect-srcrevs -a #
|
||
i586-poky-linux SRCREV_pn-glibc =
|
||
"b8079dd0d360648e4e8de48656c5c38972621072" SRCREV_pn-glibc-initial =
|
||
"b8079dd0d360648e4e8de48656c5c38972621072" SRCREV_pn-opkg-utils =
|
||
"53274f087565fd45d8452c5367997ba6a682a37a" SRCREV_pn-kmod =
|
||
"fd56638aed3fe147015bfa10ed4a5f7491303cb4" # x86_64-linux
|
||
SRCREV_pn-gtk-doc-stub-native =
|
||
"1dea266593edb766d6d898c79451ef193eb17cfa" SRCREV_pn-dtc-native =
|
||
"65cc4d2748a2c2e6f27f1cf39e07a5dbabd80ebf" SRCREV_pn-update-rc.d-native
|
||
= "eca680ddf28d024954895f59a241a622dd575c11"
|
||
SRCREV_glibc_pn-cross-localedef-native =
|
||
"b8079dd0d360648e4e8de48656c5c38972621072"
|
||
SRCREV_localedef_pn-cross-localedef-native =
|
||
"c833367348d39dad7ba018990bfdaffaec8e9ed3" SRCREV_pn-prelink-native =
|
||
"faa069deec99bf61418d0bab831c83d7c1b797ca" SRCREV_pn-opkg-utils-native =
|
||
"53274f087565fd45d8452c5367997ba6a682a37a" SRCREV_pn-kern-tools-native =
|
||
"23345b8846fe4bd167efdf1bd8a1224b2ba9a5ff" SRCREV_pn-kmod-native =
|
||
"fd56638aed3fe147015bfa10ed4a5f7491303cb4" # qemux86-poky-linux
|
||
SRCREV_machine_pn-linux-yocto =
|
||
"38cd560d5022ed2dbd1ab0dca9642e47c98a0aa1" SRCREV_meta_pn-linux-yocto =
|
||
"a227f20eff056e511d504b2e490f3774ab260d6f" # all-poky-linux
|
||
SRCREV_pn-update-rc.d = "eca680ddf28d024954895f59a241a622dd575c11"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Here are some notes on using the
|
||
buildhistory-collect-srcrevs
|
||
command:
|
||
|
||
- By default, only values where the ``SRCREV`` was not hardcoded
|
||
(usually when ``AUTOREV`` is used) are reported. Use the ``-a``
|
||
option to see all ``SRCREV`` values.
|
||
|
||
- The output statements might not have any effect if overrides are
|
||
applied elsewhere in the build system configuration. Use the
|
||
``-f`` option to add the ``forcevariable`` override to each output
|
||
line if you need to work around this restriction.
|
||
|
||
- The script does apply special handling when building for multiple
|
||
machines. However, the script does place a comment before each set
|
||
of values that specifies which triplet to which they belong as
|
||
previously shown (e.g., ``i586-poky-linux``).
|
||
|
||
Build History Image Information
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The files produced for each image are as follows:
|
||
|
||
- ``image-files:`` A directory containing selected files from the root
|
||
filesystem. The files are defined by
|
||
:term:`BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES`.
|
||
|
||
- ``build-id.txt:`` Human-readable information about the build
|
||
configuration and metadata source revisions. This file contains the
|
||
full build header as printed by BitBake.
|
||
|
||
- ``*.dot:`` Dependency graphs for the image that are compatible with
|
||
``graphviz``.
|
||
|
||
- ``files-in-image.txt:`` A list of files in the image with
|
||
permissions, owner, group, size, and symlink information.
|
||
|
||
- ``image-info.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs with
|
||
information about the image. See the following listing example for
|
||
more information.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-package-names.txt:`` A list of installed packages by name
|
||
only.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-package-sizes.txt:`` A list of installed packages ordered
|
||
by size.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-packages.txt:`` A list of installed packages with full
|
||
package filenames.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Installed package information is able to be gathered and produced
|
||
even if package management is disabled for the final image.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example of ``image-info.txt``: DISTRO = poky DISTRO_VERSION =
|
||
1.7 USER_CLASSES = buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink IMAGE_CLASSES =
|
||
image_types IMAGE_FEATURES = debug-tweaks IMAGE_LINGUAS = IMAGE_INSTALL
|
||
= packagegroup-core-boot run-postinsts BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS =
|
||
NO_RECOMMENDATIONS = PACKAGE_EXCLUDE = ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND =
|
||
write_package_manifest; license_create_manifest; \\ write_image_manifest
|
||
; buildhistory_list_installed_image ; \\
|
||
buildhistory_get_image_installed ; ssh_allow_empty_password; \\
|
||
postinst_enable_logging; rootfs_update_timestamp ;
|
||
ssh_disable_dns_lookup ; IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND =
|
||
buildhistory_get_imageinfo ; IMAGESIZE = 6900 Other than ``IMAGESIZE``,
|
||
which is the total size of the files in the image in Kbytes, the
|
||
name-value pairs are variables that may have influenced the content of
|
||
the image. This information is often useful when you are trying to
|
||
determine why a change in the package or file listings has occurred.
|
||
|
||
Using Build History to Gather Image Information Only
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
As you can see, build history produces image information, including
|
||
dependency graphs, so you can see why something was pulled into the
|
||
image. If you are just interested in this information and not interested
|
||
in collecting specific package or SDK information, you can enable
|
||
writing only image information without any history by adding the
|
||
following to your ``conf/local.conf`` file found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`: INHERIT +=
|
||
"buildhistory" BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "0" BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES = "image"
|
||
Here, you set the
|
||
:term:`BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES`
|
||
variable to use the image feature only.
|
||
|
||
Build History SDK Information
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Build history collects similar information on the contents of SDKs (e.g.
|
||
``bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename``) as compared to information it
|
||
collects for images. Furthermore, this information differs depending on
|
||
whether an extensible or standard SDK is being produced.
|
||
|
||
The following list shows the files produced for SDKs:
|
||
|
||
- ``files-in-sdk.txt:`` A list of files in the SDK with permissions,
|
||
owner, group, size, and symlink information. This list includes both
|
||
the host and target parts of the SDK.
|
||
|
||
- ``sdk-info.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs with
|
||
information about the SDK. See the following listing example for more
|
||
information.
|
||
|
||
- ``sstate-task-sizes.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs
|
||
with information about task group sizes (e.g. ``do_populate_sysroot``
|
||
tasks have a total size). The ``sstate-task-sizes.txt`` file exists
|
||
only when an extensible SDK is created.
|
||
|
||
- ``sstate-package-sizes.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs
|
||
with information for the shared-state packages and sizes in the SDK.
|
||
The ``sstate-package-sizes.txt`` file exists only when an extensible
|
||
SDK is created.
|
||
|
||
- ``sdk-files:`` A folder that contains copies of the files mentioned
|
||
in ``BUILDHISTORY_SDK_FILES`` if the files are present in the output.
|
||
Additionally, the default value of ``BUILDHISTORY_SDK_FILES`` is
|
||
specific to the extensible SDK although you can set it differently if
|
||
you would like to pull in specific files from the standard SDK.
|
||
|
||
The default files are ``conf/local.conf``, ``conf/bblayers.conf``,
|
||
``conf/auto.conf``, ``conf/locked-sigs.inc``, and
|
||
``conf/devtool.conf``. Thus, for an extensible SDK, these files get
|
||
copied into the ``sdk-files`` directory.
|
||
|
||
- The following information appears under each of the ``host`` and
|
||
``target`` directories for the portions of the SDK that run on the
|
||
host and on the target, respectively:
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The following files for the most part are empty when producing an
|
||
extensible SDK because this type of SDK is not constructed from
|
||
packages as is the standard SDK.
|
||
|
||
- ``depends.dot:`` Dependency graph for the SDK that is compatible
|
||
with ``graphviz``.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-package-names.txt:`` A list of installed packages by
|
||
name only.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-package-sizes.txt:`` A list of installed packages
|
||
ordered by size.
|
||
|
||
- ``installed-packages.txt:`` A list of installed packages with full
|
||
package filenames.
|
||
|
||
Here is an example of ``sdk-info.txt``: DISTRO = poky DISTRO_VERSION =
|
||
1.3+snapshot-20130327 SDK_NAME = poky-glibc-i686-arm SDK_VERSION =
|
||
1.3+snapshot SDKMACHINE = SDKIMAGE_FEATURES = dev-pkgs dbg-pkgs
|
||
BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS = SDKSIZE = 352712 Other than ``SDKSIZE``, which is
|
||
the total size of the files in the SDK in Kbytes, the name-value pairs
|
||
are variables that might have influenced the content of the SDK. This
|
||
information is often useful when you are trying to determine why a
|
||
change in the package or file listings has occurred.
|
||
|
||
Examining Build History Information
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
You can examine build history output from the command line or from a web
|
||
interface.
|
||
|
||
To see any changes that have occurred (assuming you have
|
||
:term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT`\ `` = "1"``),
|
||
you can simply use any Git command that allows you to view the history
|
||
of a repository. Here is one method: $ git log -p You need to realize,
|
||
however, that this method does show changes that are not significant
|
||
(e.g. a package's size changing by a few bytes).
|
||
|
||
A command-line tool called ``buildhistory-diff`` does exist, though,
|
||
that queries the Git repository and prints just the differences that
|
||
might be significant in human-readable form. Here is an example: $
|
||
~/poky/poky/scripts/buildhistory-diff . HEAD^ Changes to
|
||
images/qemux86_64/glibc/core-image-minimal (files-in-image.txt):
|
||
/etc/anotherpkg.conf was added /sbin/anotherpkg was added \*
|
||
(installed-package-names.txt): \* anotherpkg was added Changes to
|
||
images/qemux86_64/glibc/core-image-minimal
|
||
(installed-package-names.txt): anotherpkg was added
|
||
packages/qemux86_64-poky-linux/v86d: PACKAGES: added "v86d-extras" \* PR
|
||
changed from "r0" to "r1" \* PV changed from "0.1.10" to "0.1.12"
|
||
packages/qemux86_64-poky-linux/v86d/v86d: PKGSIZE changed from 110579 to
|
||
144381 (+30%) \* PR changed from "r0" to "r1" \* PV changed from
|
||
"0.1.10" to "0.1.12"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The
|
||
buildhistory-diff
|
||
tool requires the
|
||
GitPython
|
||
package. Be sure to install it using Pip3 as follows:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
$ pip3 install GitPython --user
|
||
|
||
|
||
Alternatively, you can install
|
||
python3-git
|
||
using the appropriate distribution package manager (e.g.
|
||
apt-get
|
||
,
|
||
dnf
|
||
, or
|
||
zipper
|
||
).
|
||
|
||
To see changes to the build history using a web interface, follow the
|
||
instruction in the ``README`` file here.
|
||
` <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/buildhistory-web/>`__.
|
||
|
||
Here is a sample screenshot of the interface:
|
||
|
||
.. image:: figures/buildhistory-web.png
|
||
:align: center
|
||
|
||
Performing Automated Runtime Testing
|
||
====================================
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system makes available a series of automated
|
||
tests for images to verify runtime functionality. You can run these
|
||
tests on either QEMU or actual target hardware. Tests are written in
|
||
Python making use of the ``unittest`` module, and the majority of them
|
||
run commands on the target system over SSH. This section describes how
|
||
you set up the environment to use these tests, run available tests, and
|
||
write and add your own tests.
|
||
|
||
For information on the test and QA infrastructure available within the
|
||
Yocto Project, see the "`Testing and Quality
|
||
Assurance <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#testing-and-quality-assurance>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
Enabling Tests
|
||
--------------
|
||
|
||
Depending on whether you are planning to run tests using QEMU or on the
|
||
hardware, you have to take different steps to enable the tests. See the
|
||
following subsections for information on how to enable both types of
|
||
tests.
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-enabling-tests:
|
||
|
||
Enabling Runtime Tests on QEMU
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
In order to run tests, you need to do the following:
|
||
|
||
- *Set up to avoid interaction with ``sudo`` for networking:* To
|
||
accomplish this, you must do one of the following:
|
||
|
||
- Add ``NOPASSWD`` for your user in ``/etc/sudoers`` either for all
|
||
commands or just for ``runqemu-ifup``. You must provide the full
|
||
path as that can change if you are using multiple clones of the
|
||
source repository.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
On some distributions, you also need to comment out "Defaults
|
||
requiretty" in
|
||
/etc/sudoers
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
- Manually configure a tap interface for your system.
|
||
|
||
- Run as root the script in ``scripts/runqemu-gen-tapdevs``, which
|
||
should generate a list of tap devices. This is the option
|
||
typically chosen for Autobuilder-type environments.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- Be sure to use an absolute path when calling this script
|
||
with sudo.
|
||
|
||
- The package recipe ``qemu-helper-native`` is required to run
|
||
this script. Build the package using the following command:
|
||
$ bitbake qemu-helper-native
|
||
|
||
- *Set the ``DISPLAY`` variable:* You need to set this variable so that
|
||
you have an X server available (e.g. start ``vncserver`` for a
|
||
headless machine).
|
||
|
||
- *Be sure your host's firewall accepts incoming connections from
|
||
192.168.7.0/24:* Some of the tests (in particular DNF tests) start an
|
||
HTTP server on a random high number port, which is used to serve
|
||
files to the target. The DNF module serves
|
||
``${WORKDIR}/oe-rootfs-repo`` so it can run DNF channel commands.
|
||
That means your host's firewall must accept incoming connections from
|
||
192.168.7.0/24, which is the default IP range used for tap devices by
|
||
``runqemu``.
|
||
|
||
- *Be sure your host has the correct packages installed:* Depending
|
||
your host's distribution, you need to have the following packages
|
||
installed:
|
||
|
||
- Ubuntu and Debian: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute2``
|
||
|
||
- OpenSUSE: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute2``
|
||
|
||
- Fedora: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute``
|
||
|
||
- CentOS: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute``
|
||
|
||
Once you start running the tests, the following happens:
|
||
|
||
1. A copy of the root filesystem is written to ``${WORKDIR}/testimage``.
|
||
|
||
2. The image is booted under QEMU using the standard ``runqemu`` script.
|
||
|
||
3. A default timeout of 500 seconds occurs to allow for the boot process
|
||
to reach the login prompt. You can change the timeout period by
|
||
setting
|
||
:term:`TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT`
|
||
in the ``local.conf`` file.
|
||
|
||
4. Once the boot process is reached and the login prompt appears, the
|
||
tests run. The full boot log is written to
|
||
``${WORKDIR}/testimage/qemu_boot_log``.
|
||
|
||
5. Each test module loads in the order found in ``TEST_SUITES``. You can
|
||
find the full output of the commands run over SSH in
|
||
``${WORKDIR}/testimgage/ssh_target_log``.
|
||
|
||
6. If no failures occur, the task running the tests ends successfully.
|
||
You can find the output from the ``unittest`` in the task log at
|
||
``${WORKDIR}/temp/log.do_testimage``.
|
||
|
||
.. _hardware-image-enabling-tests:
|
||
|
||
Enabling Runtime Tests on Hardware
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system can run tests on real hardware, and for
|
||
certain devices it can also deploy the image to be tested onto the
|
||
device beforehand.
|
||
|
||
For automated deployment, a "master image" is installed onto the
|
||
hardware once as part of setup. Then, each time tests are to be run, the
|
||
following occurs:
|
||
|
||
1. The master image is booted into and used to write the image to be
|
||
tested to a second partition.
|
||
|
||
2. The device is then rebooted using an external script that you need to
|
||
provide.
|
||
|
||
3. The device boots into the image to be tested.
|
||
|
||
When running tests (independent of whether the image has been deployed
|
||
automatically or not), the device is expected to be connected to a
|
||
network on a pre-determined IP address. You can either use static IP
|
||
addresses written into the image, or set the image to use DHCP and have
|
||
your DHCP server on the test network assign a known IP address based on
|
||
the MAC address of the device.
|
||
|
||
In order to run tests on hardware, you need to set ``TEST_TARGET`` to an
|
||
appropriate value. For QEMU, you do not have to change anything, the
|
||
default value is "qemu". For running tests on hardware, the following
|
||
options exist:
|
||
|
||
- *"simpleremote":* Choose "simpleremote" if you are going to run tests
|
||
on a target system that is already running the image to be tested and
|
||
is available on the network. You can use "simpleremote" in
|
||
conjunction with either real hardware or an image running within a
|
||
separately started QEMU or any other virtual machine manager.
|
||
|
||
- *"SystemdbootTarget":* Choose "SystemdbootTarget" if your hardware is
|
||
an EFI-based machine with ``systemd-boot`` as bootloader and
|
||
``core-image-testmaster`` (or something similar) is installed. Also,
|
||
your hardware under test must be in a DHCP-enabled network that gives
|
||
it the same IP address for each reboot.
|
||
|
||
If you choose "SystemdbootTarget", there are additional requirements
|
||
and considerations. See the "`Selecting
|
||
SystemdbootTarget <#selecting-systemdboottarget>`__" section, which
|
||
follows, for more information.
|
||
|
||
- *"BeagleBoneTarget":* Choose "BeagleBoneTarget" if you are deploying
|
||
images and running tests on the BeagleBone "Black" or original
|
||
"White" hardware. For information on how to use these tests, see the
|
||
comments at the top of the BeagleBoneTarget
|
||
``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/beaglebonetarget.py`` file.
|
||
|
||
- *"EdgeRouterTarget":* Choose "EdgeRouterTarget" is you are deploying
|
||
images and running tests on the Ubiquiti Networks EdgeRouter Lite.
|
||
For information on how to use these tests, see the comments at the
|
||
top of the EdgeRouterTarget
|
||
``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/edgeroutertarget.py`` file.
|
||
|
||
- *"GrubTarget":* Choose the "supports deploying images and running
|
||
tests on any generic PC that boots using GRUB. For information on how
|
||
to use these tests, see the comments at the top of the GrubTarget
|
||
``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/grubtarget.py`` file.
|
||
|
||
- *"your-target":* Create your own custom target if you want to run
|
||
tests when you are deploying images and running tests on a custom
|
||
machine within your BSP layer. To do this, you need to add a Python
|
||
unit that defines the target class under ``lib/oeqa/controllers/``
|
||
within your layer. You must also provide an empty ``__init__.py``.
|
||
For examples, see files in ``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/``.
|
||
|
||
Selecting SystemdbootTarget
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
If you did not set ``TEST_TARGET`` to "SystemdbootTarget", then you do
|
||
not need any information in this section. You can skip down to the
|
||
"`Running Tests <#qemu-image-running-tests>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
If you did set ``TEST_TARGET`` to "SystemdbootTarget", you also need to
|
||
perform a one-time setup of your master image by doing the following:
|
||
|
||
1. *Set ``EFI_PROVIDER``:* Be sure that ``EFI_PROVIDER`` is as follows:
|
||
EFI_PROVIDER = "systemd-boot"
|
||
|
||
2. *Build the master image:* Build the ``core-image-testmaster`` image.
|
||
The ``core-image-testmaster`` recipe is provided as an example for a
|
||
"master" image and you can customize the image recipe as you would
|
||
any other recipe.
|
||
|
||
Here are the image recipe requirements:
|
||
|
||
- Inherits ``core-image`` so that kernel modules are installed.
|
||
|
||
- Installs normal linux utilities not busybox ones (e.g. ``bash``,
|
||
``coreutils``, ``tar``, ``gzip``, and ``kmod``).
|
||
|
||
- Uses a custom Initial RAM Disk (initramfs) image with a custom
|
||
installer. A normal image that you can install usually creates a
|
||
single rootfs partition. This image uses another installer that
|
||
creates a specific partition layout. Not all Board Support
|
||
Packages (BSPs) can use an installer. For such cases, you need to
|
||
manually create the following partition layout on the target:
|
||
|
||
- First partition mounted under ``/boot``, labeled "boot".
|
||
|
||
- The main rootfs partition where this image gets installed,
|
||
which is mounted under ``/``.
|
||
|
||
- Another partition labeled "testrootfs" where test images get
|
||
deployed.
|
||
|
||
3. *Install image:* Install the image that you just built on the target
|
||
system.
|
||
|
||
The final thing you need to do when setting ``TEST_TARGET`` to
|
||
"SystemdbootTarget" is to set up the test image:
|
||
|
||
1. *Set up your ``local.conf`` file:* Make sure you have the following
|
||
statements in your ``local.conf`` file: IMAGE_FSTYPES += "tar.gz"
|
||
INHERIT += "testimage" TEST_TARGET = "SystemdbootTarget"
|
||
TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.2.3"
|
||
|
||
2. *Build your test image:* Use BitBake to build the image: $ bitbake
|
||
core-image-sato
|
||
|
||
Power Control
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
For most hardware targets other than "simpleremote", you can control
|
||
power:
|
||
|
||
- You can use ``TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD`` together with
|
||
``TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` as a command that runs on the host
|
||
and does power cycling. The test code passes one argument to that
|
||
command: off, on or cycle (off then on). Here is an example that
|
||
could appear in your ``local.conf`` file: TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD =
|
||
"powercontrol.exp test 10.11.12.1 nuc1" In this example, the expect
|
||
script does the following: ssh test@10.11.12.1 "pyctl nuc1 arg" It
|
||
then runs a Python script that controls power for a label called
|
||
``nuc1``.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You need to customize
|
||
TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD
|
||
and
|
||
TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS
|
||
for your own setup. The one requirement is that it accepts "on",
|
||
"off", and "cycle" as the last argument.
|
||
|
||
- When no command is defined, it connects to the device over SSH and
|
||
uses the classic reboot command to reboot the device. Classic reboot
|
||
is fine as long as the machine actually reboots (i.e. the SSH test
|
||
has not failed). It is useful for scenarios where you have a simple
|
||
setup, typically with a single board, and where some manual
|
||
interaction is okay from time to time.
|
||
|
||
If you have no hardware to automatically perform power control but still
|
||
wish to experiment with automated hardware testing, you can use the
|
||
dialog-power-control script that shows a dialog prompting you to perform
|
||
the required power action. This script requires either KDialog or Zenity
|
||
to be installed. To use this script, set the
|
||
:term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD`
|
||
variable as follows: TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD =
|
||
"${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/dialog-power-control"
|
||
|
||
Serial Console Connection
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
For test target classes requiring a serial console to interact with the
|
||
bootloader (e.g. BeagleBoneTarget, EdgeRouterTarget, and GrubTarget),
|
||
you need to specify a command to use to connect to the serial console of
|
||
the target machine by using the
|
||
:term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD`
|
||
variable and optionally the
|
||
:term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`
|
||
variable.
|
||
|
||
These cases could be a serial terminal program if the machine is
|
||
connected to a local serial port, or a ``telnet`` or ``ssh`` command
|
||
connecting to a remote console server. Regardless of the case, the
|
||
command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward that
|
||
connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal program
|
||
does. For example, to use the picocom terminal program on serial device
|
||
``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows:
|
||
TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200" For local
|
||
devices where the serial port device disappears when the device reboots,
|
||
an additional "serdevtry" wrapper script is provided. To use this
|
||
wrapper, simply prefix the terminal command with
|
||
``${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/serdevtry``: TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD =
|
||
"${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/serdevtry picocom -b 115200 /dev/ttyUSB0"
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-running-tests:
|
||
|
||
Running Tests
|
||
-------------
|
||
|
||
You can start the tests automatically or manually:
|
||
|
||
- *Automatically running tests:* To run the tests automatically after
|
||
the OpenEmbedded build system successfully creates an image, first
|
||
set the
|
||
:term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO`
|
||
variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` file in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`: TESTIMAGE_AUTO =
|
||
"1" Next, build your image. If the image successfully builds, the
|
||
tests run: bitbake core-image-sato
|
||
|
||
- *Manually running tests:* To manually run the tests, first globally
|
||
inherit the
|
||
:ref:`testimage <ref-classes-testimage*>` class
|
||
by editing your ``local.conf`` file: INHERIT += "testimage" Next, use
|
||
BitBake to run the tests: bitbake -c testimage image
|
||
|
||
All test files reside in ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime`` in the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory`. A test name maps
|
||
directly to a Python module. Each test module may contain a number of
|
||
individual tests. Tests are usually grouped together by the area tested
|
||
(e.g tests for systemd reside in ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime/systemd.py``).
|
||
|
||
You can add tests to any layer provided you place them in the proper
|
||
area and you extend :term:`BBPATH` in
|
||
the ``local.conf`` file as normal. Be sure that tests reside in
|
||
``layer/lib/oeqa/runtime``.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Be sure that module names do not collide with module names used in
|
||
the default set of test modules in
|
||
meta/lib/oeqa/runtime
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
You can change the set of tests run by appending or overriding
|
||
:term:`TEST_SUITES` variable in
|
||
``local.conf``. Each name in ``TEST_SUITES`` represents a required test
|
||
for the image. Test modules named within ``TEST_SUITES`` cannot be
|
||
skipped even if a test is not suitable for an image (e.g. running the
|
||
RPM tests on an image without ``rpm``). Appending "auto" to
|
||
``TEST_SUITES`` causes the build system to try to run all tests that are
|
||
suitable for the image (i.e. each test module may elect to skip itself).
|
||
|
||
The order you list tests in ``TEST_SUITES`` is important and influences
|
||
test dependencies. Consequently, tests that depend on other tests should
|
||
be added after the test on which they depend. For example, since the
|
||
``ssh`` test depends on the ``ping`` test, "ssh" needs to come after
|
||
"ping" in the list. The test class provides no re-ordering or dependency
|
||
handling.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Each module can have multiple classes with multiple test methods.
|
||
And, Python
|
||
unittest
|
||
rules apply.
|
||
|
||
Here are some things to keep in mind when running tests:
|
||
|
||
- The default tests for the image are defined as:
|
||
DEFAULT_TEST_SUITES_pn-image = "ping ssh df connman syslog xorg scp
|
||
vnc date rpm dnf dmesg"
|
||
|
||
- Add your own test to the list of the by using the following:
|
||
TEST_SUITES_append = " mytest"
|
||
|
||
- Run a specific list of tests as follows: TEST_SUITES = "test1 test2
|
||
test3" Remember, order is important. Be sure to place a test that is
|
||
dependent on another test later in the order.
|
||
|
||
Exporting Tests
|
||
---------------
|
||
|
||
You can export tests so that they can run independently of the build
|
||
system. Exporting tests is required if you want to be able to hand the
|
||
test execution off to a scheduler. You can only export tests that are
|
||
defined in :term:`TEST_SUITES`.
|
||
|
||
If your image is already built, make sure the following are set in your
|
||
``local.conf`` file: INHERIT +="testexport" TEST_TARGET_IP =
|
||
"IP-address-for-the-test-target" TEST_SERVER_IP =
|
||
"IP-address-for-the-test-server" You can then export the tests with the
|
||
following BitBake command form: $ bitbake image -c testexport Exporting
|
||
the tests places them in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` in
|
||
``tmp/testexport/``\ image, which is controlled by the
|
||
``TEST_EXPORT_DIR`` variable.
|
||
|
||
You can now run the tests outside of the build environment: $ cd
|
||
tmp/testexport/image $ ./runexported.py testdata.json
|
||
|
||
Here is a complete example that shows IP addresses and uses the
|
||
``core-image-sato`` image: INHERIT +="testexport" TEST_TARGET_IP =
|
||
"192.168.7.2" TEST_SERVER_IP = "192.168.7.1" Use BitBake to export the
|
||
tests: $ bitbake core-image-sato -c testexport Run the tests outside of
|
||
the build environment using the following: $ cd
|
||
tmp/testexport/core-image-sato $ ./runexported.py testdata.json
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-writing-new-tests:
|
||
|
||
Writing New Tests
|
||
-----------------
|
||
|
||
As mentioned previously, all new test files need to be in the proper
|
||
place for the build system to find them. New tests for additional
|
||
functionality outside of the core should be added to the layer that adds
|
||
the functionality, in ``layer/lib/oeqa/runtime`` (as long as
|
||
:term:`BBPATH` is extended in the
|
||
layer's ``layer.conf`` file as normal). Just remember the following:
|
||
|
||
- Filenames need to map directly to test (module) names.
|
||
|
||
- Do not use module names that collide with existing core tests.
|
||
|
||
- Minimally, an empty ``__init__.py`` file must exist in the runtime
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
To create a new test, start by copying an existing module (e.g.
|
||
``syslog.py`` or ``gcc.py`` are good ones to use). Test modules can use
|
||
code from ``meta/lib/oeqa/utils``, which are helper classes.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Structure shell commands such that you rely on them and they return a
|
||
single code for success. Be aware that sometimes you will need to
|
||
parse the output. See the
|
||
df.py
|
||
and
|
||
date.py
|
||
modules for examples.
|
||
|
||
You will notice that all test classes inherit ``oeRuntimeTest``, which
|
||
is found in ``meta/lib/oetest.py``. This base class offers some helper
|
||
attributes, which are described in the following sections:
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-writing-tests-class-methods:
|
||
|
||
Class Methods
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Class methods are as follows:
|
||
|
||
- *``hasPackage(pkg)``:* Returns "True" if ``pkg`` is in the installed
|
||
package list of the image, which is based on the manifest file that
|
||
is generated during the ``do_rootfs`` task.
|
||
|
||
- *``hasFeature(feature)``:* Returns "True" if the feature is in
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` or
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-writing-tests-class-attributes:
|
||
|
||
Class Attributes
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Class attributes are as follows:
|
||
|
||
- *``pscmd``:* Equals "ps -ef" if ``procps`` is installed in the image.
|
||
Otherwise, ``pscmd`` equals "ps" (busybox).
|
||
|
||
- *``tc``:* The called test context, which gives access to the
|
||
following attributes:
|
||
|
||
- *``d``:* The BitBake datastore, which allows you to use stuff such
|
||
as ``oeRuntimeTest.tc.d.getVar("VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager")``.
|
||
|
||
- *``testslist`` and ``testsrequired``:* Used internally. The tests
|
||
do not need these.
|
||
|
||
- *``filesdir``:* The absolute path to
|
||
``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime/files``, which contains helper files for
|
||
tests meant for copying on the target such as small files written
|
||
in C for compilation.
|
||
|
||
- *``target``:* The target controller object used to deploy and
|
||
start an image on a particular target (e.g. Qemu, SimpleRemote,
|
||
and SystemdbootTarget). Tests usually use the following:
|
||
|
||
- *``ip``:* The target's IP address.
|
||
|
||
- *``server_ip``:* The host's IP address, which is usually used
|
||
by the DNF test suite.
|
||
|
||
- *``run(cmd, timeout=None)``:* The single, most used method.
|
||
This command is a wrapper for: ``ssh root@host "cmd"``. The
|
||
command returns a tuple: (status, output), which are what their
|
||
names imply - the return code of "cmd" and whatever output it
|
||
produces. The optional timeout argument represents the number
|
||
of seconds the test should wait for "cmd" to return. If the
|
||
argument is "None", the test uses the default instance's
|
||
timeout period, which is 300 seconds. If the argument is "0",
|
||
the test runs until the command returns.
|
||
|
||
- *``copy_to(localpath, remotepath)``:*
|
||
``scp localpath root@ip:remotepath``.
|
||
|
||
- *``copy_from(remotepath, localpath)``:*
|
||
``scp root@host:remotepath localpath``.
|
||
|
||
.. _qemu-image-writing-tests-instance-attributes:
|
||
|
||
Instance Attributes
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
A single instance attribute exists, which is ``target``. The ``target``
|
||
instance attribute is identical to the class attribute of the same name,
|
||
which is described in the previous section. This attribute exists as
|
||
both an instance and class attribute so tests can use
|
||
``self.target.run(cmd)`` in instance methods instead of
|
||
``oeRuntimeTest.tc.target.run(cmd)``.
|
||
|
||
Installing Packages in the DUT Without the Package Manager
|
||
----------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
When a test requires a package built by BitBake, it is possible to
|
||
install that package. Installing the package does not require a package
|
||
manager be installed in the device under test (DUT). It does, however,
|
||
require an SSH connection and the target must be using the
|
||
``sshcontrol`` class.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This method uses
|
||
scp
|
||
to copy files from the host to the target, which causes permissions
|
||
and special attributes to be lost.
|
||
|
||
A JSON file is used to define the packages needed by a test. This file
|
||
must be in the same path as the file used to define the tests.
|
||
Furthermore, the filename must map directly to the test module name with
|
||
a ``.json`` extension.
|
||
|
||
The JSON file must include an object with the test name as keys of an
|
||
object or an array. This object (or array of objects) uses the following
|
||
data:
|
||
|
||
- "pkg" - A mandatory string that is the name of the package to be
|
||
installed.
|
||
|
||
- "rm" - An optional boolean, which defaults to "false", that specifies
|
||
to remove the package after the test.
|
||
|
||
- "extract" - An optional boolean, which defaults to "false", that
|
||
specifies if the package must be extracted from the package format.
|
||
When set to "true", the package is not automatically installed into
|
||
the DUT.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example JSON file that handles test "foo" installing
|
||
package "bar" and test "foobar" installing packages "foo" and "bar".
|
||
Once the test is complete, the packages are removed from the DUT. {
|
||
"foo": { "pkg": "bar" }, "foobar": [ { "pkg": "foo", "rm": true }, {
|
||
"pkg": "bar", "rm": true } ] }
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-debugging-tools-and-techniques:
|
||
|
||
Debugging Tools and Techniques
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
The exact method for debugging build failures depends on the nature of
|
||
the problem and on the system's area from which the bug originates.
|
||
Standard debugging practices such as comparison against the last known
|
||
working version with examination of the changes and the re-application
|
||
of steps to identify the one causing the problem are valid for the Yocto
|
||
Project just as they are for any other system. Even though it is
|
||
impossible to detail every possible potential failure, this section
|
||
provides some general tips to aid in debugging given a variety of
|
||
situations.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A useful feature for debugging is the error reporting tool.
|
||
Configuring the Yocto Project to use this tool causes the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system to produce error reporting commands as part
|
||
of the console output. You can enter the commands after the build
|
||
completes to log error information into a common database, that can
|
||
help you figure out what might be going wrong. For information on how
|
||
to enable and use this feature, see the "
|
||
Using the Error Reporting Tool
|
||
" section.
|
||
|
||
The following list shows the debugging topics in the remainder of this
|
||
section:
|
||
|
||
- "`Viewing Logs from Failed
|
||
Tasks <#dev-debugging-viewing-logs-from-failed-tasks>`__" describes
|
||
how to find and view logs from tasks that failed during the build
|
||
process.
|
||
|
||
- "`Viewing Variable
|
||
Values <#dev-debugging-viewing-variable-values>`__" describes how to
|
||
use the BitBake ``-e`` option to examine variable values after a
|
||
recipe has been parsed.
|
||
|
||
- "`Viewing Package Information with
|
||
``oe-pkgdata-util`` <#viewing-package-information-with-oe-pkgdata-util>`__"
|
||
describes how to use the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` utility to query
|
||
:term:`PKGDATA_DIR` and
|
||
display package-related information for built packages.
|
||
|
||
- "`Viewing Dependencies Between Recipes and
|
||
Tasks <#dev-viewing-dependencies-between-recipes-and-tasks>`__"
|
||
describes how to use the BitBake ``-g`` option to display recipe
|
||
dependency information used during the build.
|
||
|
||
- "`Viewing Task Variable
|
||
Dependencies <#dev-viewing-task-variable-dependencies>`__" describes
|
||
how to use the ``bitbake-dumpsig`` command in conjunction with key
|
||
subdirectories in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory` to determine
|
||
variable dependencies.
|
||
|
||
- "`Running Specific Tasks <#dev-debugging-taskrunning>`__" describes
|
||
how to use several BitBake options (e.g. ``-c``, ``-C``, and ``-f``)
|
||
to run specific tasks in the build chain. It can be useful to run
|
||
tasks "out-of-order" when trying isolate build issues.
|
||
|
||
- "`General BitBake Problems <#dev-debugging-bitbake>`__" describes how
|
||
to use BitBake's ``-D`` debug output option to reveal more about what
|
||
BitBake is doing during the build.
|
||
|
||
- "`Building with No Dependencies <#dev-debugging-buildfile>`__"
|
||
describes how to use the BitBake ``-b`` option to build a recipe
|
||
while ignoring dependencies.
|
||
|
||
- "`Recipe Logging Mechanisms <#recipe-logging-mechanisms>`__"
|
||
describes how to use the many recipe logging functions to produce
|
||
debugging output and report errors and warnings.
|
||
|
||
- "`Debugging Parallel Make Races <#debugging-parallel-make-races>`__"
|
||
describes how to debug situations where the build consists of several
|
||
parts that are run simultaneously and when the output or result of
|
||
one part is not ready for use with a different part of the build that
|
||
depends on that output.
|
||
|
||
- "`Debugging With the GNU Project Debugger (GDB)
|
||
Remotely <#platdev-gdb-remotedebug>`__" describes how to use GDB to
|
||
allow you to examine running programs, which can help you fix
|
||
problems.
|
||
|
||
- "`Debugging with the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) on the
|
||
Target <#debugging-with-the-gnu-project-debugger-gdb-on-the-target>`__"
|
||
describes how to use GDB directly on target hardware for debugging.
|
||
|
||
- "`Other Debugging Tips <#dev-other-debugging-others>`__" describes
|
||
miscellaneous debugging tips that can be useful.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-debugging-viewing-logs-from-failed-tasks:
|
||
|
||
Viewing Logs from Failed Tasks
|
||
------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can find the log for a task in the file
|
||
``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/temp/log.do_``\ taskname.
|
||
For example, the log for the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task of the
|
||
QEMU minimal image for the x86 machine (``qemux86``) might be in
|
||
``tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/temp/log.do_compile``.
|
||
To see the commands :term:`BitBake` ran
|
||
to generate a log, look at the corresponding ``run.do_``\ taskname file
|
||
in the same directory.
|
||
|
||
``log.do_``\ taskname and ``run.do_``\ taskname are actually symbolic
|
||
links to ``log.do_``\ taskname\ ``.``\ pid and
|
||
``log.run_``\ taskname\ ``.``\ pid, where pid is the PID the task had
|
||
when it ran. The symlinks always point to the files corresponding to the
|
||
most recent run.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-debugging-viewing-variable-values:
|
||
|
||
Viewing Variable Values
|
||
-----------------------
|
||
|
||
Sometimes you need to know the value of a variable as a result of
|
||
BitBake's parsing step. This could be because some unexpected behavior
|
||
occurred in your project. Perhaps an attempt to `modify a
|
||
variable <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#modifying-existing-variables>`__ did not
|
||
work out as expected.
|
||
|
||
BitBake's ``-e`` option is used to display variable values after
|
||
parsing. The following command displays the variable values after the
|
||
configuration files (i.e. ``local.conf``, ``bblayers.conf``,
|
||
``bitbake.conf`` and so forth) have been parsed: $ bitbake -e The
|
||
following command displays variable values after a specific recipe has
|
||
been parsed. The variables include those from the configuration as well:
|
||
$ bitbake -e recipename
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Each recipe has its own private set of variables (datastore).
|
||
Internally, after parsing the configuration, a copy of the resulting
|
||
datastore is made prior to parsing each recipe. This copying implies
|
||
that variables set in one recipe will not be visible to other
|
||
recipes.
|
||
|
||
Likewise, each task within a recipe gets a private datastore based on
|
||
the recipe datastore, which means that variables set within one task
|
||
will not be visible to other tasks.
|
||
|
||
In the output of ``bitbake -e``, each variable is preceded by a
|
||
description of how the variable got its value, including temporary
|
||
values that were later overriden. This description also includes
|
||
variable flags (varflags) set on the variable. The output can be very
|
||
helpful during debugging.
|
||
|
||
Variables that are exported to the environment are preceded by
|
||
``export`` in the output of ``bitbake -e``. See the following example:
|
||
export CC="i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32 -march=i586
|
||
--sysroot=/home/ulf/poky/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86"
|
||
|
||
In addition to variable values, the output of the ``bitbake -e`` and
|
||
``bitbake -e`` recipe commands includes the following information:
|
||
|
||
- The output starts with a tree listing all configuration files and
|
||
classes included globally, recursively listing the files they include
|
||
or inherit in turn. Much of the behavior of the OpenEmbedded build
|
||
system (including the behavior of the `normal recipe build
|
||
tasks <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#normal-recipe-build-tasks>`__) is
|
||
implemented in the
|
||
:ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class and the
|
||
classes it inherits, rather than being built into BitBake itself.
|
||
|
||
- After the variable values, all functions appear in the output. For
|
||
shell functions, variables referenced within the function body are
|
||
expanded. If a function has been modified using overrides or using
|
||
override-style operators like ``_append`` and ``_prepend``, then the
|
||
final assembled function body appears in the output.
|
||
|
||
Viewing Package Information with ``oe-pkgdata-util``
|
||
----------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can use the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` command-line utility to query
|
||
:term:`PKGDATA_DIR` and display
|
||
various package-related information. When you use the utility, you must
|
||
use it to view information on packages that have already been built.
|
||
|
||
Following are a few of the available ``oe-pkgdata-util`` subcommands.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can use the standard \* and ? globbing wildcards as part of
|
||
package names and paths.
|
||
|
||
- ``oe-pkgdata-util list-pkgs [``\ pattern\ ``]``: Lists all packages
|
||
that have been built, optionally limiting the match to packages that
|
||
match pattern.
|
||
|
||
- ``oe-pkgdata-util list-pkg-files ``\ package\ `` ...``: Lists the
|
||
files and directories contained in the given packages.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
A different way to view the contents of a package is to look at
|
||
the
|
||
``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/packages-split``
|
||
directory of the recipe that generates the package. This directory
|
||
is created by the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-package` task
|
||
and has one subdirectory for each package the recipe generates,
|
||
which contains the files stored in that package.
|
||
|
||
If you want to inspect the ``${WORKDIR}/packages-split``
|
||
directory, make sure that
|
||
:ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` is not
|
||
enabled when you build the recipe.
|
||
|
||
- ``oe-pkgdata-util find-path ``\ path\ `` ...``: Lists the names of
|
||
the packages that contain the given paths. For example, the following
|
||
tells us that ``/usr/share/man/man1/make.1`` is contained in the
|
||
``make-doc`` package: $ oe-pkgdata-util find-path
|
||
/usr/share/man/man1/make.1 make-doc: /usr/share/man/man1/make.1
|
||
|
||
- ``oe-pkgdata-util lookup-recipe ``\ package\ `` ...``: Lists the name
|
||
of the recipes that produce the given packages.
|
||
|
||
For more information on the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` command, use the help
|
||
facility: $ oe-pkgdata-util DASHDASHhelp $ oe-pkgdata-util subcommand
|
||
--help
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-viewing-dependencies-between-recipes-and-tasks:
|
||
|
||
Viewing Dependencies Between Recipes and Tasks
|
||
----------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Sometimes it can be hard to see why BitBake wants to build other recipes
|
||
before the one you have specified. Dependency information can help you
|
||
understand why a recipe is built.
|
||
|
||
To generate dependency information for a recipe, run the following
|
||
command: $ bitbake -g recipename This command writes the following files
|
||
in the current directory:
|
||
|
||
- ``pn-buildlist``: A list of recipes/targets involved in building
|
||
recipename. "Involved" here means that at least one task from the
|
||
recipe needs to run when building recipename from scratch. Targets
|
||
that are in
|
||
:term:`ASSUME_PROVIDED`
|
||
are not listed.
|
||
|
||
- ``task-depends.dot``: A graph showing dependencies between tasks.
|
||
|
||
The graphs are in
|
||
`DOT <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/DOT_%28graph_description_language%29>`__
|
||
format and can be converted to images (e.g. using the ``dot`` tool from
|
||
`Graphviz <http://www.graphviz.org/>`__).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- DOT files use a plain text format. The graphs generated using the
|
||
``bitbake -g`` command are often so large as to be difficult to
|
||
read without special pruning (e.g. with Bitbake's ``-I`` option)
|
||
and processing. Despite the form and size of the graphs, the
|
||
corresponding ``.dot`` files can still be possible to read and
|
||
provide useful information.
|
||
|
||
As an example, the ``task-depends.dot`` file contains lines such
|
||
as the following: "libxslt.do_configure" ->
|
||
"libxml2.do_populate_sysroot" The above example line reveals that
|
||
the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-configure`
|
||
task in ``libxslt`` depends on the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
|
||
task in ``libxml2``, which is a normal
|
||
:term:`DEPENDS` dependency
|
||
between the two recipes.
|
||
|
||
- For an example of how ``.dot`` files can be processed, see the
|
||
``scripts/contrib/graph-tool`` Python script, which finds and
|
||
displays paths between graph nodes.
|
||
|
||
You can use a different method to view dependency information by using
|
||
the following command: $ bitbake -g -u taskexp recipename This command
|
||
displays a GUI window from which you can view build-time and runtime
|
||
dependencies for the recipes involved in building recipename.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-viewing-task-variable-dependencies:
|
||
|
||
Viewing Task Variable Dependencies
|
||
----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
As mentioned in the "`Checksums
|
||
(Signatures) <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#checksums>`__" section of the BitBake
|
||
User Manual, BitBake tries to automatically determine what variables a
|
||
task depends on so that it can rerun the task if any values of the
|
||
variables change. This determination is usually reliable. However, if
|
||
you do things like construct variable names at runtime, then you might
|
||
have to manually declare dependencies on those variables using
|
||
``vardeps`` as described in the "`Variable
|
||
Flags <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#variable-flags>`__" section of the BitBake
|
||
User Manual.
|
||
|
||
If you are unsure whether a variable dependency is being picked up
|
||
automatically for a given task, you can list the variable dependencies
|
||
BitBake has determined by doing the following:
|
||
|
||
1. Build the recipe containing the task: $ bitbake recipename
|
||
|
||
2. Inside the :term:`STAMPS_DIR`
|
||
directory, find the signature data (``sigdata``) file that
|
||
corresponds to the task. The ``sigdata`` files contain a pickled
|
||
Python database of all the metadata that went into creating the input
|
||
checksum for the task. As an example, for the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` task of the
|
||
``db`` recipe, the ``sigdata`` file might be found in the following
|
||
location:
|
||
${BUILDDIR}/tmp/stamps/i586-poky-linux/db/6.0.30-r1.do_fetch.sigdata.7c048c18222b16ff0bcee2000ef648b1
|
||
For tasks that are accelerated through the shared state
|
||
(`sstate <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#shared-state-cache>`__) cache, an
|
||
additional ``siginfo`` file is written into
|
||
:term:`SSTATE_DIR` along with
|
||
the cached task output. The ``siginfo`` files contain exactly the
|
||
same information as ``sigdata`` files.
|
||
|
||
3. Run ``bitbake-dumpsig`` on the ``sigdata`` or ``siginfo`` file. Here
|
||
is an example: $ bitbake-dumpsig
|
||
${BUILDDIR}/tmp/stamps/i586-poky-linux/db/6.0.30-r1.do_fetch.sigdata.7c048c18222b16ff0bcee2000ef648b1
|
||
In the output of the above command, you will find a line like the
|
||
following, which lists all the (inferred) variable dependencies for
|
||
the task. This list also includes indirect dependencies from
|
||
variables depending on other variables, recursively. Task
|
||
dependencies: ['PV', 'SRCREV', 'SRC_URI', 'SRC_URI[md5sum]',
|
||
'SRC_URI[sha256sum]', 'base_do_fetch']
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Functions (e.g.
|
||
base_do_fetch
|
||
) also count as variable dependencies. These functions in turn
|
||
depend on the variables they reference.
|
||
|
||
The output of ``bitbake-dumpsig`` also includes the value each
|
||
variable had, a list of dependencies for each variable, and
|
||
```BB_HASHBASE_WHITELIST`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#var-BB_HASHBASE_WHITELIST>`__
|
||
information.
|
||
|
||
There is also a ``bitbake-diffsigs`` command for comparing two
|
||
``siginfo`` or ``sigdata`` files. This command can be helpful when
|
||
trying to figure out what changed between two versions of a task. If you
|
||
call ``bitbake-diffsigs`` with just one file, the command behaves like
|
||
``bitbake-dumpsig``.
|
||
|
||
You can also use BitBake to dump out the signature construction
|
||
information without executing tasks by using either of the following
|
||
BitBake command-line options: DASHDASHdump-signatures=SIGNATURE_HANDLER
|
||
-S SIGNATURE_HANDLER
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Two common values for
|
||
SIGNATURE_HANDLER
|
||
are "none" and "printdiff", which dump only the signature or compare
|
||
the dumped signature with the cached one, respectively.
|
||
|
||
Using BitBake with either of these options causes BitBake to dump out
|
||
``sigdata`` files in the ``stamps`` directory for every task it would
|
||
have executed instead of building the specified target package.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-viewing-metadata-used-to-create-the-input-signature-of-a-shared-state-task:
|
||
|
||
Viewing Metadata Used to Create the Input Signature of a Shared State Task
|
||
--------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Seeing what metadata went into creating the input signature of a shared
|
||
state (sstate) task can be a useful debugging aid. This information is
|
||
available in signature information (``siginfo``) files in
|
||
:term:`SSTATE_DIR`. For
|
||
information on how to view and interpret information in ``siginfo``
|
||
files, see the "`Viewing Task Variable
|
||
Dependencies <#dev-viewing-task-variable-dependencies>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
For conceptual information on shared state, see the "`Shared
|
||
State <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#shared-state>`__" section in the Yocto
|
||
Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-invalidating-shared-state-to-force-a-task-to-run:
|
||
|
||
Invalidating Shared State to Force a Task to Run
|
||
------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The OpenEmbedded build system uses
|
||
`checksums <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#overview-checksums>`__ and `shared
|
||
state <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#shared-state>`__ cache to avoid unnecessarily
|
||
rebuilding tasks. Collectively, this scheme is known as "shared state
|
||
code."
|
||
|
||
As with all schemes, this one has some drawbacks. It is possible that
|
||
you could make implicit changes to your code that the checksum
|
||
calculations do not take into account. These implicit changes affect a
|
||
task's output but do not trigger the shared state code into rebuilding a
|
||
recipe. Consider an example during which a tool changes its output.
|
||
Assume that the output of ``rpmdeps`` changes. The result of the change
|
||
should be that all the ``package`` and ``package_write_rpm`` shared
|
||
state cache items become invalid. However, because the change to the
|
||
output is external to the code and therefore implicit, the associated
|
||
shared state cache items do not become invalidated. In this case, the
|
||
build process uses the cached items rather than running the task again.
|
||
Obviously, these types of implicit changes can cause problems.
|
||
|
||
To avoid these problems during the build, you need to understand the
|
||
effects of any changes you make. Realize that changes you make directly
|
||
to a function are automatically factored into the checksum calculation.
|
||
Thus, these explicit changes invalidate the associated area of shared
|
||
state cache. However, you need to be aware of any implicit changes that
|
||
are not obvious changes to the code and could affect the output of a
|
||
given task.
|
||
|
||
When you identify an implicit change, you can easily take steps to
|
||
invalidate the cache and force the tasks to run. The steps you can take
|
||
are as simple as changing a function's comments in the source code. For
|
||
example, to invalidate package shared state files, change the comment
|
||
statements of
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-package` or the
|
||
comments of one of the functions it calls. Even though the change is
|
||
purely cosmetic, it causes the checksum to be recalculated and forces
|
||
the build system to run the task again.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For an example of a commit that makes a cosmetic change to invalidate
|
||
shared state, see this
|
||
commit
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-debugging-taskrunning:
|
||
|
||
Running Specific Tasks
|
||
----------------------
|
||
|
||
Any given recipe consists of a set of tasks. The standard BitBake
|
||
behavior in most cases is: ``do_fetch``, ``do_unpack``, ``do_patch``,
|
||
``do_configure``, ``do_compile``, ``do_install``, ``do_package``,
|
||
``do_package_write_*``, and ``do_build``. The default task is
|
||
``do_build`` and any tasks on which it depends build first. Some tasks,
|
||
such as ``do_devshell``, are not part of the default build chain. If you
|
||
wish to run a task that is not part of the default build chain, you can
|
||
use the ``-c`` option in BitBake. Here is an example: $ bitbake
|
||
matchbox-desktop -c devshell
|
||
|
||
The ``-c`` option respects task dependencies, which means that all other
|
||
tasks (including tasks from other recipes) that the specified task
|
||
depends on will be run before the task. Even when you manually specify a
|
||
task to run with ``-c``, BitBake will only run the task if it considers
|
||
it "out of date". See the "`Stamp Files and the Rerunning of
|
||
Tasks <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#stamp-files-and-the-rerunning-of-tasks>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for how
|
||
BitBake determines whether a task is "out of date".
|
||
|
||
If you want to force an up-to-date task to be rerun (e.g. because you
|
||
made manual modifications to the recipe's
|
||
:term:`WORKDIR` that you want to try
|
||
out), then you can use the ``-f`` option.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The reason
|
||
-f
|
||
is never required when running the
|
||
do_devshell
|
||
task is because the
|
||
[
|
||
nostamp
|
||
]
|
||
variable flag is already set for the task.
|
||
|
||
The following example shows one way you can use the ``-f`` option: $
|
||
bitbake matchbox-desktop . . make some changes to the source code in the
|
||
work directory . . $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c compile -f $ bitbake
|
||
matchbox-desktop
|
||
|
||
This sequence first builds and then recompiles ``matchbox-desktop``. The
|
||
last command reruns all tasks (basically the packaging tasks) after the
|
||
compile. BitBake recognizes that the ``do_compile`` task was rerun and
|
||
therefore understands that the other tasks also need to be run again.
|
||
|
||
Another, shorter way to rerun a task and all `normal recipe build
|
||
tasks <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#normal-recipe-build-tasks>`__ that depend on
|
||
it is to use the ``-C`` option.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This option is upper-cased and is separate from the
|
||
-c
|
||
option, which is lower-cased.
|
||
|
||
Using this option invalidates the given task and then runs the
|
||
:ref:`ref-tasks-build` task, which is
|
||
the default task if no task is given, and the tasks on which it depends.
|
||
You could replace the final two commands in the previous example with
|
||
the following single command: $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -C compile
|
||
Internally, the ``-f`` and ``-C`` options work by tainting (modifying)
|
||
the input checksum of the specified task. This tainting indirectly
|
||
causes the task and its dependent tasks to be rerun through the normal
|
||
task dependency mechanisms.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
BitBake explicitly keeps track of which tasks have been tainted in
|
||
this fashion, and will print warnings such as the following for
|
||
builds involving such tasks:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
WARNING: /home/ulf/poky/meta/recipes-sato/matchbox-desktop/matchbox-desktop_2.1.bb.do_compile is tainted from a forced run
|
||
|
||
|
||
The purpose of the warning is to let you know that the work directory
|
||
and build output might not be in the clean state they would be in for
|
||
a "normal" build, depending on what actions you took. To get rid of
|
||
such warnings, you can remove the work directory and rebuild the
|
||
recipe, as follows:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
$ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c clean
|
||
$ bitbake matchbox-desktop
|
||
|
||
|
||
You can view a list of tasks in a given package by running the
|
||
``do_listtasks`` task as follows: $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c
|
||
listtasks The results appear as output to the console and are also in
|
||
the file ``${WORKDIR}/temp/log.do_listtasks``.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-debugging-bitbake:
|
||
|
||
General BitBake Problems
|
||
------------------------
|
||
|
||
You can see debug output from BitBake by using the ``-D`` option. The
|
||
debug output gives more information about what BitBake is doing and the
|
||
reason behind it. Each ``-D`` option you use increases the logging
|
||
level. The most common usage is ``-DDD``.
|
||
|
||
The output from ``bitbake -DDD -v`` targetname can reveal why BitBake
|
||
chose a certain version of a package or why BitBake picked a certain
|
||
provider. This command could also help you in a situation where you
|
||
think BitBake did something unexpected.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-debugging-buildfile:
|
||
|
||
Building with No Dependencies
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
To build a specific recipe (``.bb`` file), you can use the following
|
||
command form: $ bitbake -b somepath/somerecipe.bb This command form does
|
||
not check for dependencies. Consequently, you should use it only when
|
||
you know existing dependencies have been met.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can also specify fragments of the filename. In this case, BitBake
|
||
checks for a unique match.
|
||
|
||
Recipe Logging Mechanisms
|
||
-------------------------
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides several logging functions for producing
|
||
debugging output and reporting errors and warnings. For Python
|
||
functions, the following logging functions exist. All of these functions
|
||
log to ``${T}/log.do_``\ task, and can also log to standard output
|
||
(stdout) with the right settings:
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.plain(``\ msg\ ``)``: Writes msg as is to the log while also
|
||
logging to stdout.
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.note(``\ msg\ ``)``: Writes "NOTE: msg" to the log. Also logs to
|
||
stdout if BitBake is called with "-v".
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.debug(``\ level\ ``, ``\ msg\ ``)``: Writes "DEBUG: msg" to the
|
||
log. Also logs to stdout if the log level is greater than or equal to
|
||
level. See the "`-D <&YOCTO_DOCS_BB_URL;#usage-and-syntax>`__" option
|
||
in the BitBake User Manual for more information.
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.warn(``\ msg\ ``)``: Writes "WARNING: msg" to the log while also
|
||
logging to stdout.
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.error(``\ msg\ ``)``: Writes "ERROR: msg" to the log while also
|
||
logging to standard out (stdout).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Calling this function does not cause the task to fail.
|
||
|
||
- ``bb.fatal(``\ msg\ ``)``: This logging function is similar to
|
||
``bb.error(``\ msg\ ``)`` but also causes the calling task to fail.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
bb.fatal()
|
||
raises an exception, which means you do not need to put a "return"
|
||
statement after the function.
|
||
|
||
The same logging functions are also available in shell functions, under
|
||
the names ``bbplain``, ``bbnote``, ``bbdebug``, ``bbwarn``, ``bberror``,
|
||
and ``bbfatal``. The
|
||
:ref:`logging <ref-classes-logging>` class
|
||
implements these functions. See that class in the ``meta/classes``
|
||
folder of the :term:`Source Directory` for information.
|
||
|
||
Logging With Python
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
When creating recipes using Python and inserting code that handles build
|
||
logs, keep in mind the goal is to have informative logs while keeping
|
||
the console as "silent" as possible. Also, if you want status messages
|
||
in the log, use the "debug" loglevel.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example written in Python. The code handles logging for
|
||
a function that determines the number of tasks needed to be run. See the
|
||
":ref:`ref-tasks-listtasks`"
|
||
section for additional information: python do_listtasks() { bb.debug(2,
|
||
"Starting to figure out the task list") if noteworthy_condition:
|
||
bb.note("There are 47 tasks to run") bb.debug(2, "Got to point xyz") if
|
||
warning_trigger: bb.warn("Detected warning_trigger, this might be a
|
||
problem later.") if recoverable_error: bb.error("Hit recoverable_error,
|
||
you really need to fix this!") if fatal_error: bb.fatal("fatal_error
|
||
detected, unable to print the task list") bb.plain("The tasks present
|
||
are abc") bb.debug(2, "Finished figuring out the tasklist") }
|
||
|
||
Logging With Bash
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
When creating recipes using Bash and inserting code that handles build
|
||
logs, you have the same goals - informative with minimal console output.
|
||
The syntax you use for recipes written in Bash is similar to that of
|
||
recipes written in Python described in the previous section.
|
||
|
||
Following is an example written in Bash. The code logs the progress of
|
||
the ``do_my_function`` function. do_my_function() { bbdebug 2 "Running
|
||
do_my_function" if [ exceptional_condition ]; then bbnote "Hit
|
||
exceptional_condition" fi bbdebug 2 "Got to point xyz" if [
|
||
warning_trigger ]; then bbwarn "Detected warning_trigger, this might
|
||
cause a problem later." fi if [ recoverable_error ]; then bberror "Hit
|
||
recoverable_error, correcting" fi if [ fatal_error ]; then bbfatal
|
||
"fatal_error detected" fi bbdebug 2 "Completed do_my_function" }
|
||
|
||
Debugging Parallel Make Races
|
||
-----------------------------
|
||
|
||
A parallel ``make`` race occurs when the build consists of several parts
|
||
that are run simultaneously and a situation occurs when the output or
|
||
result of one part is not ready for use with a different part of the
|
||
build that depends on that output. Parallel make races are annoying and
|
||
can sometimes be difficult to reproduce and fix. However, some simple
|
||
tips and tricks exist that can help you debug and fix them. This section
|
||
presents a real-world example of an error encountered on the Yocto
|
||
Project autobuilder and the process used to fix it.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you cannot properly fix a
|
||
make
|
||
race condition, you can work around it by clearing either the
|
||
PARALLEL_MAKE
|
||
or
|
||
PARALLEL_MAKEINST
|
||
variables.
|
||
|
||
The Failure
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
For this example, assume that you are building an image that depends on
|
||
the "neard" package. And, during the build, BitBake runs into problems
|
||
and creates the following output.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This example log file has longer lines artificially broken to make
|
||
the listing easier to read.
|
||
|
||
If you examine the output or the log file, you see the failure during
|
||
``make``: \| DEBUG: SITE files ['endian-little', 'bit-32',
|
||
'ix86-common', 'common-linux', 'common-glibc', 'i586-linux', 'common']
|
||
\| DEBUG: Executing shell function do_compile \| NOTE: make -j 16 \|
|
||
make --no-print-directory all-am \| /bin/mkdir -p include/near \|
|
||
/bin/mkdir -p include/near \| /bin/mkdir -p include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/types.h include/near/types.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/log.h include/near/log.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/plugin.h include/near/plugin.h \| /bin/mkdir
|
||
-p include/near \| /bin/mkdir -p include/near \| /bin/mkdir -p
|
||
include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/tag.h include/near/tag.h \| /bin/mkdir -p
|
||
include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/adapter.h include/near/adapter.h \|
|
||
/bin/mkdir -p include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/ndef.h include/near/ndef.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/tlv.h include/near/tlv.h \| /bin/mkdir -p
|
||
include/near \| /bin/mkdir -p include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/setting.h include/near/setting.h \|
|
||
/bin/mkdir -p include/near \| /bin/mkdir -p include/near \| /bin/mkdir
|
||
-p include/near \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/device.h include/near/device.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/nfc_copy.h include/near/nfc_copy.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/snep.h include/near/snep.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/version.h include/near/version.h \| ln -s
|
||
/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
|
||
0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/dbus.h include/near/dbus.h \|
|
||
./src/genbuiltin nfctype1 nfctype2 nfctype3 nfctype4 p2p > src/builtin.h
|
||
\| i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32 -march=i586
|
||
--sysroot=/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/
|
||
build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86 -DHAVE_CONFIG_H -I. -I./include -I./src
|
||
-I./gdbus -I/home/pokybuild/
|
||
yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/glib-2.0
|
||
-I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/
|
||
lib/glib-2.0/include
|
||
-I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/
|
||
tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/dbus-1.0
|
||
-I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/yocto-slave/
|
||
nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/lib/dbus-1.0/include
|
||
-I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/
|
||
yocto-slave/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/libnl3
|
||
-DNEAR_PLUGIN_BUILTIN -DPLUGINDIR=\""/usr/lib/near/plugins"\"
|
||
-DCONFIGDIR=\""/etc/neard\"" -O2 -pipe -g -feliminate-unused-debug-types
|
||
-c -o tools/snep-send.o tools/snep-send.c \| In file included from
|
||
tools/snep-send.c:16:0: \| tools/../src/near.h:41:23: fatal error:
|
||
near/dbus.h: No such file or directory \| #include <near/dbus.h> \| ^ \|
|
||
compilation terminated. \| make[1]: \**\* [tools/snep-send.o] Error 1 \|
|
||
make[1]: \**\* Waiting for unfinished jobs.... \| make: \**\* [all]
|
||
Error 2 \| ERROR: oe_runmake failed
|
||
|
||
Reproducing the Error
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Because race conditions are intermittent, they do not manifest
|
||
themselves every time you do the build. In fact, most times the build
|
||
will complete without problems even though the potential race condition
|
||
exists. Thus, once the error surfaces, you need a way to reproduce it.
|
||
|
||
In this example, compiling the "neard" package is causing the problem.
|
||
So the first thing to do is build "neard" locally. Before you start the
|
||
build, set the
|
||
:term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable
|
||
in your ``local.conf`` file to a high number (e.g. "-j 20"). Using a
|
||
high value for ``PARALLEL_MAKE`` increases the chances of the race
|
||
condition showing up: $ bitbake neard
|
||
|
||
Once the local build for "neard" completes, start a ``devshell`` build:
|
||
$ bitbake neard -c devshell For information on how to use a
|
||
``devshell``, see the "`Using a Development
|
||
Shell <#platdev-appdev-devshell>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
In the ``devshell``, do the following: $ make clean $ make
|
||
tools/snep-send.o The ``devshell`` commands cause the failure to clearly
|
||
be visible. In this case, a missing dependency exists for the "neard"
|
||
Makefile target. Here is some abbreviated, sample output with the
|
||
missing dependency clearly visible at the end: i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32
|
||
-march=i586 --sysroot=/home/scott-lenovo/...... . . . tools/snep-send.c
|
||
In file included from tools/snep-send.c:16:0: tools/../src/near.h:41:23:
|
||
fatal error: near/dbus.h: No such file or directory #include
|
||
<near/dbus.h> ^ compilation terminated. make: \**\* [tools/snep-send.o]
|
||
Error 1 $
|
||
|
||
Creating a Patch for the Fix
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Because there is a missing dependency for the Makefile target, you need
|
||
to patch the ``Makefile.am`` file, which is generated from
|
||
``Makefile.in``. You can use Quilt to create the patch: $ quilt new
|
||
parallelmake.patch Patch patches/parallelmake.patch is now on top $
|
||
quilt add Makefile.am File Makefile.am added to patch
|
||
patches/parallelmake.patch For more information on using Quilt, see the
|
||
"`Using Quilt in Your Workflow <#using-a-quilt-workflow>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
At this point you need to make the edits to ``Makefile.am`` to add the
|
||
missing dependency. For our example, you have to add the following line
|
||
to the file: tools/snep-send.$(OBJEXT): include/near/dbus.h
|
||
|
||
Once you have edited the file, use the ``refresh`` command to create the
|
||
patch: $ quilt refresh Refreshed patch patches/parallelmake.patch Once
|
||
the patch file exists, you need to add it back to the originating recipe
|
||
folder. Here is an example assuming a top-level
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` named ``poky``: $
|
||
cp patches/parallelmake.patch poky/meta/recipes-connectivity/neard/neard
|
||
The final thing you need to do to implement the fix in the build is to
|
||
update the "neard" recipe (i.e. ``neard-0.14.bb``) so that the
|
||
:term:`SRC_URI` statement includes
|
||
the patch file. The recipe file is in the folder above the patch. Here
|
||
is what the edited ``SRC_URI`` statement would look like: SRC_URI =
|
||
"${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/linux/network/nfc/${BPN}-${PV}.tar.xz \\
|
||
file://neard.in \\ file://neard.service.in \\ file://parallelmake.patch
|
||
\\ "
|
||
|
||
With the patch complete and moved to the correct folder and the
|
||
``SRC_URI`` statement updated, you can exit the ``devshell``: $ exit
|
||
|
||
Testing the Build
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
With everything in place, you can get back to trying the build again
|
||
locally: $ bitbake neard This build should succeed.
|
||
|
||
Now you can open up a ``devshell`` again and repeat the clean and make
|
||
operations as follows: $ bitbake neard -c devshell $ make clean $ make
|
||
tools/snep-send.o The build should work without issue.
|
||
|
||
As with all solved problems, if they originated upstream, you need to
|
||
submit the fix for the recipe in OE-Core and upstream so that the
|
||
problem is taken care of at its source. See the "`Submitting a Change to
|
||
the Yocto Project <#how-to-submit-a-change>`__" section for more
|
||
information.
|
||
|
||
.. _platdev-gdb-remotedebug:
|
||
|
||
Debugging With the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) Remotely
|
||
------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
GDB allows you to examine running programs, which in turn helps you to
|
||
understand and fix problems. It also allows you to perform post-mortem
|
||
style analysis of program crashes. GDB is available as a package within
|
||
the Yocto Project and is installed in SDK images by default. See the
|
||
":ref:`ref-manual/ref-images:Images`" chapter in the Yocto
|
||
Project Reference Manual for a description of these images. You can find
|
||
information on GDB at ` <http://sourceware.org/gdb/>`__.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For best results, install debug (
|
||
-dbg
|
||
) packages for the applications you are going to debug. Doing so
|
||
makes extra debug symbols available that give you more meaningful
|
||
output.
|
||
|
||
Sometimes, due to memory or disk space constraints, it is not possible
|
||
to use GDB directly on the remote target to debug applications. These
|
||
constraints arise because GDB needs to load the debugging information
|
||
and the binaries of the process being debugged. Additionally, GDB needs
|
||
to perform many computations to locate information such as function
|
||
names, variable names and values, stack traces and so forth - even
|
||
before starting the debugging process. These extra computations place
|
||
more load on the target system and can alter the characteristics of the
|
||
program being debugged.
|
||
|
||
To help get past the previously mentioned constraints, you can use
|
||
gdbserver, which runs on the remote target and does not load any
|
||
debugging information from the debugged process. Instead, a GDB instance
|
||
processes the debugging information that is run on a remote computer -
|
||
the host GDB. The host GDB then sends control commands to gdbserver to
|
||
make it stop or start the debugged program, as well as read or write
|
||
memory regions of that debugged program. All the debugging information
|
||
loaded and processed as well as all the heavy debugging is done by the
|
||
host GDB. Offloading these processes gives the gdbserver running on the
|
||
target a chance to remain small and fast.
|
||
|
||
Because the host GDB is responsible for loading the debugging
|
||
information and for doing the necessary processing to make actual
|
||
debugging happen, you have to make sure the host can access the
|
||
unstripped binaries complete with their debugging information and also
|
||
be sure the target is compiled with no optimizations. The host GDB must
|
||
also have local access to all the libraries used by the debugged
|
||
program. Because gdbserver does not need any local debugging
|
||
information, the binaries on the remote target can remain stripped.
|
||
However, the binaries must also be compiled without optimization so they
|
||
match the host's binaries.
|
||
|
||
To remain consistent with GDB documentation and terminology, the binary
|
||
being debugged on the remote target machine is referred to as the
|
||
"inferior" binary. For documentation on GDB see the `GDB
|
||
site <http://sourceware.org/gdb/documentation/>`__.
|
||
|
||
The following steps show you how to debug using the GNU project
|
||
debugger.
|
||
|
||
1. *Configure your build system to construct the companion debug
|
||
filesystem:*
|
||
|
||
In your ``local.conf`` file, set the following: IMAGE_GEN_DEBUGFS =
|
||
"1" IMAGE_FSTYPES_DEBUGFS = "tar.bz2" These options cause the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system to generate a special companion filesystem
|
||
fragment, which contains the matching source and debug symbols to
|
||
your deployable filesystem. The build system does this by looking at
|
||
what is in the deployed filesystem, and pulling the corresponding
|
||
``-dbg`` packages.
|
||
|
||
The companion debug filesystem is not a complete filesystem, but only
|
||
contains the debug fragments. This filesystem must be combined with
|
||
the full filesystem for debugging. Subsequent steps in this procedure
|
||
show how to combine the partial filesystem with the full filesystem.
|
||
|
||
2. *Configure the system to include gdbserver in the target filesystem:*
|
||
|
||
Make the following addition in either your ``local.conf`` file or in
|
||
an image recipe: IMAGE_INSTALL_append = “ gdbserver" The change makes
|
||
sure the ``gdbserver`` package is included.
|
||
|
||
3. *Build the environment:*
|
||
|
||
Use the following command to construct the image and the companion
|
||
Debug Filesystem: $ bitbake image Build the cross GDB component and
|
||
make it available for debugging. Build the SDK that matches the
|
||
image. Building the SDK is best for a production build that can be
|
||
used later for debugging, especially during long term maintenance: $
|
||
bitbake -c populate_sdk image
|
||
|
||
Alternatively, you can build the minimal toolchain components that
|
||
match the target. Doing so creates a smaller than typical SDK and
|
||
only contains a minimal set of components with which to build simple
|
||
test applications, as well as run the debugger: $ bitbake
|
||
meta-toolchain
|
||
|
||
A final method is to build Gdb itself within the build system: $
|
||
bitbake gdb-cross-architecture Doing so produces a temporary copy of
|
||
``cross-gdb`` you can use for debugging during development. While
|
||
this is the quickest approach, the two previous methods in this step
|
||
are better when considering long-term maintenance strategies.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you run
|
||
bitbake gdb-cross
|
||
, the OpenEmbedded build system suggests the actual image (e.g.
|
||
gdb-cross-i586
|
||
). The suggestion is usually the actual name you want to use.
|
||
|
||
4. *Set up the* ``debugfs``
|
||
|
||
Run the following commands to set up the ``debugfs``: $ mkdir debugfs
|
||
$ cd debugfs $ tar xvfj
|
||
build-dir/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/machine/image.rootfs.tar.bz2 $ tar
|
||
xvfj
|
||
build-dir/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/machine/image-dbg.rootfs.tar.bz2
|
||
|
||
5. *Set up GDB*
|
||
|
||
Install the SDK (if you built one) and then source the correct
|
||
environment file. Sourcing the environment file puts the SDK in your
|
||
``PATH`` environment variable.
|
||
|
||
If you are using the build system, Gdb is located in
|
||
build-dir/tmp/sysroots/host/usr/bin/architecture/architecture-gdb
|
||
|
||
6. *Boot the target:*
|
||
|
||
For information on how to run QEMU, see the `QEMU
|
||
Documentation <http://wiki.qemu.org/Documentation/GettingStartedDevelopers>`__.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Be sure to verify that your host can access the target via TCP.
|
||
|
||
7. *Debug a program:*
|
||
|
||
Debugging a program involves running gdbserver on the target and then
|
||
running Gdb on the host. The example in this step debugs ``gzip``:
|
||
root@qemux86:~# gdbserver localhost:1234 /bin/gzip —help For
|
||
additional gdbserver options, see the `GDB Server
|
||
Documentation <https://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/documentation/>`__.
|
||
|
||
After running gdbserver on the target, you need to run Gdb on the
|
||
host and configure it and connect to the target. Use these commands:
|
||
$ cd directory-holding-the-debugfs-directory $ arch-gdb (gdb) set
|
||
sysroot debugfs (gdb) set substitute-path /usr/src/debug
|
||
debugfs/usr/src/debug (gdb) target remote IP-of-target:1234 At this
|
||
point, everything should automatically load (i.e. matching binaries,
|
||
symbols and headers).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The Gdb
|
||
set
|
||
commands in the previous example can be placed into the users
|
||
~/.gdbinit
|
||
file. Upon starting, Gdb automatically runs whatever commands are
|
||
in that file.
|
||
|
||
8. *Deploying without a full image rebuild:*
|
||
|
||
In many cases, during development you want a quick method to deploy a
|
||
new binary to the target and debug it, without waiting for a full
|
||
image build.
|
||
|
||
One approach to solving this situation is to just build the component
|
||
you want to debug. Once you have built the component, copy the
|
||
executable directly to both the target and the host ``debugfs``.
|
||
|
||
If the binary is processed through the debug splitting in
|
||
OpenEmbedded, you should also copy the debug items (i.e. ``.debug``
|
||
contents and corresponding ``/usr/src/debug`` files) from the work
|
||
directory. Here is an example: $ bitbake bash $ bitbake -c devshell
|
||
bash $ cd .. $ scp packages-split/bash/bin/bash target:/bin/bash $ cp
|
||
-a packages-split/bash-dbg/\* path/debugfs
|
||
|
||
Debugging with the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) on the Target
|
||
-----------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
The previous section addressed using GDB remotely for debugging
|
||
purposes, which is the most usual case due to the inherent hardware
|
||
limitations on many embedded devices. However, debugging in the target
|
||
hardware itself is also possible with more powerful devices. This
|
||
section describes what you need to do in order to support using GDB to
|
||
debug on the target hardware.
|
||
|
||
To support this kind of debugging, you need do the following:
|
||
|
||
- Ensure that GDB is on the target. You can do this by adding "gdb" to
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`:
|
||
IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " gdb" Alternatively, you can add
|
||
"tools-debug" to
|
||
:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`:
|
||
IMAGE_FEATURES_append = " tools-debug"
|
||
|
||
- Ensure that debug symbols are present. You can make sure these
|
||
symbols are present by installing ``-dbg``: IMAGE_INSTALL_append = "
|
||
packagename-dbg" Alternatively, you can do the following to include
|
||
all the debug symbols: IMAGE_FEATURES_append = " dbg-pkgs"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
To improve the debug information accuracy, you can reduce the level
|
||
of optimization used by the compiler. For example, when adding the
|
||
following line to your
|
||
local.conf
|
||
file, you will reduce optimization from
|
||
FULL_OPTIMIZATION
|
||
of "-O2" to
|
||
DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION
|
||
of "-O -fno-omit-frame-pointer":
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
DEBUG_BUILD = "1"
|
||
|
||
|
||
Consider that this will reduce the application's performance and is
|
||
recommended only for debugging purposes.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-other-debugging-others:
|
||
|
||
Other Debugging Tips
|
||
--------------------
|
||
|
||
Here are some other tips that you might find useful:
|
||
|
||
- When adding new packages, it is worth watching for undesirable items
|
||
making their way into compiler command lines. For example, you do not
|
||
want references to local system files like ``/usr/lib/`` or
|
||
``/usr/include/``.
|
||
|
||
- If you want to remove the ``psplash`` boot splashscreen, add
|
||
``psplash=false`` to the kernel command line. Doing so prevents
|
||
``psplash`` from loading and thus allows you to see the console. It
|
||
is also possible to switch out of the splashscreen by switching the
|
||
virtual console (e.g. Fn+Left or Fn+Right on a Zaurus).
|
||
|
||
- Removing :term:`TMPDIR` (usually
|
||
``tmp/``, within the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`) can often fix
|
||
temporary build issues. Removing ``TMPDIR`` is usually a relatively
|
||
cheap operation, because task output will be cached in
|
||
:term:`SSTATE_DIR` (usually
|
||
``sstate-cache/``, which is also in the Build Directory).
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Removing
|
||
TMPDIR
|
||
might be a workaround rather than a fix. Consequently, trying to
|
||
determine the underlying cause of an issue before removing the
|
||
directory is a good idea.
|
||
|
||
- Understanding how a feature is used in practice within existing
|
||
recipes can be very helpful. It is recommended that you configure
|
||
some method that allows you to quickly search through files.
|
||
|
||
Using GNU Grep, you can use the following shell function to
|
||
recursively search through common recipe-related files, skipping
|
||
binary files, ``.git`` directories, and the Build Directory (assuming
|
||
its name starts with "build"): g() { grep -Ir \\ --exclude-dir=.git
|
||
\\ --exclude-dir='build*' \\ --include='*.bb*' \\ --include='*.inc*'
|
||
\\ --include='*.conf*' \\ --include='*.py*' \\ "$@" } Following are
|
||
some usage examples: $ g FOO # Search recursively for "FOO" $ g -i
|
||
foo # Search recursively for "foo", ignoring case $ g -w FOO # Search
|
||
recursively for "FOO" as a word, ignoring e.g. "FOOBAR" If figuring
|
||
out how some feature works requires a lot of searching, it might
|
||
indicate that the documentation should be extended or improved. In
|
||
such cases, consider filing a documentation bug using the Yocto
|
||
Project implementation of
|
||
`Bugzilla <https://bugzilla.yoctoproject.org/>`__. For information on
|
||
how to submit a bug against the Yocto Project, see the Yocto Project
|
||
Bugzilla `wiki
|
||
page <&YOCTO_WIKI_URL;/wiki/Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`__
|
||
and the "`Submitting a Defect Against the Yocto
|
||
Project <#submitting-a-defect-against-the-yocto-project>`__" section.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The manuals might not be the right place to document variables
|
||
that are purely internal and have a limited scope (e.g. internal
|
||
variables used to implement a single
|
||
.bbclass
|
||
file).
|
||
|
||
Making Changes to the Yocto Project
|
||
===================================
|
||
|
||
Because the Yocto Project is an open-source, community-based project,
|
||
you can effect changes to the project. This section presents procedures
|
||
that show you how to submit a defect against the project and how to
|
||
submit a change.
|
||
|
||
Submitting a Defect Against the Yocto Project
|
||
---------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Use the Yocto Project implementation of
|
||
`Bugzilla <http://www.bugzilla.org/about/>`__ to submit a defect (bug)
|
||
against the Yocto Project. For additional information on this
|
||
implementation of Bugzilla see the "`Yocto Project
|
||
Bugzilla <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#resources-bugtracker>`__" section in the
|
||
Yocto Project Reference Manual. For more detail on any of the following
|
||
steps, see the Yocto Project `Bugzilla wiki
|
||
page <&YOCTO_WIKI_URL;/wiki/Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`__.
|
||
|
||
Use the following general steps to submit a bug"
|
||
|
||
1. Open the Yocto Project implementation of
|
||
`Bugzilla <&YOCTO_BUGZILLA_URL;>`__.
|
||
|
||
2. Click "File a Bug" to enter a new bug.
|
||
|
||
3. Choose the appropriate "Classification", "Product", and "Component"
|
||
for which the bug was found. Bugs for the Yocto Project fall into
|
||
one of several classifications, which in turn break down into
|
||
several products and components. For example, for a bug against the
|
||
``meta-intel`` layer, you would choose "Build System, Metadata &
|
||
Runtime", "BSPs", and "bsps-meta-intel", respectively.
|
||
|
||
4. Choose the "Version" of the Yocto Project for which you found the
|
||
bug (e.g. DISTRO).
|
||
|
||
5. Determine and select the "Severity" of the bug. The severity
|
||
indicates how the bug impacted your work.
|
||
|
||
6. Choose the "Hardware" that the bug impacts.
|
||
|
||
7. Choose the "Architecture" that the bug impacts.
|
||
|
||
8. Choose a "Documentation change" item for the bug. Fixing a bug might
|
||
or might not affect the Yocto Project documentation. If you are
|
||
unsure of the impact to the documentation, select "Don't Know".
|
||
|
||
9. Provide a brief "Summary" of the bug. Try to limit your summary to
|
||
just a line or two and be sure to capture the essence of the bug.
|
||
|
||
10. Provide a detailed "Description" of the bug. You should provide as
|
||
much detail as you can about the context, behavior, output, and so
|
||
forth that surrounds the bug. You can even attach supporting files
|
||
for output from logs by using the "Add an attachment" button.
|
||
|
||
11. Click the "Submit Bug" button submit the bug. A new Bugzilla number
|
||
is assigned to the bug and the defect is logged in the bug tracking
|
||
system.
|
||
|
||
Once you file a bug, the bug is processed by the Yocto Project Bug
|
||
Triage Team and further details concerning the bug are assigned (e.g.
|
||
priority and owner). You are the "Submitter" of the bug and any further
|
||
categorization, progress, or comments on the bug result in Bugzilla
|
||
sending you an automated email concerning the particular change or
|
||
progress to the bug.
|
||
|
||
.. _how-to-submit-a-change:
|
||
|
||
Submitting a Change to the Yocto Project
|
||
----------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Contributions to the Yocto Project and OpenEmbedded are very welcome.
|
||
Because the system is extremely configurable and flexible, we recognize
|
||
that developers will want to extend, configure or optimize it for their
|
||
specific uses.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project uses a mailing list and a patch-based workflow that is
|
||
similar to the Linux kernel but contains important differences. In
|
||
general, a mailing list exists through which you can submit patches. You
|
||
should send patches to the appropriate mailing list so that they can be
|
||
reviewed and merged by the appropriate maintainer. The specific mailing
|
||
list you need to use depends on the location of the code you are
|
||
changing. Each component (e.g. layer) should have a ``README`` file that
|
||
indicates where to send the changes and which process to follow.
|
||
|
||
You can send the patch to the mailing list using whichever approach you
|
||
feel comfortable with to generate the patch. Once sent, the patch is
|
||
usually reviewed by the community at large. If somebody has concerns
|
||
with the patch, they will usually voice their concern over the mailing
|
||
list. If a patch does not receive any negative reviews, the maintainer
|
||
of the affected layer typically takes the patch, tests it, and then
|
||
based on successful testing, merges the patch.
|
||
|
||
The "poky" repository, which is the Yocto Project's reference build
|
||
environment, is a hybrid repository that contains several individual
|
||
pieces (e.g. BitBake, Metadata, documentation, and so forth) built using
|
||
the combo-layer tool. The upstream location used for submitting changes
|
||
varies by component:
|
||
|
||
- *Core Metadata:* Send your patch to the
|
||
`openembedded-core <http://lists.openembedded.org/mailman/listinfo/openembedded-core>`__
|
||
mailing list. For example, a change to anything under the ``meta`` or
|
||
``scripts`` directories should be sent to this mailing list.
|
||
|
||
- *BitBake:* For changes to BitBake (i.e. anything under the
|
||
``bitbake`` directory), send your patch to the
|
||
`bitbake-devel <http://lists.openembedded.org/mailman/listinfo/bitbake-devel>`__
|
||
mailing list.
|
||
|
||
- *"meta-*" trees:* These trees contain Metadata. Use the
|
||
`poky <https://lists.yoctoproject.org/listinfo/poky>`__ mailing list.
|
||
|
||
For changes to other layers hosted in the Yocto Project source
|
||
repositories (i.e. ``yoctoproject.org``), tools, and the Yocto Project
|
||
documentation, use the `Yocto
|
||
Project <https://lists.yoctoproject.org/listinfo/yocto>`__ general
|
||
mailing list.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Sometimes a layer's documentation specifies to use a particular
|
||
mailing list. If so, use that list.
|
||
|
||
For additional recipes that do not fit into the core Metadata, you
|
||
should determine which layer the recipe should go into and submit the
|
||
change in the manner recommended by the documentation (e.g. the
|
||
``README`` file) supplied with the layer. If in doubt, please ask on the
|
||
Yocto general mailing list or on the openembedded-devel mailing list.
|
||
|
||
You can also push a change upstream and request a maintainer to pull the
|
||
change into the component's upstream repository. You do this by pushing
|
||
to a contribution repository that is upstream. See the "`Git Workflows
|
||
and the Yocto
|
||
Project <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#gs-git-workflows-and-the-yocto-project>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for additional
|
||
concepts on working in the Yocto Project development environment.
|
||
|
||
Two commonly used testing repositories exist for OpenEmbedded-Core:
|
||
|
||
- *"ross/mut" branch:* The "mut" (master-under-test) tree exists in the
|
||
``poky-contrib`` repository in the `Yocto Project source
|
||
repositories <&YOCTO_GIT_URL;>`__.
|
||
|
||
- *"master-next" branch:* This branch is part of the main "poky"
|
||
repository in the Yocto Project source repositories.
|
||
|
||
Maintainers use these branches to test submissions prior to merging
|
||
patches. Thus, you can get an idea of the status of a patch based on
|
||
whether the patch has been merged into one of these branches.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
This system is imperfect and changes can sometimes get lost in the
|
||
flow. Asking about the status of a patch or change is reasonable if
|
||
the change has been idle for a while with no feedback. The Yocto
|
||
Project does have plans to use
|
||
Patchwork
|
||
to track the status of patches and also to automatically preview
|
||
patches.
|
||
|
||
The following sections provide procedures for submitting a change.
|
||
|
||
.. _pushing-a-change-upstream:
|
||
|
||
Using Scripts to Push a Change Upstream and Request a Pull
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Follow this procedure to push a change to an upstream "contrib" Git
|
||
repository:
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You can find general Git information on how to push a change upstream
|
||
in the
|
||
Git Community Book
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
1. *Make Your Changes Locally:* Make your changes in your local Git
|
||
repository. You should make small, controlled, isolated changes.
|
||
Keeping changes small and isolated aids review, makes
|
||
merging/rebasing easier and keeps the change history clean should
|
||
anyone need to refer to it in future.
|
||
|
||
2. *Stage Your Changes:* Stage your changes by using the ``git add``
|
||
command on each file you changed.
|
||
|
||
3. *Commit Your Changes:* Commit the change by using the ``git commit``
|
||
command. Make sure your commit information follows standards by
|
||
following these accepted conventions:
|
||
|
||
- Be sure to include a "Signed-off-by:" line in the same style as
|
||
required by the Linux kernel. Adding this line signifies that you,
|
||
the submitter, have agreed to the Developer's Certificate of
|
||
Origin 1.1 as follows: Developer's Certificate of Origin 1.1 By
|
||
making a contribution to this project, I certify that: (a) The
|
||
contribution was created in whole or in part by me and I have the
|
||
right to submit it under the open source license indicated in the
|
||
file; or (b) The contribution is based upon previous work that, to
|
||
the best of my knowledge, is covered under an appropriate open
|
||
source license and I have the right under that license to submit
|
||
that work with modifications, whether created in whole or in part
|
||
by me, under the same open source license (unless I am permitted
|
||
to submit under a different license), as indicated in the file; or
|
||
(c) The contribution was provided directly to me by some other
|
||
person who certified (a), (b) or (c) and I have not modified it.
|
||
(d) I understand and agree that this project and the contribution
|
||
are public and that a record of the contribution (including all
|
||
personal information I submit with it, including my sign-off) is
|
||
maintained indefinitely and may be redistributed consistent with
|
||
this project or the open source license(s) involved.
|
||
|
||
- Provide a single-line summary of the change. and, if more
|
||
explanation is needed, provide more detail in the body of the
|
||
commit. This summary is typically viewable in the "shortlist" of
|
||
changes. Thus, providing something short and descriptive that
|
||
gives the reader a summary of the change is useful when viewing a
|
||
list of many commits. You should prefix this short description
|
||
with the recipe name (if changing a recipe), or else with the
|
||
short form path to the file being changed.
|
||
|
||
- For the body of the commit message, provide detailed information
|
||
that describes what you changed, why you made the change, and the
|
||
approach you used. It might also be helpful if you mention how you
|
||
tested the change. Provide as much detail as you can in the body
|
||
of the commit message.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
You do not need to provide a more detailed explanation of a
|
||
change if the change is minor to the point of the single line
|
||
summary providing all the information.
|
||
|
||
- If the change addresses a specific bug or issue that is associated
|
||
with a bug-tracking ID, include a reference to that ID in your
|
||
detailed description. For example, the Yocto Project uses a
|
||
specific convention for bug references - any commit that addresses
|
||
a specific bug should use the following form for the detailed
|
||
description. Be sure to use the actual bug-tracking ID from
|
||
Bugzilla for bug-id: Fixes [YOCTO #bug-id] detailed description of
|
||
change
|
||
|
||
4. *Push Your Commits to a "Contrib" Upstream:* If you have arranged for
|
||
permissions to push to an upstream contrib repository, push the
|
||
change to that repository: $ git push upstream_remote_repo
|
||
local_branch_name For example, suppose you have permissions to push
|
||
into the upstream ``meta-intel-contrib`` repository and you are
|
||
working in a local branch named your_name\ ``/README``. The following
|
||
command pushes your local commits to the ``meta-intel-contrib``
|
||
upstream repository and puts the commit in a branch named
|
||
your_name\ ``/README``: $ git push meta-intel-contrib
|
||
your_name/README
|
||
|
||
5. *Determine Who to Notify:* Determine the maintainer or the mailing
|
||
list that you need to notify for the change.
|
||
|
||
Before submitting any change, you need to be sure who the maintainer
|
||
is or what mailing list that you need to notify. Use either these
|
||
methods to find out:
|
||
|
||
- *Maintenance File:* Examine the ``maintainers.inc`` file, which is
|
||
located in the :term:`Source Directory` at
|
||
``meta/conf/distro/include``, to see who is responsible for code.
|
||
|
||
- *Search by File:* Using `Git <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#git>`__, you can
|
||
enter the following command to bring up a short list of all
|
||
commits against a specific file: git shortlog -- filename Just
|
||
provide the name of the file for which you are interested. The
|
||
information returned is not ordered by history but does include a
|
||
list of everyone who has committed grouped by name. From the list,
|
||
you can see who is responsible for the bulk of the changes against
|
||
the file.
|
||
|
||
- *Examine the List of Mailing Lists:* For a list of the Yocto
|
||
Project and related mailing lists, see the "`Mailing
|
||
lists <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#resources-mailinglist>`__" section in
|
||
the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
6. *Make a Pull Request:* Notify the maintainer or the mailing list that
|
||
you have pushed a change by making a pull request.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides two scripts that conveniently let you
|
||
generate and send pull requests to the Yocto Project. These scripts
|
||
are ``create-pull-request`` and ``send-pull-request``. You can find
|
||
these scripts in the ``scripts`` directory within the
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` (e.g.
|
||
``~/poky/scripts``).
|
||
|
||
Using these scripts correctly formats the requests without
|
||
introducing any whitespace or HTML formatting. The maintainer that
|
||
receives your patches either directly or through the mailing list
|
||
needs to be able to save and apply them directly from your emails.
|
||
Using these scripts is the preferred method for sending patches.
|
||
|
||
First, create the pull request. For example, the following command
|
||
runs the script, specifies the upstream repository in the contrib
|
||
directory into which you pushed the change, and provides a subject
|
||
line in the created patch files: $ ~/poky/scripts/create-pull-request
|
||
-u meta-intel-contrib -s "Updated Manual Section Reference in README"
|
||
Running this script forms ``*.patch`` files in a folder named
|
||
``pull-``\ PID in the current directory. One of the patch files is a
|
||
cover letter.
|
||
|
||
Before running the ``send-pull-request`` script, you must edit the
|
||
cover letter patch to insert information about your change. After
|
||
editing the cover letter, send the pull request. For example, the
|
||
following command runs the script and specifies the patch directory
|
||
and email address. In this example, the email address is a mailing
|
||
list: $ ~/poky/scripts/send-pull-request -p ~/meta-intel/pull-10565
|
||
-t meta-intel@yoctoproject.org You need to follow the prompts as the
|
||
script is interactive.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
For help on using these scripts, simply provide the
|
||
-h
|
||
argument as follows:
|
||
::
|
||
|
||
$ poky/scripts/create-pull-request -h
|
||
$ poky/scripts/send-pull-request -h
|
||
|
||
|
||
.. _submitting-a-patch:
|
||
|
||
Using Email to Submit a Patch
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
You can submit patches without using the ``create-pull-request`` and
|
||
``send-pull-request`` scripts described in the previous section.
|
||
However, keep in mind, the preferred method is to use the scripts.
|
||
|
||
Depending on the components changed, you need to submit the email to a
|
||
specific mailing list. For some guidance on which mailing list to use,
|
||
see the `list <#figuring-out-the-mailing-list-to-use>`__ at the
|
||
beginning of this section. For a description of all the available
|
||
mailing lists, see the "`Mailing
|
||
Lists <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#resources-mailinglist>`__" section in the
|
||
Yocto Project Reference Manual.
|
||
|
||
Here is the general procedure on how to submit a patch through email
|
||
without using the scripts:
|
||
|
||
1. *Make Your Changes Locally:* Make your changes in your local Git
|
||
repository. You should make small, controlled, isolated changes.
|
||
Keeping changes small and isolated aids review, makes
|
||
merging/rebasing easier and keeps the change history clean should
|
||
anyone need to refer to it in future.
|
||
|
||
2. *Stage Your Changes:* Stage your changes by using the ``git add``
|
||
command on each file you changed.
|
||
|
||
3. *Commit Your Changes:* Commit the change by using the
|
||
``git commit --signoff`` command. Using the ``--signoff`` option
|
||
identifies you as the person making the change and also satisfies the
|
||
Developer's Certificate of Origin (DCO) shown earlier.
|
||
|
||
When you form a commit, you must follow certain standards established
|
||
by the Yocto Project development team. See `Step
|
||
3 <#making-sure-you-have-correct-commit-information>`__ in the
|
||
previous section for information on how to provide commit information
|
||
that meets Yocto Project commit message standards.
|
||
|
||
4. *Format the Commit:* Format the commit into an email message. To
|
||
format commits, use the ``git format-patch`` command. When you
|
||
provide the command, you must include a revision list or a number of
|
||
patches as part of the command. For example, either of these two
|
||
commands takes your most recent single commit and formats it as an
|
||
email message in the current directory: $ git format-patch -1 or $
|
||
git format-patch HEAD~
|
||
|
||
After the command is run, the current directory contains a numbered
|
||
``.patch`` file for the commit.
|
||
|
||
If you provide several commits as part of the command, the
|
||
``git format-patch`` command produces a series of numbered files in
|
||
the current directory – one for each commit. If you have more than
|
||
one patch, you should also use the ``--cover`` option with the
|
||
command, which generates a cover letter as the first "patch" in the
|
||
series. You can then edit the cover letter to provide a description
|
||
for the series of patches. For information on the
|
||
``git format-patch`` command, see ``GIT_FORMAT_PATCH(1)`` displayed
|
||
using the ``man git-format-patch`` command.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you are or will be a frequent contributor to the Yocto Project
|
||
or to OpenEmbedded, you might consider requesting a contrib area
|
||
and the necessary associated rights.
|
||
|
||
5. *Import the Files Into Your Mail Client:* Import the files into your
|
||
mail client by using the ``git send-email`` command.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
In order to use
|
||
git send-email
|
||
, you must have the proper Git packages installed on your host.
|
||
For Ubuntu, Debian, and Fedora the package is
|
||
git-email
|
||
.
|
||
|
||
The ``git send-email`` command sends email by using a local or remote
|
||
Mail Transport Agent (MTA) such as ``msmtp``, ``sendmail``, or
|
||
through a direct ``smtp`` configuration in your Git ``~/.gitconfig``
|
||
file. If you are submitting patches through email only, it is very
|
||
important that you submit them without any whitespace or HTML
|
||
formatting that either you or your mailer introduces. The maintainer
|
||
that receives your patches needs to be able to save and apply them
|
||
directly from your emails. A good way to verify that what you are
|
||
sending will be applicable by the maintainer is to do a dry run and
|
||
send them to yourself and then save and apply them as the maintainer
|
||
would.
|
||
|
||
The ``git send-email`` command is the preferred method for sending
|
||
your patches using email since there is no risk of compromising
|
||
whitespace in the body of the message, which can occur when you use
|
||
your own mail client. The command also has several options that let
|
||
you specify recipients and perform further editing of the email
|
||
message. For information on how to use the ``git send-email``
|
||
command, see ``GIT-SEND-EMAIL(1)`` displayed using the
|
||
``man git-send-email`` command.
|
||
|
||
Working With Licenses
|
||
=====================
|
||
|
||
As mentioned in the "`Licensing <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#licensing>`__"
|
||
section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, open source
|
||
projects are open to the public and they consequently have different
|
||
licensing structures in place. This section describes the mechanism by
|
||
which the :term:`OpenEmbedded Build System`
|
||
tracks changes to
|
||
licensing text and covers how to maintain open source license compliance
|
||
during your project's lifecycle. The section also describes how to
|
||
enable commercially licensed recipes, which by default are disabled.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-configuring-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM:
|
||
|
||
Tracking License Changes
|
||
------------------------
|
||
|
||
The license of an upstream project might change in the future. In order
|
||
to prevent these changes going unnoticed, the
|
||
:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
|
||
variable tracks changes to the license text. The checksums are validated
|
||
at the end of the configure step, and if the checksums do not match, the
|
||
build will fail.
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-specifying-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM:
|
||
|
||
Specifying the ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` Variable
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
The ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable contains checksums of the license text
|
||
in the source code for the recipe. Following is an example of how to
|
||
specify ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM``: LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://COPYING;md5=xxxx \\
|
||
file://licfile1.txt;beginline=5;endline=29;md5=yyyy \\
|
||
file://licfile2.txt;endline=50;md5=zzzz \\ ..."
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- When using "beginline" and "endline", realize that line numbering
|
||
begins with one and not zero. Also, the included lines are
|
||
inclusive (i.e. lines five through and including 29 in the
|
||
previous example for ``licfile1.txt``).
|
||
|
||
- When a license check fails, the selected license text is included
|
||
as part of the QA message. Using this output, you can determine
|
||
the exact start and finish for the needed license text.
|
||
|
||
The build system uses the :term:`S`
|
||
variable as the default directory when searching files listed in
|
||
``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM``. The previous example employs the default
|
||
directory.
|
||
|
||
Consider this next example: LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://src/ls.c;beginline=5;endline=16;\\
|
||
md5=bb14ed3c4cda583abc85401304b5cd4e" LIC_FILES_CHKSUM =
|
||
"file://${WORKDIR}/license.html;md5=5c94767cedb5d6987c902ac850ded2c6"
|
||
|
||
The first line locates a file in ``${S}/src/ls.c`` and isolates lines
|
||
five through 16 as license text. The second line refers to a file in
|
||
:term:`WORKDIR`.
|
||
|
||
Note that ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable is mandatory for all recipes,
|
||
unless the ``LICENSE`` variable is set to "CLOSED".
|
||
|
||
.. _usingpoky-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM-explanation-of-syntax:
|
||
|
||
Explanation of Syntax
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
As mentioned in the previous section, the ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable
|
||
lists all the important files that contain the license text for the
|
||
source code. It is possible to specify a checksum for an entire file, or
|
||
a specific section of a file (specified by beginning and ending line
|
||
numbers with the "beginline" and "endline" parameters, respectively).
|
||
The latter is useful for source files with a license notice header,
|
||
README documents, and so forth. If you do not use the "beginline"
|
||
parameter, then it is assumed that the text begins on the first line of
|
||
the file. Similarly, if you do not use the "endline" parameter, it is
|
||
assumed that the license text ends with the last line of the file.
|
||
|
||
The "md5" parameter stores the md5 checksum of the license text. If the
|
||
license text changes in any way as compared to this parameter then a
|
||
mismatch occurs. This mismatch triggers a build failure and notifies the
|
||
developer. Notification allows the developer to review and address the
|
||
license text changes. Also note that if a mismatch occurs during the
|
||
build, the correct md5 checksum is placed in the build log and can be
|
||
easily copied to the recipe.
|
||
|
||
There is no limit to how many files you can specify using the
|
||
``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` variable. Generally, however, every project
|
||
requires a few specifications for license tracking. Many projects have a
|
||
"COPYING" file that stores the license information for all the source
|
||
code files. This practice allows you to just track the "COPYING" file as
|
||
long as it is kept up to date.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
- If you specify an empty or invalid "md5" parameter,
|
||
:term:`BitBake` returns an md5
|
||
mis-match error and displays the correct "md5" parameter value
|
||
during the build. The correct parameter is also captured in the
|
||
build log.
|
||
|
||
- If the whole file contains only license text, you do not need to
|
||
use the "beginline" and "endline" parameters.
|
||
|
||
Enabling Commercially Licensed Recipes
|
||
--------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
By default, the OpenEmbedded build system disables components that have
|
||
commercial or other special licensing requirements. Such requirements
|
||
are defined on a recipe-by-recipe basis through the
|
||
:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` variable
|
||
definition in the affected recipe. For instance, the
|
||
``poky/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gst-plugins-ugly`` recipe
|
||
contains the following statement: LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial" Here is a
|
||
slightly more complicated example that contains both an explicit recipe
|
||
name and version (after variable expansion): LICENSE_FLAGS =
|
||
"license_${PN}_${PV}" In order for a component restricted by a
|
||
``LICENSE_FLAGS`` definition to be enabled and included in an image, it
|
||
needs to have a matching entry in the global
|
||
:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST`
|
||
variable, which is a variable typically defined in your ``local.conf``
|
||
file. For example, to enable the
|
||
``poky/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gst-plugins-ugly`` package, you
|
||
could add either the string "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly" or the more
|
||
general string "commercial" to ``LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST``. See the
|
||
"`License Flag Matching <#license-flag-matching>`__" section for a full
|
||
explanation of how ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` matching works. Here is the
|
||
example: LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST = "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly"
|
||
Likewise, to additionally enable the package built from the recipe
|
||
containing ``LICENSE_FLAGS = "license_${PN}_${PV}"``, and assuming that
|
||
the actual recipe name was ``emgd_1.10.bb``, the following string would
|
||
enable that package as well as the original ``gst-plugins-ugly``
|
||
package: LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST = "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly
|
||
license_emgd_1.10" As a convenience, you do not need to specify the
|
||
complete license string in the whitelist for every package. You can use
|
||
an abbreviated form, which consists of just the first portion or
|
||
portions of the license string before the initial underscore character
|
||
or characters. A partial string will match any license that contains the
|
||
given string as the first portion of its license. For example, the
|
||
following whitelist string will also match both of the packages
|
||
previously mentioned as well as any other packages that have licenses
|
||
starting with "commercial" or "license". LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST =
|
||
"commercial license"
|
||
|
||
License Flag Matching
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
License flag matching allows you to control what recipes the
|
||
OpenEmbedded build system includes in the build. Fundamentally, the
|
||
build system attempts to match ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` strings found in
|
||
recipes against ``LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST`` strings found in the
|
||
whitelist. A match causes the build system to include a recipe in the
|
||
build, while failure to find a match causes the build system to exclude
|
||
a recipe.
|
||
|
||
In general, license flag matching is simple. However, understanding some
|
||
concepts will help you correctly and effectively use matching.
|
||
|
||
Before a flag defined by a particular recipe is tested against the
|
||
contents of the whitelist, the expanded string ``_${PN}`` is appended to
|
||
the flag. This expansion makes each ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` value
|
||
recipe-specific. After expansion, the string is then matched against the
|
||
whitelist. Thus, specifying ``LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial"`` in recipe
|
||
"foo", for example, results in the string ``"commercial_foo"``. And, to
|
||
create a match, that string must appear in the whitelist.
|
||
|
||
Judicious use of the ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` strings and the contents of the
|
||
``LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST`` variable allows you a lot of flexibility for
|
||
including or excluding recipes based on licensing. For example, you can
|
||
broaden the matching capabilities by using license flags string subsets
|
||
in the whitelist.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
When using a string subset, be sure to use the part of the expanded
|
||
string that precedes the appended underscore character (e.g.
|
||
usethispart_1.3
|
||
,
|
||
usethispart_1.4
|
||
, and so forth).
|
||
|
||
For example, simply specifying the string "commercial" in the whitelist
|
||
matches any expanded ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` definition that starts with the
|
||
string "commercial" such as "commercial_foo" and "commercial_bar", which
|
||
are the strings the build system automatically generates for
|
||
hypothetical recipes named "foo" and "bar" assuming those recipes simply
|
||
specify the following: LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial" Thus, you can choose
|
||
to exhaustively enumerate each license flag in the whitelist and allow
|
||
only specific recipes into the image, or you can use a string subset
|
||
that causes a broader range of matches to allow a range of recipes into
|
||
the image.
|
||
|
||
This scheme works even if the ``LICENSE_FLAGS`` string already has
|
||
``_${PN}`` appended. For example, the build system turns the license
|
||
flag "commercial_1.2_foo" into "commercial_1.2_foo_foo" and would match
|
||
both the general "commercial" and the specific "commercial_1.2_foo"
|
||
strings found in the whitelist, as expected.
|
||
|
||
Here are some other scenarios:
|
||
|
||
- You can specify a versioned string in the recipe such as
|
||
"commercial_foo_1.2" in a "foo" recipe. The build system expands this
|
||
string to "commercial_foo_1.2_foo". Combine this license flag with a
|
||
whitelist that has the string "commercial" and you match the flag
|
||
along with any other flag that starts with the string "commercial".
|
||
|
||
- Under the same circumstances, you can use "commercial_foo" in the
|
||
whitelist and the build system not only matches "commercial_foo_1.2"
|
||
but also matches any license flag with the string "commercial_foo",
|
||
regardless of the version.
|
||
|
||
- You can be very specific and use both the package and version parts
|
||
in the whitelist (e.g. "commercial_foo_1.2") to specifically match a
|
||
versioned recipe.
|
||
|
||
Other Variables Related to Commercial Licenses
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Other helpful variables related to commercial license handling exist and
|
||
are defined in the
|
||
``poky/meta/conf/distro/include/default-distrovars.inc`` file:
|
||
COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS ?= "" COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS ?= "" If you
|
||
want to enable these components, you can do so by making sure you have
|
||
statements similar to the following in your ``local.conf`` configuration
|
||
file: COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS = "gst-plugins-ugly-mad \\
|
||
gst-plugins-ugly-mpegaudioparse" COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS =
|
||
"gst-plugins-ugly-mpeg2dec \\ gst-plugins-ugly-mpegstream
|
||
gst-plugins-bad-mpegvideoparse" LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST =
|
||
"commercial_gst-plugins-ugly commercial_gst-plugins-bad commercial_qmmp"
|
||
Of course, you could also create a matching whitelist for those
|
||
components using the more general "commercial" in the whitelist, but
|
||
that would also enable all the other packages with ``LICENSE_FLAGS``
|
||
containing "commercial", which you may or may not want:
|
||
LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST = "commercial"
|
||
|
||
Specifying audio and video plugins as part of the
|
||
``COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS`` and ``COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS`` statements
|
||
(along with the enabling ``LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST``) includes the
|
||
plugins or components into built images, thus adding support for media
|
||
formats or components.
|
||
|
||
Maintaining Open Source License Compliance During Your Product's Lifecycle
|
||
--------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
One of the concerns for a development organization using open source
|
||
software is how to maintain compliance with various open source
|
||
licensing during the lifecycle of the product. While this section does
|
||
not provide legal advice or comprehensively cover all scenarios, it does
|
||
present methods that you can use to assist you in meeting the compliance
|
||
requirements during a software release.
|
||
|
||
With hundreds of different open source licenses that the Yocto Project
|
||
tracks, it is difficult to know the requirements of each and every
|
||
license. However, the requirements of the major FLOSS licenses can begin
|
||
to be covered by assuming that three main areas of concern exist:
|
||
|
||
- Source code must be provided.
|
||
|
||
- License text for the software must be provided.
|
||
|
||
- Compilation scripts and modifications to the source code must be
|
||
provided.
|
||
|
||
There are other requirements beyond the scope of these three and the
|
||
methods described in this section (e.g. the mechanism through which
|
||
source code is distributed).
|
||
|
||
As different organizations have different methods of complying with open
|
||
source licensing, this section is not meant to imply that there is only
|
||
one single way to meet your compliance obligations, but rather to
|
||
describe one method of achieving compliance. The remainder of this
|
||
section describes methods supported to meet the previously mentioned
|
||
three requirements. Once you take steps to meet these requirements, and
|
||
prior to releasing images, sources, and the build system, you should
|
||
audit all artifacts to ensure completeness.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project generates a license manifest during image creation
|
||
that is located in
|
||
${DEPLOY_DIR}/licenses/
|
||
image_name-datestamp
|
||
to assist with any audits.
|
||
|
||
Providing the Source Code
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
Compliance activities should begin before you generate the final image.
|
||
The first thing you should look at is the requirement that tops the list
|
||
for most compliance groups - providing the source. The Yocto Project has
|
||
a few ways of meeting this requirement.
|
||
|
||
One of the easiest ways to meet this requirement is to provide the
|
||
entire :term:`DL_DIR` used by the
|
||
build. This method, however, has a few issues. The most obvious is the
|
||
size of the directory since it includes all sources used in the build
|
||
and not just the source used in the released image. It will include
|
||
toolchain source, and other artifacts, which you would not generally
|
||
release. However, the more serious issue for most companies is
|
||
accidental release of proprietary software. The Yocto Project provides
|
||
an :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class to
|
||
help avoid some of these concerns.
|
||
|
||
Before you employ ``DL_DIR`` or the ``archiver`` class, you need to
|
||
decide how you choose to provide source. The source ``archiver`` class
|
||
can generate tarballs and SRPMs and can create them with various levels
|
||
of compliance in mind.
|
||
|
||
One way of doing this (but certainly not the only way) is to release
|
||
just the source as a tarball. You can do this by adding the following to
|
||
the ``local.conf`` file found in the
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`: INHERIT +=
|
||
"archiver" ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original" During the creation of your
|
||
image, the source from all recipes that deploy packages to the image is
|
||
placed within subdirectories of ``DEPLOY_DIR/sources`` based on the
|
||
:term:`LICENSE` for each recipe.
|
||
Releasing the entire directory enables you to comply with requirements
|
||
concerning providing the unmodified source. It is important to note that
|
||
the size of the directory can get large.
|
||
|
||
A way to help mitigate the size issue is to only release tarballs for
|
||
licenses that require the release of source. Let us assume you are only
|
||
concerned with GPL code as identified by running the following script: #
|
||
Script to archive a subset of packages matching specific license(s) #
|
||
Source and license files are copied into sub folders of package folder #
|
||
Must be run from build folder #!/bin/bash
|
||
src_release_dir="source-release" mkdir -p $src_release_dir for a in
|
||
tmp/deploy/sources/*; do for d in $a/*; do # Get package name from path
|
||
p=`basename $d\` p=${p%-*} p=${p%-*} # Only archive GPL packages (update
|
||
\*GPL\* regex for your license check) numfiles=`ls
|
||
tmp/deploy/licenses/$p/*GPL\* 2> /dev/null \| wc -l\` if [ $numfiles -gt
|
||
1 ]; then echo Archiving $p mkdir -p $src_release_dir/$p/source cp $d/\*
|
||
$src_release_dir/$p/source 2> /dev/null mkdir -p
|
||
$src_release_dir/$p/license cp tmp/deploy/licenses/$p/\*
|
||
$src_release_dir/$p/license 2> /dev/null fi done done At this point, you
|
||
could create a tarball from the ``gpl_source_release`` directory and
|
||
provide that to the end user. This method would be a step toward
|
||
achieving compliance with section 3a of GPLv2 and with section 6 of
|
||
GPLv3.
|
||
|
||
Providing License Text
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
One requirement that is often overlooked is inclusion of license text.
|
||
This requirement also needs to be dealt with prior to generating the
|
||
final image. Some licenses require the license text to accompany the
|
||
binary. You can achieve this by adding the following to your
|
||
``local.conf`` file: COPY_LIC_MANIFEST = "1" COPY_LIC_DIRS = "1"
|
||
LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE = "1" Adding these statements to the
|
||
configuration file ensures that the licenses collected during package
|
||
generation are included on your image.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Setting all three variables to "1" results in the image having two
|
||
copies of the same license file. One copy resides in
|
||
``/usr/share/common-licenses`` and the other resides in
|
||
``/usr/share/license``.
|
||
|
||
The reason for this behavior is because
|
||
:term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` and
|
||
:term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST`
|
||
add a copy of the license when the image is built but do not offer a
|
||
path for adding licenses for newly installed packages to an image.
|
||
:term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE`
|
||
adds a separate package and an upgrade path for adding licenses to an
|
||
image.
|
||
|
||
As the source ``archiver`` class has already archived the original
|
||
unmodified source that contains the license files, you would have
|
||
already met the requirements for inclusion of the license information
|
||
with source as defined by the GPL and other open source licenses.
|
||
|
||
Providing Compilation Scripts and Source Code Modifications
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
At this point, we have addressed all we need to prior to generating the
|
||
image. The next two requirements are addressed during the final
|
||
packaging of the release.
|
||
|
||
By releasing the version of the OpenEmbedded build system and the layers
|
||
used during the build, you will be providing both compilation scripts
|
||
and the source code modifications in one step.
|
||
|
||
If the deployment team has a `BSP
|
||
layer <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#bsp-layers>`__ and a distro layer, and those
|
||
those layers are used to patch, compile, package, or modify (in any way)
|
||
any open source software included in your released images, you might be
|
||
required to release those layers under section 3 of GPLv2 or section 1
|
||
of GPLv3. One way of doing that is with a clean checkout of the version
|
||
of the Yocto Project and layers used during your build. Here is an
|
||
example: # We built using the DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP branch of the poky repo
|
||
$ git clone -b DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP git://git.yoctoproject.org/poky $ cd
|
||
poky # We built using the release_branch for our layers $ git clone -b
|
||
release_branch git://git.mycompany.com/meta-my-bsp-layer $ git clone -b
|
||
release_branch git://git.mycompany.com/meta-my-software-layer # clean up
|
||
the .git repos $ find . -name ".git" -type d -exec rm -rf {} \\; One
|
||
thing a development organization might want to consider for end-user
|
||
convenience is to modify ``meta-poky/conf/bblayers.conf.sample`` to
|
||
ensure that when the end user utilizes the released build system to
|
||
build an image, the development organization's layers are included in
|
||
the ``bblayers.conf`` file automatically: # POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION
|
||
is increased each time build/conf/bblayers.conf # changes incompatibly
|
||
POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION = "2" BBPATH = "${TOPDIR}" BBFILES ?= ""
|
||
BBLAYERS ?= " \\ ##OEROOT##/meta \\ ##OEROOT##/meta-poky \\
|
||
##OEROOT##/meta-yocto-bsp \\ ##OEROOT##/meta-mylayer \\ " Creating and
|
||
providing an archive of the :term:`Metadata`
|
||
layers (recipes, configuration files, and so forth) enables you to meet
|
||
your requirements to include the scripts to control compilation as well
|
||
as any modifications to the original source.
|
||
|
||
Copying Licenses that Do Not Exist
|
||
----------------------------------
|
||
|
||
Some packages, such as the linux-firmware package, have many licenses
|
||
that are not in any way common. You can avoid adding a lot of these
|
||
types of common license files, which are only applicable to a specific
|
||
package, by using the
|
||
:term:`NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`
|
||
variable. Using this variable also avoids QA errors when you use a
|
||
non-common, non-CLOSED license in a recipe.
|
||
|
||
The following is an example that uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as
|
||
the license from the fetched source: NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis]
|
||
= "LICENSE.Abilis.txt"
|
||
|
||
Using the Error Reporting Tool
|
||
==============================
|
||
|
||
The error reporting tool allows you to submit errors encountered during
|
||
builds to a central database. Outside of the build environment, you can
|
||
use a web interface to browse errors, view statistics, and query for
|
||
errors. The tool works using a client-server system where the client
|
||
portion is integrated with the installed Yocto Project
|
||
:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
|
||
The server receives the information collected and saves it in a
|
||
database.
|
||
|
||
A live instance of the error reporting server exists at
|
||
` <http://errors.yoctoproject.org>`__. This server exists so that when
|
||
you want to get help with build failures, you can submit all of the
|
||
information on the failure easily and then point to the URL in your bug
|
||
report or send an email to the mailing list.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If you send error reports to this server, the reports become publicly
|
||
visible.
|
||
|
||
Enabling and Using the Tool
|
||
---------------------------
|
||
|
||
By default, the error reporting tool is disabled. You can enable it by
|
||
inheriting the
|
||
:ref:`report-error <ref-classes-report-error>`
|
||
class by adding the following statement to the end of your
|
||
``local.conf`` file in your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. INHERIT +=
|
||
"report-error"
|
||
|
||
By default, the error reporting feature stores information in
|
||
``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``.
|
||
However, you can specify a directory to use by adding the following to
|
||
your ``local.conf`` file: ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path" Enabling error
|
||
reporting causes the build process to collect the errors and store them
|
||
in a file as previously described. When the build system encounters an
|
||
error, it includes a command as part of the console output. You can run
|
||
the command to send the error file to the server. For example, the
|
||
following command sends the errors to an upstream server: $
|
||
send-error-report
|
||
/home/brandusa/project/poky/build/tmp/log/error-report/error_report_201403141617.txt
|
||
In the previous example, the errors are sent to a public database
|
||
available at ` <http://errors.yoctoproject.org>`__, which is used by the
|
||
entire community. If you specify a particular server, you can send the
|
||
errors to a different database. Use the following command for more
|
||
information on available options: $ send-error-report --help
|
||
|
||
When sending the error file, you are prompted to review the data being
|
||
sent as well as to provide a name and optional email address. Once you
|
||
satisfy these prompts, the command returns a link from the server that
|
||
corresponds to your entry in the database. For example, here is a
|
||
typical link: http://errors.yoctoproject.org/Errors/Details/9522/
|
||
Following the link takes you to a web interface where you can browse,
|
||
query the errors, and view statistics.
|
||
|
||
Disabling the Tool
|
||
------------------
|
||
|
||
To disable the error reporting feature, simply remove or comment out the
|
||
following statement from the end of your ``local.conf`` file in your
|
||
:term:`Build Directory`. INHERIT +=
|
||
"report-error"
|
||
|
||
Setting Up Your Own Error Reporting Server
|
||
------------------------------------------
|
||
|
||
If you want to set up your own error reporting server, you can obtain
|
||
the code from the Git repository at
|
||
` <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/error-report-web/>`__.
|
||
Instructions on how to set it up are in the README document.
|
||
|
||
.. _dev-using-wayland-and-weston:
|
||
|
||
Using Wayland and Weston
|
||
========================
|
||
|
||
`Wayland <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Wayland_(display_server_protocol)>`__
|
||
is a computer display server protocol that provides a method for
|
||
compositing window managers to communicate directly with applications
|
||
and video hardware and expects them to communicate with input hardware
|
||
using other libraries. Using Wayland with supporting targets can result
|
||
in better control over graphics frame rendering than an application
|
||
might otherwise achieve.
|
||
|
||
The Yocto Project provides the Wayland protocol libraries and the
|
||
reference
|
||
`Weston <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Wayland_(display_server_protocol)#Weston>`__
|
||
compositor as part of its release. You can find the integrated packages
|
||
in the ``meta`` layer of the :term:`Source Directory`.
|
||
Specifically, you
|
||
can find the recipes that build both Wayland and Weston at
|
||
``meta/recipes-graphics/wayland``.
|
||
|
||
You can build both the Wayland and Weston packages for use only with
|
||
targets that accept the `Mesa 3D and Direct Rendering
|
||
Infrastructure <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mesa_(computer_graphics)>`__,
|
||
which is also known as Mesa DRI. This implies that you cannot build and
|
||
use the packages if your target uses, for example, the Intel Embedded
|
||
Media and Graphics Driver (Intel EMGD) that overrides Mesa DRI.
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
Due to lack of EGL support, Weston 1.0.3 will not run directly on the
|
||
emulated QEMU hardware. However, this version of Weston will run
|
||
under X emulation without issues.
|
||
|
||
This section describes what you need to do to implement Wayland and use
|
||
the Weston compositor when building an image for a supporting target.
|
||
|
||
Enabling Wayland in an Image
|
||
----------------------------
|
||
|
||
To enable Wayland, you need to enable it to be built and enable it to be
|
||
included (installed) in the image.
|
||
|
||
.. _enable-building:
|
||
|
||
Building
|
||
~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To cause Mesa to build the ``wayland-egl`` platform and Weston to build
|
||
Wayland with Kernel Mode Setting
|
||
(`KMS <https://wiki.archlinux.org/index.php/Kernel_Mode_Setting>`__)
|
||
support, include the "wayland" flag in the
|
||
:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
|
||
statement in your ``local.conf`` file: DISTRO_FEATURES_append = "
|
||
wayland"
|
||
|
||
.. note::
|
||
|
||
If X11 has been enabled elsewhere, Weston will build Wayland with X11
|
||
support
|
||
|
||
.. _enable-installation-in-an-image:
|
||
|
||
Installing
|
||
~~~~~~~~~~
|
||
|
||
To install the Wayland feature into an image, you must include the
|
||
following
|
||
:term:`CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL`
|
||
statement in your ``local.conf`` file: CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL +=
|
||
"wayland weston"
|
||
|
||
Running Weston
|
||
--------------
|
||
|
||
To run Weston inside X11, enabling it as described earlier and building
|
||
a Sato image is sufficient. If you are running your image under Sato, a
|
||
Weston Launcher appears in the "Utility" category.
|
||
|
||
Alternatively, you can run Weston through the command-line interpretor
|
||
(CLI), which is better suited for development work. To run Weston under
|
||
the CLI, you need to do the following after your image is built:
|
||
|
||
1. Run these commands to export ``XDG_RUNTIME_DIR``: mkdir -p
|
||
/tmp/$USER-weston chmod 0700 /tmp/$USER-weston export
|
||
XDG_RUNTIME_DIR=/tmp/$USER-weston
|
||
|
||
2. Launch Weston in the shell: weston
|